DCE Security Services provide authentication and authorization within a cell and is based upon MIT's Kerberos private key encryption system.
1 – Admin Intro
NAME sec_intro - Introduction to the DCE Security administrative commands DESCRIPTION This section describes DCE Security commands for system administration. These commands are: acl_edit Manages Access Control Lists (ACLs) for DCE objects auditd Starts the DCE Audit Daemon chpass Changes user information, such as login name, password, home directory, password and account expiration dates,and login shell. The implementation of this utility is platform- specific. Use the chpass utility supplied your platform vendor for changing user information. dce_login Validates a principal's identity and obtains a principal's network credentials. This command is used primarily during DCE configuration. Use the login utility supplied by your platform vendor for user login. kdestroy Destroys your login context and credentials kinit Obtains and caches a ticket granting ticket klist Lists cached tickets passwd_export Updates local password and group files from DCE registry data passwd_import Creates DCE registry entries based on password and group file entries passwd_override Establishes DCE registry overrides for a principal on a local node pwd_strengthd Sample password management server rgy_edit Edits the registry database sec_admin Administers the Security Server sec_create_db Creates registry databases secd The Security Server daemon sec_salvage_db Reconstructs or recovers a registry database See the command's reference page for further information on each command.
1.1 – acl_edit
NAME acl_edit - Edits or lists an object's ACLs SYNOPSIS acl_edit {[-e] pathname | -addr string_binding component_name} [-ic | -io] [-n | -c] [command_line_subcommands] [-ngui] [-v] OPTIONS -e pathname Specifies that the ACL on the Directory Service entry is to be edited. You must specify the pathname argument if you use the -e option. The -e option is especially useful in case of an ambiguous pathname. The pathname argument can be interpreted in two ways if it is the name of a leaf object in the Directory Service (that is, if it is not the name of a directory). It can be interpreted as the Directory Service entry itself, or as the object (whatever it is) referenced by that Directory Service entry. When such a path- name is specified, the -e option directs acl_edit to the ACL on the Directory Service entry. -addr string_binding component_name The -addr option lets you identify the object whose ACLs you want to edit by supplying the RPC binding handle of the ACL Manager that controls access to the object (with the string_binding argument) and the relative pathname of the object (with the component_name argument). Because you have identified the RPC binding handle, you can specify only the object's relative pathname for component_name. The most common way to identify the object whose ACLs you want to manipulate is through the pathname argument,described below. The -addr option is used primarily by applications that do not use the Directory Service, but do use the generic ACL Manager. It can also be used if the Directory Service is unavailable. -ic For container objects only, specifies that the object's Initial Container Creation ACL is to be edited. The Initial Container Creation ACL is applied by default to any containers created within the ACL'd container. If this option is specified and the object named in pathname is not a container, an error is returned. -io For container objects only, specifies that the object's Initial Object Creation ACL is to be edited. The Initial Object Creation ACL is applied by default to any simple objects (that is, objects that are not containers) created within the ACL'd container. If this option is specified and the object is not a container, an error is returned. -n Specifies that a new mask should not be calculated. This option is useful only for objects that support the mask_obj entry type and that are required to recalculate a new mask after they are modified. If a modify operation creates a mask that unintentionally adds permissions to an existing acl entry, the modify causing the mask recalculation will abort with an error unless you specify either the -c or -n option. -c Creates or modifies the object's mask_obj type entry with permissions equal to the union of all entries other than type user_obj, other_obj, and unauthenticated. This creation or modification is done after all other modifications to the ACL are performed. The new mask is set even if it grants permissions previously masked out. It is recommended that you use this option only if not specifying it results in an error. This option is useful only for objects that support the mask_obj entry type and are required to recalculate a new mask after they are modified. If a modify operation creates a mask that unintentionally adds permissions to an existing acl entry, the modify causing the mask recalculation will abort with an error unless you specify either the -c or -n option. If you specify the -c option for an ACL that does not support mask_obj entry type, acl_edit returns an error when it attempts to save the ACL, aborting all subcommands supplied on the command line. -ngui Specifies that a Graphical User Interface (GUI) should not be used even if a GUI is available. If your version of acl_edit supports a GUI and your terminal is capable of using it, invoking acl_edit without this option will bring up the GUI mode. Use the -ngui option to bring up command- line mode. However, if a GUI is not available, or the terminal is not capable of using the GUI, acl_edit comes up in command-line mode regardles of wheter you supply this option or not. -v Run in verbose mode. ARGUMENTS pathname The full pathname of the object whose ACL is to be viewed or edited. If the object is in another cell, pathname must be fully qualified to include the cell identifier. command_line_subcommands The command-line subcommands, which act on the object specified by pathname, are entered as part of the command string that invokes acl_edit. Only one command-line subcommand can be specified per invocation. The commands follow. See the description of the equivalent interactive subcommand for a more detailed description of the command functions. -m [acl_entry] acl_entry... Adds a new ACL entry or changes the permissions of an existing entry. You can enter multiple entries, each separated by a space. -p Purges all masked permissions (before any other modifications are made). This option is useful only for ACLs that contain an entry of type mask_obj. Use it to prevent unintentionally granting permissions to an existing entry when a new mask is calculated as a result of adding or modifying an ACL entry. -d [acl_entry] acl_entry... Deletes an existing entry from the ACL associated with the specified object. You can enter multiple entries, each separated by a space. -s [acl_entry] acl_entry... Replaces (substitutes) the ACL information associated with this object with acl_entry. All existing entries are removed and replaced by the newly specified entries. If you specify the -s subcommand, you cannot specify the -f or -k subcommand. You can enter multiple entries, each separated by a space. -f file Assigns the ACL information contained in file to the object. All existing entries are removed and replaced by the entries in the file. If you specify the -f sub- command, you cannot specify the -s or -k subcommand. -k Removes all entries, except entries of type user_obj (if they are present). If you specify the -k subcommand, you cannot specify the -f or -s subcommand. -l Lists the entries in the object's ACL. The command-line subcommands are evaluated in the following order: 1. -p 2. -s or -f or -k 3. -d 4. -m 5. -l NOTES With the exception of the following subcommands, this command is replaced at Revision 1.1 by the dcecp command. This command may be fully replaced by the dcecp command in a future release of DCE, and may no longer be supported at that time. + abort + commit + exit + help + test access DESCRIPTION The acl_edit command is a client program that, when invoked, binds to the specified object's ACL Manager (which is implemented in the object's server), and allows the user to manipulate the object's ACL through the standard DCE ACL interface. This interface is the sec_acl_...() interface documented in the OSF DCE Application Development Reference. The acl_edit command automatically binds to the server of the object specified, and then communicates (through the standard DCE ACL interface) with that server's ACL manager in response to user input. Exactly what the object "specified" is depends partly on whether or not the -e option is specified. Specifying -e means that you want to operate on the Directory Service ACL - in other words, you want acl_edit to bind to the CDS server and allow you to operate on the ACL maintained by that server on the object's directory entry. If, on the the ACL on the object to which the directory entry refers - then you simply omit the -e option. The result will be that acl_edit will bind to that object's server (the server must, of course, implement an ACL manager), giving you access to the object's ACL. All acl_edit subcommands act on the object specified by pathname when you invoked acl_edit. You can invoke acl_edit in either command-line or interactive mode: + To invoke acl_edit in command-line mode, enter the command, the object's pathname, options, and the command-line subcommand on th line that invokes acl_edit. Only one command-line subcommand can be entered per acl_edit invocation. + To invoke acl_edit in interactive mode, enter only acl_edit, the object's pathname, and options. The acl_edit prompt is then displayed. In this mode, you enter interactive subcommands that let you edit and view entries in the object's ACL and view help information about the acl_edit command itself. Changes you make in command-line mode are saved when you enter the command. In interactive mode, you must explicitly save your changes. To do so, use the commit subcommand to save the changes without exiting acl_edit or the exit subcommand to save the changes and exit acl_edit. Use the abort subcommand to exit acl_edit and save none of the changes you have made. When you invoke acl_edit for a specific object's ACL, that ACL is not locked. This means that it is possible for multiple users to edit the ACL simultaneously, with each change overwriting the previous changes. For this reason, the number of users assigned rights to change a particular ACL should be tightly controlled and limited to one user if possible. INTERACTIVE SUBCOMMANDS The following subcommands are available when acl_edit is invoked in interactive mode. All of the commands act on the ACL associated with the object specified by pathname when acl_edit was invoked. ? Displays the available acl_edit subcommands. ab[ort] Exits acl_edit without saving the changes to the object's ACL. as[sign] filename Applies the ACL entries in filename to the specified object. This subcommand removes existing entries and replaces them with the entries in the file. c[ell] name Sets the cell name to be associated with the ACL. This sub- command is used primarily to facilitate copying ACLs to different cells. The default cell name stays in place until you run the subcommand again to change it. co[mmit] Saves all changes to the ACL without exiting. d[elete] acl_entry Deletes the specified ACL entry. e[xit] Exits from acl_edit, saving any changes to the object's ACL. g[et_access] Displays the permissions granted in the specified object's ACL to the principal that invoked acl_edit. h[elp] [command ...] Initiates the help facility. If you enter only the command help, acl_edit displays a list of all commands and their functions. If you enter help and a command (or commands separated by a space), acl_edit displays help information on the specified commands. Entering help sec_acl_entry displays information about ACL entries. k[ill_entries] Removes all ACL entries except the user_obj entry if it exists. l[ist] Lists the entries in the object's ACL. m[odify] acl_entry [-n | -c] Adds a new ACL entry or replaces an existing ACL entry. This command affects a single ACL entry. To add or replace all of an object's ACL entries, see the su[bstitute] subcommand. For objects that support the mask_obj entry type and are required to calculate a new mask when their ACLs are modified, the -n option specifies that a new mask should not be calculated; the -c option specifies that the object's mask_obj entry should have permissions equal to the union of all entries other than user_obj, other_obj, and unauthenticated. The mask is calculated after the ACL is modified. If you use the -c option, the new mask is set even if it grants permissions previously masked out. It is recommended that you use the -c option only if not specifying it results in an error. If the new mask unintentionally grants permissions to an existing entry, the modify operation causing the mask recalculation will abort with an error unless you specify either the -c or -n option. p[ermissions] Lists the available permission tokens and explanations. pu[rge] Purges all masked permissions. This option is useful only for ACLs that contain an entry of type mask_obj. Use it to prevent unintentionally granting permissions to an existing entry when a new mask is calculated as a result of adding or modifying an ACL entry. su[bstitute] acl_entry [acl_entry ...] Replaces all ACL entries with the one or ones specified. This subcommand removes all existing entries and adds the ones specified by acl_entry. To replace only a single ACL entry, see the m[odify] subcommand. t[est_access] [permissions ...] Tests whether or not the permissions specified in the command are granted to the principal under whose DCE identity the acl_edit command was invoked. The option returns Granted if the permissions are granted or Denied if they are not. ACL ENTRIES An ACL entry has the following syntax: type[:key]:permissions where: type Identifies the role of the ACL entry. key Identifies the specific principal or group to whom the entry applies. For an entry type of extended, key contains the ACL data. permissions The ACL permissions. A thorough description of each syntax component follows. Type The type tag identifies the role of the ACL entry. Valid types are the following: + user_obj - Permissions for the object's real or effective user. + group_obj - Permissions for the object's real or effective group. + other_obj - Permissions for others in the local cell who are not otherwise named by a more specific entry type. + user - Permissions for a specific principal user in the ACL's cell. This type of ACL entry must include a key that identifies the specific principal. + group - Permissions for a specific group in the ACL's cell. This type of ACL entry must include a key that identifies the specific group. + foreign_user Permissions for a specific, authenticated user in a foreign cell. This type of ACL entry must include a key that identifies the specific principal and the principal's cell. + foreign_group Permissions for a specific, authenticated group in a foreign cell. This type of ACL entry must include a key that identifies the specific group and the group's cell. + foreign_other Permissions for all authenticated principals in a specific foreign cell, unless those principals are specifically named in an ACL entry of type foreign_user or members in a group named in an entry of type foreign_group. This type of ACL entry must include a key that identifies the specific foreign cell. + any_other - Permissions for all authenticated principals unless those principals match a more specific entry in the ACL. + mask_obj - Permissions for the object mask that is applied to all entry types except user_obj, other_obj, and unauthenticated. + unauthenticated Maximum permissions applied when the accessor does not pass authentication procedures. This entry is used for principals that have failed authentica- tion due to bad keys, principals who are entirely outside of any authentication cell, and principals who choose not to use authenticated access. Permissions granted to an unauthenticated principal are masked with this entry, if it exists. If this entry does not exist, access to unauthenticated principals is always denied. + extended - A special entry that allows client applications running at earlier DCE versions to copy ACLs to and from ACL Managers running at the current DCE version without losing any data. The extended entry allows the application running at the lower version to obtain a printable form of the ACL. The extended ACL entry has the following form: extended:uuid.ndr.ndr.ndr.ndr.number_of_byte.data where: uuid Identifies the type extended ACL entry. (This UUID can identify one of the ACL entry types described here or an as-yet- undefined ACL entry type.) ndr.ndr.ndr.ndr Up to three Network Data Representation (NDR) format labels (in hexadecimal format and separated by periods) that identify the encoding of data. number_of_bytes A decimal number that specifies the total number of bytes in data. data The ACL data in hexadecimal form. (Each byte of ACL data is two hexadecimal digits.) The ACL data includes all of the ACL entry specifications except the permissions (described later) that are entered separately. The data is not interpreted; it is assumed that the ACL Manager to which the data is being passed can understand that data. Key The key identifier (principal or group name) specifies the principal or group to which the ACL entry applies. For entries of entry type extended, key is the data passed from one ACL Manager to another. A key is required for the following types of ACL entries: + user - Requires a principal name only. + group - Requires a group name only. + foreign_user - Requires a fully qualified cell name in addition to the principal name. + foreign_group - Requires a fully qualified cell name in addition to the group name. + foreign_other - Requires a fully qualified cell name. Permissions The permissions argument specifies the set of permissions that defines the access rights conferred by the entry. Since each ACL Manager defines the permission tokens and meanings appropriate for the objects it controls, the actual tokens and their meanings vary. For example, the Distributed File Service, the Directory Service, and the Security Registry Service each implemhent a separate ACL Manager, and each can use a different set of tokens and permissions. This means that file system objects, objects in the namespace, and registry objects could each use different permissions. Use the p[ermissions] subcommand to display the currently available tokens and their meanings. See the documentation for the DCE component you are using to obtain a more detailed description of its specific permissions. EXAMPLES 1. The following example uses the interactive interface to set permis- sions for the unauthenticated and mask_obj entry type: sec_acl_edit> m mask_obj:rwx sec_acl_edit> m unauthenticated:r 2. The following example uses the interactive interface to set permis- sions for the effective user, group, and others in the ACL's cell: sec_acl_edit> m user_obj:crwx sec_acl_edit> m group_obj:rwx sec_acl_edit> m other_obj:rwx 3. The following example uses the command-line interface to invoke acl_edit and assign permissions for the file progress_chart to the authenticated user mike in the local cell: % acl_edit /.../dresden.com/fs/walden/progress_chart -m user:mike:cx Note that because this entry will be filtered through the object mask (mask_obj), which specifies only rwx permissions, the actual permissions will be rwx, not crwx. The l(ist) subcommand will show those permissions as follows: user:mike:crwx #effective -rwx--- 4. The following example uses the interactive interface to set permis- sions for the authenticated foreign user named burati in the cell named /.../usc-cs.uscal.edu: sec_acl_edit> m foreign_user:/.../usc-cs.uscal.edu/sailing/staff/bux 5. The following example uses the non-interactive command-line inter- face to invoke and set the Initial Container Creation permissions for the directory that is named walden: % acl_edit /.../dresden.com/fs/walden -ic -m /user:walden:crwxid
1.2 – chpass
NAME chpass - Changes user database information SYNOPSIS chpass [user] OPTIONS None ARGUMENTS user The user argument indicates the user whose database informa- tion you want to change. If omitted, you are prompted for the user. DESCRIPTION The chpass command changes user database information associated with user. Note that the functionality of the chpass command as described in this reference page can change depending on the platform on which you are running the command. Each platform vendor integrates this command (based on 4.4BSD source) with the vendor's own login facility. You can edit information associated with user only if you are user or have the appropriate rights. chpass prompts for the information it needs. The information will include all or a subset of the following list: o Login - The login name used to access the account. Because the login name controls file access, they must be unique within the cell. In multicell environments, this uniqueness is ensured by automatically appending the cell designator to the user's name. While it is possible to have multiple entries with identical login names, it is usually a mistake to do so. Routines that manipulate these files will often return only one of the multiple entries, and that one by random selection. o Password - The encrypted account password. Once the information has been verified, the network registry is updated. RELATED INFORMATION COMMANDS: login dce_login
1.3 – dce_login
NAME dce_login - Validates a principal's identity and obtains the principal's network credentials SYNOPSIS dce_login [principal_name] [password] [-c] [-e[xec] cmd_string] OPTIONS -c Causes the principal's identity to be certified. If you do not specify -c, the principal's identity is validated only. [-e[xec] cmd_string] Executes the command supplied as cmd_string. ARGUMENTS principal_name The name of the principal to log in as. password The password for principal_name. DESCRIPTION The dce_login command is supplied for use in DCE configuration. It vali- dates a principal's identity and obtains the principal's network creden- tials. If the -c option is supplied, the command also certifies the principal's identity, and, if the principal is able to be certified, creates an entry for the principal in the machine's local registry. If the principal is not able to be certified, the command attempts to log the principal in via the local registry. The -exec option executes the command specified by cmd_string after login. If cmd_string is specified without a full pathname, the path prefix is obtained by searching the directories according to the PATH variable. The principal_name argument specifies the name of the principal who is logging in. The password argument specifies the principal's password. If you do not supply a principal name or a principal password, dce_login prompts for them. If you enter them both on the command line, you must specify the principal name first, followed by the password. The dce_login command executes the shell specified in the SHELL environ- ment variable. Note that if the clocks on the Security server and client machines are not synchronized to within 2 or 3 minutes of each other, you may receive a password validation error and be unable to be validated.
1.4 – kdestroy
NAME kdestroy - Destroys a principal's login context and associated credentials SYNOPSIS kdestroy [-c cache_name] OPTIONS -c cache_name Specifies that the login context and associated credentials for cache_name should be destroyed instead of the default cache. DESCRIPTION The kdestroy command destroys a principal's login context and the principal's credentials. Until the credentials are reestablished by either executing the dce_login command or the kinit command, the principal and any processes created by the principal will be limited to unauthenticated access. FILES dce$local:[var.security.creds]DCECRED* If the KRB5CCNAME logical name is set, the default credentials cache. RELATED INFORMATION COMMANDS: klist kinit
1.5 – kinit
NAME kinit - Obtains and caches ticket-granting ticket SYNOPSIS kinit [-c cachename] [-f] [-l lifetime] [-p] [-r lifetime] [-v] [principal] OPTIONS -c cachename Specifies an alternative credentials cache, cachename, to be used in place of the default credentials cache. The kinit command overwrites the contents of the alternative cache with the current credentials. The name of the default credentials cache may vary between systems. However, if the KRB5CCNAME logical name is set, its value is used to name the default cache. -f Requests the FORWARDABLE option. This option allows a ticket- granting ticket with a different network address than the present ticket-granting ticket to be issued to the principal. For forwardable tickets to be granted, the principal's account in the registry must specify that the principal can be granted forwardable tickets. -l lifetime Specifies the lifetime of the ticket-granting ticket in hours. If this option is not specified, the default ticket lifetime (set by each site using the rgy_edit command) is used. -p Requests the PROXIABLE option. This option allows a ticket with a different network address than the present ticket to be issued to the principal. For proxiable tickets to be granted, the principal's account in the registry must specify that the principal can be granted proxiable tickets. -r lifetime Requests the RENEWABLE option. This option allows the tickets issued to the principal to be renewed. For renewable tickets to be granted, the principal's account in the registry must specify that the principal can be granted renewable tickets. The lifetime of the ticket-granting ticket is specified in hours by lifetime. -v Specifies that the command should run in verbose mode. ARGUMENTS principal The principal argument specifies the name of the principal for whom the ticket-granting ticket should be obtained. If principal is omitted, the principal name from the existing cache is reused. DESCRIPTION The kinit command can be used to refresh a DCE credentials cache. When you invoke kinit, it prompts for your password. The ticket lifetime and renewable lifetime are set in the following format: {num {interval}}... where: num A number that specifies the number of the interval; interval can be specified by the following: + w - weeks + d - days + h - hours + m - minutes + s - seconds For example, to set the lifetime to 3 weeks, 5 days, and 10 hours, the entry would be the following: 3w5d10h FILES dce$local:[var.security.creds]DCECRED* If the KRB5CCNAME logical name is not set, the name of the file is in the form shown. If the KRB5CCNAME logical name is set, its setting determines the name of the file. RELATED INFORMATION COMMANDS: klist kdestroy
1.6 – klist
NAME klist - Lists cached tickets SYNOPSIS klist [-c cachename] [-e] [-f] OPTIONS -c cachename Specifies that the contents of the cache identified by cachename should be displayed instead of the contents of the default cache. -e Includes expired tickets in the display. Without this option, only current tickets are displayed. -f Displays option settings on the tickets. The options are + D (postdatable) + d (postdated) F (forwardable) + f (forwarded) + I (initial) + i (invalid) + P (proxiable) + p (proxy) + R (renewable) DESCRIPTION The klist command lists the primary principal and tickets held in the default credentials cache, or in the cache identified by cachename if the -c option is used. The name of the default credentials cache can vary between systems. How- ever, if the KRB5CCNAME logical name is set, its value is used to name the default cache. If it is not set, the form of the name is dce$local:[var.security.creds]DCECRED*. RELATED INFORMATION COMMANDS: kinit kdestroy krb5
1.7 – DCE$EXPORT
The DCE EXPORT utility allows you to create an OpenVMS authorization file from an existing DCE registry. The DCE registry entries (or a subset of the registry entries) are converted into records in the OpenVMS SYSUAF file and rights database. Conversions are essentially a reversal of those made with the IMPORT function. Passwords cannot be exported. Instead, the automatic synchronization feature that occurs during integrated login is used to export user pass- words. The DCE EXPORT utility also creates and maintains an exclude list. The exclude list contains the DCE names of users who do not have, and do not require, an OpenVMS account. This feature allows DCE EXPORT to skip over these users during EXPORT operations. NOTE: The DCE EXPORT utility described in this section cannot be satisfied by the export function shipped with OSF DCE because of substantial differences between OpenVMS and UNIX user registry data.
1.7.1 – File Info
The DCE EXPORT utility is shipped as an OpenVMS executable image named DCE$EXPORT.EXE. The image resides in the SYS$SYSTEM directory. The DCE EXPORT exclude file is named by default DCE$EXPORT_EXCLUDE.DAT and also resides in SYS$SYSTEM. You can change the name or location, or both, of this file by defining the logical name DCE$EXPORT_EXCLUDE to point to the new filename and location.
1.7.2 – Running EXPORT
The DCE EXPORT utility allows system administrators to create an OpenVMS authorization file from an existing DCE registry. Integrated Login provides two methods of running the DCE EXPORT utility, as follows. o By invoking the DCE EXPORT utility using a predefined symbol. $ EXPORT EXPORT> You can also specify a single DCE EXPORT command on the command line. Control returns to DCL after the command is executed. $ EXPORT command $ SYS$COMMON:[SYSMGR]DCE$DEFINE_REQUIRED_COMMANDS.COM defines the DCE symbol EXPORT, which is used to invoke the DCE EXPORT utility. If this symbol is not defined in your environment, you can define the symbol as follows: $ EXPORT :== $SYS$SYSTEM:DCE$EXPORT o By issuing the RUN command. $ RUN SYS$SYSTEM:DCE$EXPORT EXPORT> See the HP DCE for OpenVMS Alpha and OpenVMS I64 Reference Guide for detailed descriptions of the EXPORT commands.
1.7.3 – Messages
1.7.3.1 – EXP_ACCEXISTS
OpenVMS account for <principal> already exists Explanation: Could not export <principal> because it has already been exported. User Action: None.
1.7.3.2 – EXP_ADDDCEACC
account for <principal> successfully added to OpenVMS Explanation: An OpenVMS acount was successfully created for <principal>. User Action: Note directly preceding and following messages for warnings.
1.7.3.3 – EXP_ADDDCEUAF
principal <principal> successfully added to DCE$UAF Explanation: Principal <principal> successfully added to the DCE$UAF file as part of the EXPORT operation. Message displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the EXPORT command line. User Action: None.
1.7.3.4 – EXP_ADDUAF
principal <principal> successfully exported to OpenVMS Explanation: An OpenVMS account for successfully created for DCE <principal>. User Action: Note directly preceding and following messages for warnings.
1.7.3.5 – EXP_BINDERR
error binding to DCE security registry Explanation: Cannot connect to the DCE security server. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.6 – EXP_CREDCEUAF
created new DCE$UAF file Explanation: A new DCE$UAF file was created. User Action: None.
1.7.3.7 – EXP_DCEERR
<DCE error message> Explanation: Accompanying DCE error message. User Action: Use this message to solve the problem generating the error.
1.7.3.8 – EXP_DCELOGIN
error in DCE login Explanation: Could not perform a DCE login. User Action: Enter valid DCE principal and password combination.
1.7.3.9 – EXP_DCEUAFERR
error searching DCE$UAF Explanation: Error searching or reading DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.10 – EXP_DELDCEUAF
principal <principal> successfully deleted from DCE$UAF Explanation: Principal <principal> successfully deleted from DCE$UAF as part of larger delete operation. Message is displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the EXPORT command line. User Action: None.
1.7.3.11 – EXP_DISUSER
<username> remains DISUSER-ed Explanation: OpenVMS account for <username> was successfully created but could not enable the account. User Action: Manually remove the DISUSER flag using the AUTHORIZE utility.
1.7.3.12 – EXP_ERRACCEXC
error accessing DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not access DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.13 – EXP_ERRADDEXC
error adding principal to DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not add principal to DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.14 – EXP_ERRADDUAF
error adding principal to DCE$UAF file Explanation: Could not add principal name to DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.15 – EXP_ERRCRACC
error creating OpenVMS account for <username> Explanation: Could not create an OpenVMS account for <username>. User Action: See accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.16 – EXP_ERRCRDCEUAF
error creating DCE authorization file Explanation: An error occurred while attempting to create the DCE$UAF file. User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.7.3.17 – EXP_ERRCREUAF
error creating OpenVMS account for <username> - see following messages Explanation: Could not create the OpenVMS account for <username>. User Action: Note accompanying error messages for more details.
1.7.3.18 – EXP_ERRDCEUAF
error accessing DCE authorization file Explanation: An error occurred while attempting to access the DCE$UAF file. User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.7.3.19 – EXP_ERRDELEXC
error deleting principal from DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not delete principal from DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.20 – EXP_ERRDELUAF
error deleting principal from DCE$UAF file Explanation: Could not delete principal from DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.21 – EXP_ERRENAUSR
error enabling user <username> Explanation: Could not remove DISUSER flag from <username>'s account. User Action: Manually remove the flag using the AUTHORIZE utility.
1.7.3.22 – EXP_ERRQUOTA
error assigning disk quota to username <username> - see following messages Explanation: Error(s) occurred while attempting to set up disk quota for <username> User Action: Note the messages following this message.
1.7.3.23 – EXP_ERRSETPW
error setting password for <username> Explanation: Could not set password for OpenVMS <username>. User Action: Manually set password using the AUTHORIZE utility.
1.7.3.24 – EXP_ERRSPAWN
error spawning subprocess Explanation: Error spawning subprocess with the SPAWN command. User Action: Check user runtime configuration. Refer to appropriate OpenVMS documentation for more details.
1.7.3.25 – EXP_ERRSYSUAF
error accessing SYSUAF file Explanation: Could not access the SYSUAF file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.26 – EXP_ERRUAFGET
error getting SYSUAF information Explanation: Error accessing information in the SYSUAF file. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more information.
1.7.3.27 – EXP_EXCADD
principal <principal> added to DCE EXPORT exclude list Explanation: Principal <principal> successfully added to the DCE EXPORT exclude list. User Action: None.
1.7.3.28 – EXP_EXCDEL
principal <principal> removed from DCE EXPORT exclude list Explanation: Principal <principal> successfully deleted from the DCE EXPORT exclude list. User Action: None.
1.7.3.29 – EXP_EXCLUDED
principal <principal> has been excluded from OpenVMS Explanation: Unable to export <principal> because it is on the DCE EXPORT exclude list. This message is displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the EXPORT command line. User Action: If incorrectly excluded, use DELETE/EXCLUDE to remove it from the DCE EXPORT exclude list and reexport.
1.7.3.30 – EXP_GRPUICFULL
no member UIC available in specified group Explanation: No more members available in the specified group. User Action: Use another group UIC if possible.
1.7.3.31 – EXP_INDCEUAF
principal <principal> already in DCE$UAF Explanation: Could not add already existing principal name to DCE$UAF. User Action: None.
1.7.3.32 – EXP_INEXCLUDE
principal <principal> already in DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: An attempt was made to add an already existing principal name to the DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: None.
1.7.3.33 – EXP_INITERROR
initialization error Explanation: Error during initialization phase for DCE EXPORT. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.34 – EXP_INITWAIT
initializing..... Explanation: DCE EXPORT in initialization phase. User Action: None.
1.7.3.35 – EXP_INPREQ
input required! Explanation: Input not entered where mandatory. User Action: Provide input.
1.7.3.36 – EXP_INTERROR
internal error Explanation: Internal error in DCE EXPORT. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details or submit a Quality Assurance Report (QAR).
1.7.3.37 – EXP_INTINPDEV
internal error opening input device Explanation: Error accessing SYS$INPUT. User Action: Check user runtime configuration. Refer to appropriate OpenVMS documentation for more information.
1.7.3.38 – EXP_INVGRPUIC
invalid group UIC Explanation: Group UIC entered is invalid (format if value, name if identifier). User Action: Enter valid group UIC.
1.7.3.39 – EXP_INVMEMUIC
invalid member UIC Explanation: Member UIC entered is out of range or of invalid format. User Action: Enter valid member UIC.
1.7.3.40 – EXP_INVMS
principal <principal> already exported to OpenVMS Explanation: A record for <principal> already exists in the DCE$UAF file indicating that is has already been exported. User Action: None.
1.7.3.41 – EXP_INVPASSWD
password validation failed. Please retry Explanation: Password validation failed while entering password for the OpenVMS account to be created. User Action: Enter valid password.
1.7.3.42 – EXP_INVPWDLEN
password length must be between <minimum> and <maximum> characters Explanation: The user specified password for the OpenVMS account is outside of the defined range. User Action: Specify a password of length between <minimum> and <maximum>
1.7.3.43 – EXP_NAMEINUSE
OpenVMS username <username> already mapped to another DCE principal Explanation: OpenVMS username specified is already associated with another DCE principal in the DCE$UAF file. User Action: Specify a username that is not associated with a DCE princi- pal. Use the DCE$UAF utility to search the DCE$UAF file for usernames and associated DCE principal names.
1.7.3.44 – EXP_NODCEUAF
unable to open DCE authorization file Explanation: Error occurred while attempting to open the DCE$UAF file. User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.7.3.45 – EXP_NOEXCUSR
no excluded users Explanation: No principal names listed in the DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: None.
1.7.3.46 – EXP_NOSCHUSR
no principal <principal> in DCE registry Explanation: Principal <principal> requested for export does not exist in the DCE registry. User Action: Use valid DCE principal name. Use the DCE tool RGY_EDIT to view DCE principal names.
1.7.3.47 – EXP_NOSUCHEXC
no such principal in DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: Requested principal does not exist in DCE EXPORT exclude file. User Action: Use the SHOW/EXCLUDE command to list names in the exclude file.
1.7.3.48 – EXP_NOSUCHPR
no DCE account <principal> Explanation: An attempt was made to export a nonexistent DCE principal. User Action: Specify a valid DCE principal name. Use the DCE tool RGY_EDIT to view the DCE principals.
1.7.3.49 – EXP_NOTINEXC
principal <principal> not in DCE EXPORT exclude file Explanation: An attempt was made to access a nonexistent record in the DCE EXPORT file. User Action: Use SHOW/EXCLUDE to see the contents of the exclude file.
1.7.3.50 – EXP_NOVMSUSR
no OpenVMS user <username> Explanation: A nonexistent OpenVMS username was specified with the /LIKE qualifier. User Action: Specify a valid OpenVMS username.
1.7.3.51 – EXP_NXTMEMUIC
error finding next available member UIC Explanation: Could not find the next available member UIC in the group specified. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.52 – EXP_OUTOPNERR
error opening alternate output Explanation: Could not access file name specified with /OUTPUT qualifier. User Action: Note accompanying error message for more details.
1.7.3.53 – EXP_SEEFILE
see file <file name> for error messages Explanation: Error(s) occurred while creating the OpenVMS account but EXPORT was unable to display the error messages. The user is asked to read the file <file name> for the error messages. User Action: Read the file <file name> for error messages.
1.7.3.54 – EXP_TIMERR
DCE time configuration error Explanation: Time configuration is incorrect on the DCE system. User Action: Refer to the Troubleshooting chapter in the HP DCE for OpenVMS Alpha and OpenVMS I64 Product Guide.
1.7.3.55 – EXP_TOOLONG
input for <qualifier> too long Explanation: Value of <qualifer> is longer than expected maximum size of value. User Action: Enter a value that is within the valid size range.
1.7.3.56 – EXP_USERERR
error getting input from user Explanation: User entered invalid input. User Action: Enter valid input.
1.7.4 – ADD
Adds DCE principal names. The ADD command can only be used with the following qualifier: o ADD/EXCLUDE Adds a DCE principal name to the EXPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Adds a DCE principal name to the EXPORT exclude list. Format: ADD/EXCLUDE PRINCIPAL Parameters principal Specifies the DCE principal name to be added to the EXPORT exclude list. If the principal name contains lowercase characters, spaces, or other special characters, enclose the entire string in quotes.
1.7.5 – DELETE
Deletes DCE principal names. The DELETE command can only be used with the following qualifier: o DELETE/EXCLUDE Deletes a DCE principal name from the EXPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Deletes a DCE principal name from the EXPORT exclude list. Format: DELETE/EXCLUDE PRINCIPAL Parameters principal Specifies the DCE principal name to be deleted from the EXPORT exclude list. If the principal name contains lowercase characters, spaces, or other special characters, enclose the entire string is quotes.
1.7.6 – EXIT
Exits the EXPORT utility. You can also exit EXPORT by pressing the Ctrl/Z key. Format: EXIT
1.7.7 – EXPORT
The EXPORT command is used to create OpenVMS accounts in the OpenVMS system authorization file (SYSUAF) based on existing accounts in the DCE registry. Format: EXPORT DCE-ACCOUNT-NAME Qualifiers Defaults /[NO]ADD_IDENTIFIERS /ADD_IDENTIFIERS /[NO]CONFIRM /DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=value[,...]) /[NO]EXCLUDE /NOEXCLUDE /[NO]INFORM /INFORM /[NO]INTERACTIVE /INTERACTIVE /OUTPUT[=output] /OUTPUT=SYS$OUTPUT: /[NO]RECAP /NORECAP /[NO]TEST_ONLY /NOTEST_ONLY /[NO]WILD /WILD Data Qualifiers Defaults /[NO]ACCOUNT=account /ACCOUNT=dce-group-name /DEVICE=device Taken from /LIKE account /DIRECTORY=directory /DIRECTORY=vms-username /GROUP_UIC=group_uic /LIKE=vms-account /LIKE=DEFAULT /MEMBER_UIC=member_uic Next available within UIC group /[NO]OWNER=owner /OWNER=dce-principal-name /PASSWORD=passwd None /[NO]QUOTA=n /QUOTA=1000 /USERNAME=username /USERNAME=dce-principal-name
1.7.7.1 – Parameters
dce-account-name Specifies the name of the DCE account that is to be exported. If the DCE account name contains lowercase characters, spaces or other special characters then enclose the name in quotes. If an asterisk is specified in place of the dce-account- name then all accounts from the registry are selected.
1.7.7.2 – Qualifiers
/CONFIRM /CONFIRM /NOCONFIRM Controls whether the EXPORT command asks for confirmation before creating the OpenVMS account. In interactive mode the default is /CONFIRM. In noninteractive mode the default is /NOCONFIRM. /DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=value[,...]) /DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=value[,...]) Provides DCE account details for accounts that are authorized to read pricipals and accounts from the DCE registry. Valid keywords for the DCE_LOGIN qualifier are as follows: Keyword Description PRINCIPAL The principal name to be used for authentication purposes when reading accounts and/or principals from the DCE registry. If you do not specify a principal with this qualifier you are prompted for one interactively. PASSWORD The password associated with the principal name that was specified by the PRINCIPAL keyword. If you do not specify a password with this qualifier you are prompted for one interactively. If you do not specify a principal or password with this qualifi- er, you are prompted for them interactively, regardless of whether or not you are running in interactive mode. This infor- mation need be entered only once per session, on the first EXPORT command.Subsequent EXPORT commands within the same session do not require that you to reenter this information. If you are an interactive user and you do not specify the PASSWORD keyword, EXPORT prompts you for your password. The advantage in this is the password is not echoed and therefore does not appear on your terminal. /EXCLUDE /EXCLUDE /NOEXCLUDE (default) Determines whether the DCE account is exported to OpenVMS. If the DCE account is not exported, the OpenVMS account is not created and an entry is created in the EXPORT exclude file for the specified DCE account. /INFORM /INFORM (default) /NOINFORM Determines whether the user is informed of DCE accounts that would have been selected for export, but are not selected. (The reasons that accounts are not selected for export are that they have already been exported (for example, they have an entry in the DCE$UAF) or that they exist in the EXPORT exclude file.) /INTERACTIVE (default) /INTERACTIVE (default) /NOINTERACTIVE Controls whether an interactive or noninteractive export is performed. In interactive mode, a series of questions is asked and the user's responses are used to determine the account details. This mode is well suited to interactive users. In noninteractive mode, all input is supplied through the data qualifiers, and any missing or conflicting data causes the OpenVMS account to not be created. This mode is well suited to command files and batch jobs. Data qualifiers can be specified in interactive mode. In this case the data they provide is used to provide the default answers to the relevant questions. All questions are still asked. /OUTPUT[=output] /OUTPUT[=output] Defines where all program output should be written. The default is SYS$OUTPUT:. /RECAP /RECAP /NORECAP (default) If /RECAP is specified details of the OpenVMS account are dis- played before it is actually created. When /CONFIRM is also specified the account details are displayed immediately before the confirmation request. /TEST_ONLY /TEST_ONLY /NOTEST_ONLY (default) If /TEST_ONLY is specified, OpenVMS accounts, identifiers, and DCE$UAF entries are not created. All other functions operate normally. /WILD /WILD (default) /NOWILD Specifies whether or not standard VMS wildcarding is to be applied to dce-account-name. The default is /WILD which means a dce-account-name of "SM*" is interpreted as meaning "export any account starting SM". If /NOWILD is specified the dce-account-name "SM*" is exported.
1.7.7.3 – Data Qualifiers
1.7.7.3.1 /ACCOUNT=account
/ACCOUNT=account (default) [NO]ACCOUNT Specifies the account string for the OpenVMS account (same as /ACCOUNT in AUTHORIZE). The account is a string of 1 to 8 alphanumeric characters. If this qualifier is not specified, the DCE account's group name is used (truncated to 8 characters if necessary). If no account field is required then specify /NOACCOUNT.
1.7.7.3.2 /DEVICE=device
/DEVICE=device Specifies the name of the OpenVMS account's default device at login. The device-name is a string of 1 to 31 alphanumeric characters. If you omit the colon from the device-name value, a colon is automatically appended. The default device is copy the device field from the account specified by the /LIKE qualifier.
1.7.7.3.3 /DIRECTORY=directory
/DIRECTORY=directory Specifies the default directory name for the DIRECTORY field of the OpenVMS SYSUAF record. The directory name can be 1 to 63 alphanumeric characters. If you do not enclose the directory name in brackets, EXPORT adds the brackets for you. The default directory name is [username] where username is the OpenVMS account's username.
1.7.7.3.4 /GROUP_UIC=group_uic
/GROUP_UIC=group_uic Specifies the group part of the UIC for the OpenVMS account. GROUP_UIC can be specified as an octal group UIC code or as an existing group UIC identifier. If specified as an octal number, it must be in the range 1 to 37776 (octal). The default is to take the OpenVMS account's ACCOUNT field, convert it to uppercase, and interpret this as a group UIC identifier. If such an identifier does not exist then a similar translation is attempted for the DCE account's group name. If neither identifiers exist, the group UIC is derived from the OpenVMS account specified by the /LIKE qualifier.
1.7.7.3.5 /LIKE=vms-account
/LIKE=vms-account Specifies an existing OpenVMS account that is to be used as the basis for the OpenVMS account that is being created. Any fields not specified on the EXPORT command line, as well as all quotas, privileges, etc, are inherited from the /LIKE account. The default is DEFAULT (as it is in AUTHORIZE).
1.7.7.3.6 /MEMBER_UIC=member_uic
/MEMBER_UIC=member_uic Specifies the member part of the UIC for the OpenVMS account. MEMBER_UIC should be specified as an octal number within the range 0 to 177776 (octal). The default is to use the first available member UIC within the group UIC (as specified by /GROUP_UIC). For example, if the selected group is 150 and that group has members 1, 2, 5 and 6 already defined, then the new uic would be [150,3].
1.7.7.3.7 /OWNER=owner (default)
/OWNER=owner (default) /NOOWNER Specifies the owner string for the OpenVMS account (same as /OWNER in AUTHORIZE). The owner is a string of 1 to 31 characters. If this qualifier is not specified, the DCE account's principal name is used (truncated to 31 characters if necessary). If no owner field is required, specify /NOOWNER.
1.7.7.3.8 /PASSWORD=passwd
/PASSWORD=passwd Specifies the password for the OpenVMS account. Passwords contain from 0 to 32 characters and can include alphanumeric characters, dollar signs, and underscores. Passwords are not case-sensitive. If you do not specify a password, the account is created without a valid OpenVMS password.
1.7.7.3.9 /QUOTA=quota
/QUOTA=quota (default) /NOQUOTA Specifies the disk quota for the device specified by /DEVICE to be given to the OpenVMS account (if quotas are enabled on that volume). The default is 1000 blocks. If quotas are not enabled on the device specified by /DEVICE, or if /NOQUOTA is specified, then no quota is given.
1.7.7.3.10 /USERNAME=username
/USERNAME=username Specifies the username for the OpenVMS account. The username is a string of 1 to 12 alphanumeric characters and can contain underscores. If this qualifier is not specified, the DCE account's principal name is used (truncated to 12 characters and uppercased).
1.7.8 – SHOW
Displays DCE principal names. The SHOW command can only be used with the following qualifier: o SHOW/EXCLUDE Displays DCE principal names in the EXPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Displays DCE principal names in the EXPORT exclude list. Format: SHOW/EXCLUDE [PRINCIPAL] Qualifiers Defaults /ALL /OUTPUT=output /OUTPUT=SYS$OUTPUT:
1.7.8.1 – Parameters
principal Specifies the name of the DCE principal to be displayed from the EXPORT exclude list. Full OpenVMS wildcarding is allowed. If the principal name contains lowercase characters, spaces, or other special characters, enclose the entire string is quotes. If /ALL is on the command line, do not specify a principal name.
1.7.8.2 – Qualifiers
1.7.8.2.1 /ALL
/ALL Specifies that all EXPORT exclude entries are to be displayed. If you do not specify principal, then /ALL is assumed.
1.7.8.2.2 /OUTPUT=output
/OUTPUT=output Determines where the output is written. The default is SYS$OUTPUT:.
1.8 – DCE$IMPORT
The DCE IMPORT utility allows you to create principal and account entries in a DCE registry based on accounts in an existing OpenVMS authorization file. It is used for the following purposes: o To populate the DCE registry when a new DCE cell is first established o To add entries to an existing DCE registry when a new OpenVMS system joins an existing DCE cell o To add entries to an existing DCE registry when new users have joined an OpenVMS sytem that is already part of an existing DCE cell The DCE IMPORT utility also creates and maintains an exclude list. The exclude list contains the OpenVMS usernames of users who do not have, and do not require, a DCE account. This feature allows DCE IMPORT to skip over these users during DCE IMPORT operations. NOTE: The DCE IMPORT utility described in this section cannot be satisfied by the import function shipped with OSF DCE because of substantial differences between OpenVMS and UNIX user registry data. Passwords cannot be imported. Instead, the automatic synchronization feature that occurs during integrated login is used to import user passwords. See the HP DCE for OpenVMS Alpha and OpenVMS I64 Reference Guide for detailed descriptions of the DCE IMPORT commands. RELATED INFORMATION COMMANDS: DCE$EXPORT
1.8.1 – File Info
The DCE DCE IMPORT utility is shipped as an OpenVMS executable image named DCE$IMPORT.EXE. The image resides in the SYS$SYSTEM directory. The DCE IMPORT exclude file is named by default DCE$IMPORT_EXCLUDE.DAT and also resides in SYS$SYSTEM. You can change the name or location, or both, of this file by defining the logical name DCE$IMPORT_EXCLUDE to point to the new filename and location.
1.8.2 – Running IMPORT
The DCE IMPORT utility allows system administrators to create princi- pal and account entries in a DCE registry based on accounts in SYSUAF. Integrated Login provides two methods of running the DCE IMPORT utility, as follows. o By invoking the DCE IMPORT utility using a predefined symbol. $ IMPORT IMPORT> You can also specify a single DCE IMPORT command on the command line. Control returns to DCL after the command is executed. $ IMPORT command SYS$COMMON:[SYSMGR]DCE$DEFINE_REQUIRED_COMMANDS.COM defines the DCE symbol IMPORT which is used to invoke the DCE IMPORT utility. If this symbol is not defined in your environment, you can define the symbol as follows: $ IMPORT :== $SYS$SYSTEM:DCE$IMPORT o By issuing the RUN command. $ RUN SYS$SYSTEM:DCE$IMPORT IMPORT>
1.8.3 – Messages
1.8.3.1 – IMP_ACCEXISTS
account for <principal> already exists in DCE Explanation: An attempt has been made to recreate an account for <principal> in the DCE registry. User Action: None. This is a warning indicating that this suboperation in the IMPORT operation was previously performed.
1.8.3.2 – IMP_ADDDCE
username <username> successfully imported into DCE Explanation: A DCE account has been successfully created for OpenVMS username <username>. User Action: None.
1.8.3.3 – IMP_ADDDCEACC
account for <principal> successfully added to DCE Explanation: A DCE account was successfully created for <principal>. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.4 – IMP_ADDDCEPRN
principal <principal> successfully added to DCE Explanation: Principal <principal> record successfully created in the DCE registry. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.5 – IMP_ADDDCEUAF
username <username> successfully added to DCE$UAF Explanation: Username <username> successfully added to the DCE$UAF file. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.6 – IMP_BINDERR
error binding to DCE security registry Explanation: Unable to bind to the DCE security server. User Action: Note accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.7 – IMP_CREDCEUAF
created new DCE$UAF file Explanation: A new DCE$UAF file was created. User Action: None.
1.8.3.8 – IMP_DCEERR
<DCE error message> Explanation: Accompanying DCE error message supplied with other DCE IMPORT error messages. User Action: Use this message to determine the cause of the problem.
1.8.3.9 – IMP_DCELOGIN
error in DCE login Explanation: An error occurred during DCE login. User Action: Enter a valid DCE username and password when prompted by DCE IMPORT.
1.8.3.10 – IMP_DCEUAFERR
error searching DCE$UAF Explanation: An error occurred while searching the DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.11 – IMP_DELACC
account for principal <principal> deleted from DCE Explanation: DCE account for <principal> was deleted from the DCE registry. This occurs when an atomic IMPORT operation fails during one of its suboperations. Such failure prompts a backout of all suboperations successfully performed during this IMPORT operation. Deleting the account is one such backout operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.12 – IMP_DELDCEUAF
username <username> successfully deleted from DCE$UAF Explanation: Username <username> deleted from DCE$UAF file. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only if /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.13 – IMP_DELFRGRP
principal <principal> from group <group> Explanation: Principal <principal> was deleted from <group> in the DCE registry. This occurs when an atomic IMPORT operation fails during one of its suboperations. Such failure prompts a backout of all suboperations successfully performed during this IMPORT operation. Deleting the principal from the group is one such backout operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.14 – IMP_DELFRORG
principal <principal> deleted from organization <organization> Explanation: Principal <principal> was deleted from <organization> in the DCE registry. This occurs when an atomic IMPORT operation fails during one of its suboperations. Such failure prompts a backout of all suboperations successfully performed during this IMPORT operation. Deleting the principal from the organization is one such backout operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.15 – IMP_DELPRN
principal <principal> deleted from DCE Explanation: Principal <principal> was deleted from the DCE registry. This occurs when an atomic IMPORT operation fails during one of its suboperations. Such failure prompts a backout of all suboperations successfully performed during this IMPORT operation. Deleting the principal is one such backout operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.16 – IMP_ERRADDGRP
error adding principal <principal> to group <group> Explanation: Could not add <principal> to <group> in the DCE registry. User Action: Note the accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.17 – IMP_ERRADDORG
error adding principal <principal> to organization <organization> Explanation: Could not add <principal> to <organization> in DCE registry. User Action: Note the accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.18 – IMP_ERRACCEXC
error accessing DCE IMPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not access the DCE IMPORT exclude file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.19 – IMP_ERRADDEXC
adding username to DCE IMPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not add the requested username to the DCE IMPORT exclude file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.20 – IMP_ERRADDUAF
error adding username to DCE$UAF file Explanation: Could not add the imported username to the DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.21 – IMP_ERRCRACC
error creating account for <principal> Explanation: Could not create a DCE account for <principal>. User Action: Note the accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.22 – IMP_ERRCRDCEUAF
error creating DCE authorization file Explanation: An error occurred while attempting to create the DCE$UAF file. User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.8.3.23 – IMP_ERRCRPRN
error creating principal <principal> Explanation: Could not create a principal in the DCE registry. User Action: Note the accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.24 – IMP_ERRDCEUAF
error accessing DCE authorization file Explanation: An error occurred while attempting to access the DCE$UAF file. User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.8.3.25 – IMP_ERRDELACC
error deleting account for <principal> Explanation: Unable to delete account for <principal> from DCE registry. User Action: See accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.26 – IMP_ERRDELEXC
error deleting username from DCE IMPORT exclude file Explanation: Could not remove requested username from the DCE IMPORT exclude file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.27 – IMP_ERRDELFRGRP
error deleting principal <principal> from group <group> Explanation: An error occurred while deleting <principal> from <group> in the DCE registry. This delete operation is performed if the overall IMPORT operation failed and a backout of changes applied to the DCE registry is required. User Action: See accompanying DCE message for details.
1.8.3.28 – IMP_ERRDELFRORG
error deleting principal <principal> from organization <organization> Explanation: An error occurred while deleting <principal> from <organization> in the DCE registry. This delete operation is performed if the overall IMPORT operation failed and a backout of changes applied to the DCE registry is required. User Action: See accompanying DCE message for details.
1.8.3.29 – IMP_ERRDELPRN
error deleting principal <principal> Explanation: Unable to delete <principal> from DCE registry User Action: See accompanying DCE error message for more details
1.8.3.30 – IMP_ERRDELUAF
error deleting username from DCE$UAF file Explanation: Could not delete a username from the DCE$UAF file. User Action: Note the accompanying error message for more details.
1.8.3.31 – IMP_ERRCHGAUT
error changing account authorization policy Explanation: Could not change the DCE account's authorization policy. User Action: Note the accompanying DCE error message for more details.
1.8.3.32 – IMP_ERRSPAWN
error spawning sub-process Explanation: An error occurred while spawning a subprocess on the SPAWN command. User Action: Refer to appropriate OpenVMS documentation for resolution.
1.8.3.33 – IMP_ERRSYSUAF
error accessing SYSUAF file Explanation: Could not access the OpenVMS SYSUAF file. User Action: See accompanying OpenVMS or RMS error message for more details.
1.8.3.34 – IMP_EXCADD
username <username> added to DCE IMPORT exclude list Explanation: Username <username> successfully added to the DCE IMPORT exclude file. A DCE account will not be created for this username. User Action: None.
1.8.3.35 – IMP_EXCDEL
username <username> removed from DCE IMPORT exclude list Explanation: Username <username> successfully removed from DCE IMPORT exclude file. A subsequent IMPORT session could be used to create a DCE account for this username. User Action: None.
1.8.3.36 – IMP_EXCLUDED
username <username> has been excluded from DCE Explanation: Username <username> cannot be imported since it has been excluded from the DCE registry. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.37 – IMP_INDCE
username <username> already imported into DCE Explanation: An import operation was attempted on an already imported OpenVMS username. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.38 – IMP_INDCEUAF
user <username> already in DCE$UAF Explanation: Username <username> already exists in the DCE$UAF.DAT file. User Action: None. This is a warning indicating that this suboperation in the IMPORT operation was previously performed.
1.8.3.39 – IMP_INEXCLUDE
username <username> already in DCE IMPORT exclude file Explanation: Username <username> has previously been added to the DCE IMPORT exclude file. User Action: None. This informational message is displayed when an exclude operation is attempted on an already excluded username and is displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.40 – IMP_INTINPDEV
internal error opening input device Explanation: Error opening SYS$INPUT. User Action: Verify user runtime environment. See to appropriate OpenVMS documentation for more details.
1.8.3.41 – IMP_INITERROR
initialization error Explanation: An error occurred during DCE IMPORT's initialization phase. User Action: Note error messages accompanying or directly preceding this message.
1.8.3.42 – IMP_INITWAIT
initializing..... Explanation: DCE IMPORT is in initialization mode. User Action: None.
1.8.3.43 – IMP_INVPASSWD
password validation failed. Please retry Explanation: The password entered when prompted for a retype does not match the originally entered password. User Action: Enter correct password for original and retype entry.
1.8.3.44 – IMP_INPREQ
input required! Explanation: Input not entered where input was mandatory. User Action: Provide required input.
1.8.3.45 – IMP_INTERROR
internal error Explanation: DCE IMPORT internal error occurred. User Action: Contact your support engineer or Submit a Quality Assurance Report (QAR).
1.8.3.46 – IMP_INVDATETM
invalid date/time Explanation: Date/time entered has invalid format. User Action: Enter date/time in standard format (dd-MMM-yyyy hh:mm:ss).
1.8.3.47 – IMP_NODCEUAF
unable to open DCE authorization file Explanation: Error occurred while attempting to open the DCE$UAF file User Action: See accompanying message for details.
1.8.3.48 – IMP_NOEXCUSR
no excluded users Explanation: No users listed in DCE IMPORT exclude file. User Action: None.
1.8.3.49 – IMP_NOGRP
group name not specified Explanation: Mandatory qualifier /GROUP not specified during a noninter- active IMPORT session. User Action: Provide the /GROUP qualifier with the group name on the command line.
1.8.3.50 – IMP_NOORG
organization name not specified Explanation: Mandatory qualifier /ORGANIZATION not specified during a noninteractive IMPORT session. User Action: Provide the /ORGANIZATION qualifier with the organiation name on the command line.
1.8.3.51 – IMP_NOPRIN
principal <principal> does not exist in DCE Registry Explanation: Principal <principal> does not exist in the DCE Registry. This means that <principal> does not have a corresponding OpenVMS username/account. User Action: None.
1.8.3.52 – IMP_NOSUCHEXC
no such username in exclude file Explanation: Username specified does not exist in DCE IMPORT's exclude file. User Action: Specify username that exists in DCE IMPORT's exclude file. Enter command SHOW/EXCLUDE to display the entire exclude list.
1.8.3.53 – IMP_NOSUCHGRP
no group <group>. Please choose a valid group Explanation: The group name specified is nonexistent in the DCE registry. User Action: Choose a valid group name. Use the DCE tool RGY_EDIT to search the DCE registry for group names.
1.8.3.54 – IMP_NOSUCHORG
no organization <organization>. Please choose a valid organization Explanation: The organization name specified is nonexistent in the DCE registry. User Action: Choose a valid organization name. Use the DCE tool RGY_EDIT to search the DCE registry for organization names.
1.8.3.55 – IMP_NOSCHPRM
corresponding primary principal not found in DCE Explanation: The DCE principal name specified as the primary principal while attempting to create an alias principal name is non- existent in the DCE registry. User Action: Use the correct DCE principal name. Use the DCE tool RGY_EDIT to view the DCE registry.
1.8.3.56 – IMP_NOSCHUSR
OpenVMS username <username> does not exist on this system Explanation: An attempt was made to import a nonexistent OpenVMS user. User Action: Choose a valid OpenVMS user.
1.8.3.57 – IMP_OUTOPNERR
error opening alternate output Explanation: Could not access output medium User Action: If /OUTPUT was specified, verify the file name supplied with /OUTPUT. If /OUTPUT was not specified, check user runtime environment. See appropriate OpenVMS documentation for more details.
1.8.3.58 – IMP_PREXISTS
principal <principal> already exists in DCE Explanation: An attempt has been made to add <principal> to the DCE registry. User Action: None. This is a warning indicating that this suboperation in the IMPORT operation was previously performed.
1.8.3.59 – IMP_PRINGRP
principal <principal> already exists in group <group> Explanation: An attempt was made to add <principal> to DCE group <group> when it already was a member of the group. This action was attempted during an import operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.60 – IMP_PRINORG
principal <principal> already exists in organization <organization> Explanation: An attempt was made to add <principal> to DCE organization <organization> when it was already a member of that organization. This action was attempted during an import operation. User Action: None. This is an informational message displayed only when /INFORM is specified on the DCE IMPORT command line.
1.8.3.61 – IMP_PRINUSE
principal <principal> in use by another OpenVMS username Explanation: The DCE principal name specified for the OpenVMS username being imported is associated with another OpenVMS username. User Action: Choose a DCE principal name that is not associated with any OpenVMS username.
1.8.3.62 – IMP_RANGEERR
error in entry! Number must be between 1 and 65535 Explanation: The value entered for quota is not within the desired range. User Action: Enter a number between 1 and 65535.
1.8.3.63 – IMP_TIMERR
DCE time configuration error Explanation: Time configuration incorrect on the DCE system. User Action: Refer to the Troubleshooting chapter in the HP DCE for OpenVMS Alpha and OpenVMS I64 Product Guide.
1.8.3.64 – IMP_TOOLONG
input for <qualifier> too long Explanation: Value of <qualifer> is longer than expected maximum size of value. User Action: Enter a value that is within the valid size range.
1.8.3.65 – IMP_USERERR
error getting input from user Explanation: Error occurred while getting user input. User Action: Provide valid input.
1.8.4 – ADD
Adds OpenVMS usernames. The ADD command can only be used with the following qualifier: o ADD/EXCLUDE Adds an OpenVMS username to the IMPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Adds an OpenVMS username to the IMPORT exclude list. Format: ADD/EXCLUDE USERNAME Parameters username Specifies the name of the OpenVMS account to be added to the IMPORT exclude list.
1.8.5 – DELETE
Deletes OpenVMS usernames. The DELETE command can only be used with the following qualifier: o DELETE/EXCLUDE Deletes an OpenVMS username from the IMPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Deletes an OpenVMS username from the IMPORT exclude list. Format: DELETE/EXCLUDE USERNAME Parameters username Specifies the name of the OpenVMS account to be deleted from the IMPORT exclude list.
1.8.6 – EXIT
Exits the IMPORT utility. You can also exit IMPORT by pressing the Ctrl/Z key. Format: EXIT
1.8.7 – IMPORT
The IMPORT command is used to create DCE accounts based on OpenVMS accounts from an existing System Authorization File (SYSUAF). Format: IMPORT VMS-USERNAME Qualifiers Defaults /[NO]CONFIRM /DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=value,...) /[NO]IMPORT /IMPORT /[NO]EXCLUDE /NOEXCLUDE /[NO]INFORM /INFORM /[NO]INTERACTIVE /INTERACTIVE /MY_PASSWORD=passwd None /OUTPUT[=output] /OUTPUT=SYS$OUTPUT: /[NO]RECAP /NORECAP /[NO]TEST_ONLY /NOTEST_ONLY Data Qualifiers Defaults /[NO]EXPIRATION_DATE=d /NOEXPIRATION_DATE /FLAGS=flags /GOOD_SINCE_DATE=date /GOOD_SINCE_DATE=now /GROUP=group "none" /HOME_DIRECTORY=string None /LIFETIME=hours Taken from registry authorization policy /LOGIN_SHELL=string None /MISCELLANEOUS=string None /ORGANIZATION=organiza "none" /PASSWORD=passwd No valid password /PRINCIPAL=principal /RENEWABLE_LIFETIME=ho Taken from registry authorization policy
1.8.7.1 – Parameters
vms-username Specifies the name of the OpenVMS account that is to be imported. If an asterisk is specified in place of the vms-username, all accounts from the OpenVMS system authorization file are selected.
1.8.7.2 – Qualifiers
1.8.7.2.1 /CONFIRM
/CONFIRM /NOCONFIRM Controls whether the IMPORT command asks for confirmation before creating a DCE principal or account, or both. In interactive mode the default is /CONFIRM. In non- interactive mode the default is /NOCONFIRM.
1.8.7.2.2 /DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=valud[,...])
/DCE_LOGIN=(keyword=valud[,...]) Provides DCE account details for accounts that are authorized to create pricipals and accounts in the DCE registry. Valid keywords for the DCE_LOGIN qualifier are as follows: Keyword Description PRINCIPAL The principal name to be used for authentication purposes when creating accounts and/or principals in the DCE registry. If you do not specify a principal with this qualifier you are prompted for one interactively. PASSWORD The password associated with the principal name that was specified by the PRINCIPAL keyword. If you do not specify a password with this qualifier you are prompted for one interactively. If you do not specify a principal or password with this qualifier, you are prompted for them interactively, regardless of whether or not you are running in interactive mode. This information need be entered only once per session, on the first IMPORT command. Subsequent IMPORT commands within the same session do not require you to reenter this information. If you are an interactive user and you do not specify the PASSWORD keyword, IMPORT prompts you for your password. The advantage in this is the password is not echoed and therefore does not appear on your terminal.
1.8.7.2.3 /EXCLUDE
/EXCLUDE /NOEXCLUDE (default) Determines whether or not the OpenVMS account is imported to the DCE registry. If the OpenVMS account is not imported then the DCE account is not created and instead an entry is created in the IMPORT exclude file for the specified OpenVMS account.
1.8.7.2.4 /INFORM
/INFORM (default) /NOINFORM Determines whether or not the user is informed of OpenVMS accounts that would have been selected for import, but are not because they either have already been imported (for example, they have an entry in the DCE$UAF) or they have an entry in the IMPORT exclude file.
1.8.7.2.5 /INTERACTIVE
/INTERACTIVE (default) /NOINTERACTIVE Controls whether an interactive or noninteractive import is performed. In interactive mode, a series of questions is asked and the user's responses are used to determine the account details. This mode is well suited to interactive users. In noninteractive mode, all input is supplied through the data qualifiers, and any missing or conflicting data causes the DCE account to not be created. This mode is well suited to command files and batch jobs. Data qualifiers can be specified in interactive mode. In this case the data they provide is used to provide the default answers to the relevant questions. All questions are still asked.
1.8.7.2.6 /MY_PASSWORD=passwd
/MY_PASSWORD=passwd DCE requires that you specify your current DCE password for authentication purposes. If you do not specify your DCE password with this qualifier you are prompted for it interactively, regardless of if you are running in interactive mode or not. Omitting this qualifier and allowing IMPORT to prompt you for your DCE password has the advantage that in this case the password is not echoed and does therefore not appear on your terminal if you are an interactive user. OUTPUT[=output] /OUTPUT[=output] Defines where all program output should be written. The default is SYS$OUTPUT:.
1.8.7.2.7 /RECAP
/RECAP /NORECAP (default) If /RECAP is specified details of the DCE account are displayed before it is actually created. When /CONFIRM is also specified the account details are displayed immediately before the confirmation request.
1.8.7.2.8 /TEST_ONLY
/TEST_ONLY /NOTEST_ONLY (default) If /TEST_ONLY is specified, DCE accounts and DCE$UAF entries are not created. All other functions operate normally.
1.8.7.3 – Data Qualifiers
1.8.7.3.1 /EXPIRATION_DATE=date
/EXPIRATION_DATE=date /NOEXPIRATION_DATE (default) Specifies the expiration date for the DCE account. If not specified, or if /NOEXPIRATION_DATE is specified, then the DCE account is created without an expiration date.
1.8.7.3.2 /FLAGS=([no]keyword[,...])
/FLAGS=([no]keyword[,...]) Specifies several attributes of the DCE account. The keywords you can specify are: Keyword Description ACCOUNT_VALID A flag that is set to determine account validity. An account without this flag set is invalid and cannot log in. The default is ACCOUNT_VALID. CLIENT A flag that is set to indicate whether or not the account is for a principal that can act as a client. The default is CLIENT. DUPLICATE_KEYS A flag that is set to determine if tickets issued to the account's principal can have duplicate keys. The default is NODUPLICATE_KEYS. FORWARDABLE_ A flag that is set to determine whether a CERTIFICATES new ticket-granting ticket with a network address that differs from the present ticket-granting ticket network address can be issued to the account's principal. (The Proxiable Certificate Flag performs the same function for service tickets.) The default is FORWARDABLE_CERTIFICATES. PASSWORD_VALID A flag that is set to determine whether the current password is valid. If this flag is not set, the next time the principal logs in to the DCE account, the system prompts the principal to change his password. The default is PASSWORD_VALID. POSTDATED_ A flag that is set to determine if tickets CERTIFICATES with a start time some time in the future can be issued to the account's principal. The default is NOPOSTDATED_CERTIFICATES. PROXIABLE_ A flag that is set to determine whether or CERTIFICATE not a new ticket with a different network address than the present ticket can be issued to the account's principal. (The Forwardable Certificate Flag performs the same function for ticket-granting tickets.) The default is NOPROXIABLE_CERTIFICATE. RENEWABLE_ A flag that is set to determine if the CERTIFICATE ticket-granting ticket issued to the account's principal can be renewed.If this flag is set the authentication service renews the ticket-granting ticket if its lifetime is valid. The default is RENEWABLE_CERTIFICATE. SERVER A flag that is set to indicate whether or not the account is for a principal that can act as a server. The default is SERVER. TGT_ A flag that is set to determine whether AUTHENTICATION or not tickets issued to the account's principal can use the ticket-granting ticket authentication mechanism. The default is TGT_AUTHENTICATION.
1.8.7.3.3 /GOOD_SINCE_DATE=date
/GOOD_SINCE_DATE=date Specifies the date and time that the account was known to be in an uncompromised state. If not specified, the Good Since Date is set to the current date and time.
1.8.7.3.4 /GROUP=group
/GROUP=group Specifies the name of an existing DCE group that is associated with the account being created. Note that if the group does not exist it is not be created by IMPORT. The default group name is "none".
1.8.7.3.5 /HOME_DIRECTORY=string
/HOME_DIRECTORY=string Specifies the directory in which the principal is placed at login. If not specified the DCE account is created without a Home Directory.
1.8.7.3.6 /LIFETIME=hours
/LIFETIME=hours Specifies the maximum amount of time, in hours, that a ticket can be valid. If not specified the Maximum Certificate Lifetime defined as registry authorization policy is used.
1.8.7.3.7 /LOGIN_SHELL=string
/LOGIN_SHELL=string Specifies the shell that is executed when a principal logs in. If not specified the DCE account is created without a login shell.
1.8.7.3.8 /MISCELLANEOUS=string
/MISCELLANEOUS=string Specifies a text string that is typically used to describe the use of the account. If not specified the DCE account is created without a miscellaneous value.
1.8.7.3.9 /ORGANIZATION=organization
/ORGANIZATION=organization Specifies the name of an existing DCE organization that is associated with the account being created. Note that if the organization does not exist it is not be created by IMPORT. The default organization name is "none".
1.8.7.3.10 /PASSWORD=passwd
/PASSWORD=passwd Specifies the password to be assigned to the DCE account. If not specified the DCE account is created without a valid DCE password.
1.8.7.3.11 /PRINCIPAL=(keyword[,...])
/PRINCIPAL=(keyword[,...]) Specifies the principal that is associated with the DCE account that is being created. If an existing principal is to be associated with the DCE account being created then you need only specify NAME (and ALIAS if its an alias principal). The other keywords are only used when a new principal is created. The keywords you can specify are: Keyword Description ALIAS Specifies that the principal defined by the NAME keyword is an alias. By default the name is considered a primary principal. CASE=keyword Specifies how the principal name should be Formatted. For example, to specify that the principal name should be all lowercase, use /PRINCIPAL=CASE=LOWERCASE. Possible keywords are: NOEDIT Do not perform any Format:ting. This is the default. LOWERCASE[=n1[,n2]]Convert the principal name so that the first n1 characters and last n2 are lowercase, and the remainder are uppercase. If you do not specify a value for n1 then the entire principal is converted to lowercase. If you do not specify a value for n2 then 0 is used. UPPERCASE[=n1[,n2]]Convert the principal name so that the first n1 characters and last n2 are uppercase, and the remainder are lowercase. If you do not specify a value for n1 then the entire principal is converted to uppercase. If you do not specify a value for n2 then 0 is used. The default is NOEDIT. FULL_ An optional string that is used to more NAME=string fully qualify a primary name. If the name contains spaces, lowercase characters, or any other special characters, enclose the string in quotes. The default is no full name. NAME=name The standard name (primary or alias) that is associated with the DCE account. If the name contains spaces, lowercase characters, or any other special characters, enclose the string in quotes. The default is to take the username from the system authorization file (SYSUAF) record, edit it according to the CASE keyword, and then use this as the principal name. OBJECT_ The number of registry objects that can be CREATION_ created by the principal. QUOTA=number If you do not specify this keyword then no quota is established and the principal can create an unlimited number of registry objects. UNIX_ID=number The required UNIX ID that is associated with the principal. If a primary principal is being created you can omit the UNIX ID and one is generated automatically. If an alias principal is being created you must specify the UNIX ID of the corresponding primary principal.
1.8.7.3.12 /RENEWABLE_LIFETIME=hours
/RENEWABLE_LIFETIME=hours Specifies the amount of time, in hours, before a principal's ticket-granting ticket expires and that principal must log into the system again to reauthenticate and obtain another ticket-granting ticket. If not specified the Maximum Certificate Renewable Lifetime defined as registry authorization policy is used.
1.8.8 – SHOW
Displays OpenVMS usernames. The SHOW command can only be used with the following qualifier: o SHOW/EXCLUDE Displays OpenVMS usernames in the IMPORT exclude list (see /EXCLUDE). /EXCLUDE Displays OpenVMS usernames in the IMPORT exclude list. Format: SHOW/EXCLUDE [USERNAME] Qualifiers Defaults /ALL /OUTPUT=output /OUTPUT=SYS$OUTPUT:
1.8.8.1 – Parameters
username Specifies the name of the OpenVMS account to be displayed from the IMPORT exclude list. Full OpenVMS wildcarding is allowed. If /ALL is on the command line, do not specify a username.
1.8.8.2 – Qualifiers
1.8.8.2.1 /ALL
/ALL Specifies that all IMPORT exclude entries are to be displayed. If you do not specify username, then /ALL is assumed.
1.8.8.2.2 /OUTPUT=output
/OUTPUT=output Determines where the output is written. The default is SYS$OUTPUT:.
1.9 – rgy_edit
NAME rgy_edit - Edits the registry database SYNOPSIS rgy_edit [[[-a | -p | -g | -o] [-s name] [-up[date]] [-v [-f] [name | -un[ix__number]] [-nq]] | -l] OPTIONS The following options are supplied when rgy_edit is invoked. You can specify only one of the options -a, -p, -g, and -o. If you specify the -l option, you can specify no other options. -a (default) Edits or views accounts. -p Edits or views principals. -g Edits or views groups. -o Edits or views organizations. -s Binds to the registry site specified by name. The name variable is either the fully qualified name of the cell that contains the registry to which you want access, or the fully qualified name of a specific registry server. -up[date] Binds to a read-write registry site in the cell specified by the -s option. -v Views the registry entry specified by name or unix_number. If no entry is specified, all entries are viewed. -f Displays in full the entry (or entries) selected by the -v option. The full entry includes all fields except the membership list and organization policy. -nq Specifies that delete operations will not be queried. The default is to prompt the user for verification when a delete operation is requested. -l Edits or views entries in local registry. NOTES With the exception of the following subcommands, this command is replaced at Revision 1.1 by the dcecp command. This command may be fully replaced by the dcecp command in a future release of DCE, and may no longer be supported at that time. + defaults + domain + scope + help + quit + exit + delete + purge + view DESCRIPTION The rgy_edit tool views and edits information in the registry database. You can invoke rgy_edit from any node. You can edit and view principals, groups, organization, accounts, and policies in the network registry (the default) or perform a subset of those functions on the local registry (using the -l option). Changes made by rgy_edit apply only to the registry. They do not apply to the local override file or the local password and group files, both of which can be edited manually. You can view and change only those registry objects to which you are granted the appropriate permissions. INVOKING RGY_EDIT When you invoke rgy_edit, it displays the following prompt: rgy_edit=> At this prompt, you can enter any of the rgy_edit subcommands, and rgy_edit will prompt you for the required information. Alternatively, you can enter the subcommand followed by all the options required to perform a specific operation. The rgy_edit command may prompt you for any required information you do not enter. SUBCOMMANDS In the rgy_edit subcommands that follow, use two double quotation marks with nothing in between to indicate a null fullname, password, misc, homedir, or shell. Use double quotation marks to embed spaces, or hyphens in fullname, misc, and homedir if you specify the argument on the command line.
1.9.1 – pgo_commands
PRINCIPAL, GROUP, AND ORGANIZATION SUBCOMMANDS Whether name applies to a principal, group, or organization depends on the domain in which you run rgy_edit. Use the do[main] subcommand (described in Miscellaneous Commands) to change domains.
1.9.1.1 – view
v[iew] [name] [-f] [-m] [-po] Views registry entries. The -f option displays entries in full (all fields except the membership list and organization policy). If you are viewing groups or organizations, -m displays the membership list. For principals, -m lists all groups of which the principal is a member, including groups that cannot appear in a project list. If you are viewing organizations, -po displays policy information. If you do not enter the -po option, rgy_edit shows only the organization's name and the UNIX number.
1.9.1.2 – add
a[dd] [principal_name [unix_number] [-f fullname] [-al] [-q quota]] a[dd] [group_name [unix_number] [-f fullname [-nl]]] [-al] ls a[dd] [organization_name [unix_number] [-f fullname]] Create a new name entry. If you do not specify principal_name, group_name, or organization name, the add subcommand prompts you for each field in the entry. If you are adding organizations, the command prompts you for policy information as well. If you specify only principal_name, group_name, or organization_name and no other arguments, the object's fullname defaults to "" (that is, blank), the object's UNIX number is assigned automatically, and the object's creation quota defaults to unlimited. Use the -al option to create an alias for an existing principal or group. No two principals or groups can have the same UNIX number, but a principal or group and all its aliases share the same UNIX number. The -al option creates an alias name for a principal or group and assigns the alias name the same UNIX number as the principal or group. The -q option specifies the principal's object creation quota, the total number of registry objects that can be created by the principal. If you do not specify this option, the object creation quota defaults to unlimited. For groups, the -nl option indicates that the group is not to be included on project lists; omitting this option allows the group to appear on project lists.
1.9.1.3 – change
c[hange] [principal_name [-n name] [-f fullname] [-al | -pr] [-q quota]] c[hange] [group_name [-n name] [-f fullname] [-nl | -l] ] [-al | -pr] c[hange] [organization_name [-n name] [-f fullname]] Changes a principal, group, or organization. Specify the entry to change with principal_name, group_name, or organization_name. If you do not specify a principal_name, group_name, or organization_name, the change subcommand prompts you for a name. If you do not specify any fields, the subcommand prompts you for each field in succession. To leave a field unchanged, press <RETURN> at the prompt. If you are changing organization entries in the interactive mode, the subcommand prompts you for policy information as well. Use -n name and -f fullname, to specify a new primary name or fullname, respectively. For principals and groups, the -al option changes a primary name into an alias, and the -pr option changes an alias into a primary name. This change can be made only from the command line, not in the interactive mode. The -q option specifies the total number of registry objects that can be created by the principal. For group entries, the -nl option disallows the group from appearing in project lists, while the -l option allows the group to appear in project lists. For organization entries, you can change policy information only in the interactive mode. Changes to a principal name are reflected in membership lists that contain the principal name. For example, if the principal ludwig is a member of the group composers and the principal name is changed to louis, the membership list for composers is automatically changed to include louis but not ludwig. For reserved names, you can change only fullname.
1.9.1.4 – member
m[ember] [group_name | organization_name [-a member_list] [-r member_list] ] Edits the membership list for a group or organization. If you do not specify a group or organization, the member subcommand prompts you for names to add or remove. To add names or aliases to a membership list, use the -a option followed by the names separated by commas. To delete names from a membership list, use the -r option followed by the names separated by commas. If you do not include either the -a or -r option on the command line, rgy_edit prompts you for names to add or remove. Removing names from the membership list for a group or organization has the side effect of deleting the login account for removed member (and, of course, eliminating any permissions granted as a result of the membership the next time the member's ticket-granting ticket is renewed).
1.9.1.5 – delete
del[ete] name Deletes a registry entry. If you delete a principal, rgy_edit deletes the principal's account.If you delete a group or organization, rgy_edit deletes any accounts associated with the group or organization. You cannot delete reserved principals.
1.9.1.6 – adopt
adopt uuid principal_name [-u unix_number] [ -f fullname] [-q quota] adopt uuid group_name [-f fullname] [-nl] adopt uuid organization_name [-f fullname] Creates a principal, group, or organization for the specified UUID. The principal, group, or organization is created to adopt an orphan object. Orphans are registry objects that cannot be accessed because 1) they are owned by UUIDs that are not associated with a principal or group and 2) no other principal, group, or organiza- tion has access rights to the orphaned object. UUIDs are associ- ated with all registry objects when the object is created. When the registry object is deleted, the association between the object and the UUID is also deleted. The principal_name, group_name, or organization_name you specify must be unique in the registry as it must be when you create a principal, group, or organization using the add subcommand. Except for the manner in which it is created, the principal, group, or organization created by the adopt subcommand is no different from any other principal, group, or organization. The uuid option specifies the UUID number to be assigned to the principal, group,or organization. The UUID supplied must be the one that owns the orphaned object. Specify the uuid in RPC print string format as 8 hexadecimal digits, a hyphen; 4 hexadecimal digits, a hyphen; 4 hexadecimal digits, a hyphen; 4 hexadecimal digits, a hyphen; and 12 hexadecimal digits. The format follows: nnnnnnnn-nnnn-nnnn-nnnn-nnnnnnnnnnnn For cell principals only, the -u option specifies the UNIX number to be associated with the cell name. If you do not enter this option, the next sequential UNIX number is supplied as a default. For all principals other than cells, the UNIX number is extracted from information embedded in the principal's UUID and cannot be specified here. For principals, the -q option specifies the principal's object creation quota. If you do not enter the option, the object creation quota is set to "unlimited." For groups, the -nl option turns off the project list inclusion property so that groups are not included in project lists. If you do not enter this option, the group is included in project lists. For principals, groups, and organizations, the -f option supplies the object's fullname. If you do not enter the -f option, fullname defaults to blank. An error occurs if you specify a name or UNIX number that is already defined within the same domain of the database. Note that in the current implementation of the DCE, UNIX numbers are embedded in UUID numbers. If you try to create a group or organization to adopt an orphaned object and fail, it could be because the embedded UNIX number is invalid because it does not fall within the range of valid UNIX numbers set for the cell as a registry property. If this is the case, you must reset the range of valid UNIX numbers to include the UNIX number embedded in the UUID and then try again to adopt the object.
1.9.2 – account_commands
ACCOUNT SUBCOMMANDS
1.9.2.1 – view
v[iew] [pname [gname [oname]]] [-f] Displays login accounts. Without the -f option, view displays only the user fields in each account entry. These fields include each account's + Principal, group, and organization name + Encrypted password + Miscellaneous information + Home directory + Login shell With -f, view displays the full entry, including the adminis- trative fields as well as the user fields. Administrative information includes: + Who created the account + When the account was created + Who last changed the account + When the account was last changed + When the account expires + Whether the account is valid + Whether the account principal's password is valid + When the account principal's password was last changed
1.9.2.2 – add
a[dd] [pname [-g gname -o oname -mp password {-rp | -pw password} [-m misc] [-h homedir] [-s shell] [-pnv | -pv] [-x account_exp | none] [-anv | -av] [ [-ena[ble] option | -dis[able] option]...] [-gs date_and_time] [-mcr lifespan] [-mcl lifespan]]] Creates a login account. If you enter the subcommand only or the subcommand and the optional pname argument (principal name), rgy_edit prompts you for all information. If you enter the subcommand, the pname argument, and the gname (group name) argument or the the pname, gname and oname (organization name) arguments, you must also enter the -mp, and -pw or -rp options. All other options are optional. The pname argument specifies the principal for whom the account should be created. The -g and -o options specify the account's group and organization. If the principal specified in pname is not already a member of the specified group and organization, rgy_edit automatically attempts to add the principal to the membership lists. If you do not have the appropriate permissions for the group and organization, the attempt will fail and the account will not be created. The -rp option generates a random password for the account. The primary use of this option is to create passwords for accounts that will not be logged into (since the random password can never be supplied.) The -pw option is used to supply a password for the account on the command line. If you use the -rp option or the -pw option, you must also use the -mp option to supply your password so your identity can be validated. If you do not specify the -rp option or the -pw option, rgy_edit prompts for the account's password twice to ensure you did not make a typing mistake. Then it prompts for your password to verify your identity. If the user's password management policy allows the selection of generated passwords, specifying "*" as the argument to the -pw option or at the account's password prompt automatically generates a plaintext password. If the user's password management policy requires the selection of generated passwords, specifying the -pw option is an error. rgy_edit displays a generated password and then prompts for the password for confirmation. The format of password must adhere to the policy of the associated organization or the policy of the registry as a whole, whichever is more restrictive. The information supplied with the -m option is used to create the GECOS field for the account in the /etc/passwd file [on UNIX]. The -h option specifies the pathname of the principal's home directory. The default homedir is /. The -s option specifies the pathname of the principal's login shell. The default shell is a null string. The -pnv (password not valid) option specifies that the password has expired. Generally, users must change their passwords when the passwords expire. However, the policy to handle expired passwords and the mechanism by which users change their passwords are defined for each platform, usually through the login facility. The -pv option indicates the password is not expired (the default). The -x option sets an expiration date for the account in yy/mm/dd/hh/mm/ss format. The default is "none," meaning that the password will never expire. The -anv (account not valid) option specifies that the account is not currently valid for login. The -av option indicates the account is currently valid (the default). The -enable and -disable options set or clear the following options: + The c[lient] option, if enabled, allows the principal to act as a client and log in, acquire tickets, and be authenticated. If you disable client, the principal cannot act as a client. The default is enabled. + The s[erver] option, if enabled, allows the principal to act as a server and engage in authenticated communication. If you disable server, the principal cannot act as a server that engages in authenticated communication. The default is enabled. + The po[stdated] option, if enabled, allows tickets with a start time some time in the future to be issued to the account's principal. The default is disabled. + The f[orwardable] option, if enabled, allows a new ticket- granting ticket with a network address that differs from the present ticket-granting ticket address to be issued to the account's principal. The default is enabled. + The pr[oxiable] option, if enabled, allows a new ticket with a different network address than the present ticket to be issued to the account's principal. The default is disabled. + The T[GT_authentication] option, if enabled, specifies that tickets issued to the account's principal can use the ticket- granting-ticket authentication mechanism. The default is enabled. + The r[enewable] option turns on the Kerberos V5 renewable ticket feature. This feature is not currently used by the DCE; any use of this option is unsupported at the present time. + The dup[_session_key] option allows tickets issued to the account's principal to have duplicate keys. The default is disabled. The -gs (good since date) is the date and time the account was last known to be valid. When accounts are created, this date is set to the account creation time. If you change the good since date, any tickets issued before the changed date are invalid. Enter the date in yy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. The -mcr (maximum certificate renewable) option is the number of hours before a session with the principal's identity expires and the principal must log in again to reauthenticate. The default is 4 weeks. The -mcl (maximum certificate lifetime) option is the number of hours before the Authentication Service must renew a principal's service certificates. This is handled automatically and requires no action on the part of the principal. The default is 1 day.
1.9.2.3 – change
c[hange] [-p pname] [-g gname] [-o oname] [-np pname] [-ng gname] [-no oname] [{-rp | -pw password} -mp password] [-m misc] [-h homedir] [-s shell] [-pnv | -pv] [-x account_exp | none] [-anv | -av] [[-ena[ble] option | -dis[able] option]...] [-gs date_and_time] [-mcr lifespan] [-mcl lifespan] Changes an account. The -p, -g, and -o options identify the account to change. The -np, -ng, and -no options change the account's, principal, group, and organization, respectively. If you do not specify all three -p, -g, and -o options, wildcard updates can occur. For example, if you specify only the -g option, the changes affect all accounts that are associated with the named group. Note that you cannot use wildcarding to change passwords. To change a password, you must enter the -p, -g, and -o options. All other options have the same meaning as described in the add command for accounts. Note that the -rp option can be used to change the random passwords of the reserved accounts created by sec_create_db when the registry database is created.
1.9.2.4 – delete
del[ete] -p pname [-g gname] [-o oname] Deletes the specified account. Enter the -p option to delete the specified principal's account. Enter the -g or -o option to delete accounts associated with the specified group or organization. If you enter the -g or -o option, rgy_edit prompts individually for whether to delete each account associated with the group or organization.
1.9.2.5 – cell
ce[ll] cellname [-ul unix_num] [-uf unix_num] [-gl gname] [-ol oname] [-gf gname] [-of oname] [-mp passwd] [-fa name] [-fp passwd] [-q quota] [-x account_expiration_date | none] Creates a cross-cell authentication account in the local and foreign cells. This account allows local principals to access objects in the foreign cell as authenticated users and vice versa. The admin- istrator in the foreign cell must have also set up a standard account, whose ID and password the administrator of the foreign cell must supply to you. The cellname variable specifies the full pathname of the foreign cell with which you will establish the cross-cell authentication account. This name is stripped of the path qualifier and prefixed with "krbtgt." The resulting name is used as the primary name for the cross-cell authentication account. For example, if you enter /.../dresden.com, the principal name is krbtgt/dresden.com. The -ul option specifies the UNIX number for the local cell's principal. The -uf option specifies the UNIX number for the foreign cell's principal. If you do not specify these UNIX numbers, they are generated automatically. The -gl and -ol options specify the local account's group and organization. The -gf and -of options specify the foreign account's group and organization. The -mp option specifies the password of the person who invoked rgy_edit. The -fa option specifies the name identifying the account in the foreign cell, and the -fp option specifies the account's password. The -q option specifies the total number of objects that can be created in your cell's registry by all foreign users who use the cross-cell authentication account to access your cell. The object creation quota defaults to 0 (zero), meaning that principals in the foreign cell cannot create objects in the local cell. The object creation quota set for your cell's account in the foreign cell places the same restriction on the number of objects that your cell's principals can create in the foreign cell's registry. The -x option specifies the account expiration date for both the local and foreign accounts. The default for this option is "none." Note that the object creation quota for the local account defaults to 0 (zero), meaning that principals in the foreign cell cannot create objects in the local cell. You can change this with the rgy_edit change subcommand.
1.9.3 – key_management_commands
KEY MANAGEMENT SUBCOMMANDS The key management subcommands must be run in command-line mode.
1.9.3.1 – ktadd
kta[dd] -p principal_name [-pw password] [-a[uto]] [-r[egistry]] [-f key-file] Creates a password for a server or machine in the keytab file on the local node. The -p option specifies the name of the server or machine principal for which you are creating a password. The -pw option lets you supply the password on the command line. If you do not enter this option or the -auto option, ktadd prompts for the password. The -a option generates the password randomly. If you use this option, you must also use the -r option. If you do not specify the -auto or the -pw option, you are prompted for a password. The -r option updates the principal's password in the registry to match the string you enter (or automatically generate) for the password in the keytab file. Use it to ensure that the principal's password in the registry and the keytab file are in synch when you change a principal's password in the keytab file. To use this option, a password for the principal must exist in the default keytab file or the keytab file named by the -f option. The -f option specifies the name of the server keytab file on the local node to which you are adding the password. If you do not specify a keytab file name, dce$local:[krb5]v5srvtab.; is used. Note that you must be privileged to add entries in the default keytab file.
1.9.3.2 – ktlist
ktl[ist] [-p principal_name] [-f keyfile] Displays principal names and password version numbers in the local keytab file. The -p option specifies the name of the server or machine principal for which you are displaying passwords. The -f option specifies the name of the server keytab file on the local node for which you want to display entries. If you do not specify a keytab file name, dce$local:[krb5]v5srvtab.; is used.
1.9.3.3 – ktdelete
ktd[elete] -p principal_name -v version_number [-f keyfile] Deletes a sever or machine principal's password entry from a keytab file. The -p option specifies the name of the server or machine principal for whom you are deleting a password entry. The -v option specifies the version number of the password you want to delete. Version numbers are assigned to a principal's password whenever the principal's password is changed. This allows any servers or machines still using tickets granted under the old pass- word to run without interruption until the ticket expires naturally. The -f option specifies the name of the server keytab file on the local node from which you want to delete passwords. If you do not specify a keytab file name, dce$local:[krb5]v5srvtab.; is used. Note that you must be privileged to delete entries in the default keytab file. You must have the appropriate access rights to delete entries in other keytab files.
1.9.4 – miscellaneous_commands
Miscellaneous Commands
1.9.4.1 – domain
do[main] [p | g | o | a] Changes or displays the type of registry information being viewed or edited. You can specify p for principals, g for groups, o for organizations, or a for accounts. If you supply no argument, rgy_edit displays the current domain.
1.9.4.2 – site
si[te] [[name]] [-u[pdate]] Changes or displays the registry site being viewed or edited. The name variable is the fully qualified name of the cell that contains the registry to which you want access. If you supply no argument, rgy_edit displays the current site. The -update option indicates you want to talk to an update site in the specified cell.
1.9.4.3 – properties
prop[erties] Changes or displays registry properties. This command prompts you for changes. Press <Return> to leave information unchanged.
1.9.4.4 – policy
po[licy] [organization_name] [-al lifespan | forever] [-pl passwd_lifespan | forever] [-px passwd_exp_date | none] [-pm passwd_min_length] [-pa | -pna] [-ps | -pns] Changes or displays registry standard policy or the policy for an organization. Enter organization_name to display or change policy for that specific organization. If you do not enter organization_name the subcommand affects standard policy for the entire registry. The -al option determines the account's lifespan, the period during which accounts are valid. After this period of time passes, the accounts become invalid and must be recreated. An account's lifespan is also controlled by the add and change subcommands -x option. If the two lifespans conflict, the shorter one is used. Enter the lifespan in the following in the following format: weekswdaysdhourshminutesm For example, 4 weeks and 5 days is entered as 4w5d. If you enter only a number and no weeks, days, or hours designation, the designation defaults to hours. If you end the lifepan with a number and no weeks, days, or hours designation, the number with no designation defaults to seconds. For example, 12w30 is assumed to be 12 weeks thirty seconds. The -pl option determines the password lifespan, the period of time before account's password expires. Generally, users must change their passwords when the passwords expire. However, the policy to handle expired passwords and the mechanism by which users change their passwords are defined for each platform, usually through the login facility. Enter passwd_lifespan as a number indicating the number of days. If you define a password lifespan as forever, the password has an unlimited lifespan. The -px option specifies the password expiration date in yy/mm/dd/hh.mm:ss format. Generally, users must change their passwords when the passwords expire. However, the policy to handle expired passwords and the mechanism by which users change their passwords are defined for each platform, usually through the login facility. If you define a password expiration date as none, the password has an unlimited lifespan. The -pm, -ps, -pns, -pa, and -pna options all control the format of passwords as follows: + -pm - Specifies the minimum length of passwords in characters. If you enter 0, no password minimum length is in effect. + -ps and -pns - Specify whether passwords can contain all spaces (-ps) or can not be all spaces (-pns). + -pa and -pna - Specify whether passwords can consist of all alphanumeric characters (-pn) or must include some non- alphanumeric characters (-pna).
1.9.4.5 – auth_policy
au[th_policy] Changes and/or displays registry authentication policies. This command prompts you for changes. Press <Return> to leave information unchanged.
1.9.4.6 – defaults
def[aults] Changes or displays the home directory, login shell, password valid option, account expiration date, and account valid option default values that rgy_edit uses. This command first displays the current defaults. It then prompts you for whether or not you want to make changes. If you make changes, defaults immediately changes the defaults for the current session, and it saves the new defaults in sys$login:.rgy_editrc. The newly saved defaults are used until you change them.
1.9.4.7 – help
h[elp] [command Displays usage information for rgy_edit. If you do not specify a particular command, rgy_edit lists the available commands.
1.9.4.8 – quit
q[uit] Exit rgy_edit.
1.9.4.9 – exit
e[xit] Exit rgy_edit.
1.9.4.10 – login
l[ogin] Lets you establish a new network identity for use during the rgy_edit session. The rgy_edit login command prompts for a principal name and password.
1.9.4.11 – scope
sc[ope] [name] Limits the scope of the information displayed by the view subcommand to the directory (specified by name) in the registry database.
1.9.5 – local_registry_commands
Commands for the Local Registry To edit or view the local registry, invoke rgy_edit with the -l option while you are logged into the machine whose local registry you want to maintain. This section lists the commands that are valid for editing or viewing the local registry. When you invoke rgy_edit with the -l option, only the subcommands and options listed here can be used.
1.9.5.1 – view
v[iew] Displays local registry entries.
1.9.5.2 – delete
del[ete] principal_name Deletes the account and credential information for principal_name from the local registry.
1.9.5.3 – purge
pu[rge] Purges expired local registry entries. This command has no options or arguments. The time limit, or lifespan, for which an entry in the local registry is valid is set as a property of the local registry with the properties subcommand. When the purge subcommand is run, it deletes all expired entries. The lifespan begins when an entry for the principal is added to the local registry (that is, the beginning of the lifespan is the last time the principal logged in to the local machine.) The lifespan ends after the time limit set as a local registry property.
1.9.5.4 – properties
pr[operties] Changes and/or displays local registry properties and policies. This command displays the current properties and then prompts for whether you want to make changes to them. You can change the local registry's: + Capacity - A number representing the total number of entries the local registry can contain at any one time. When the capacity is reached, subsequent new entries overwrite the oldest entries. + Account lifespan - The time in which an account in the local registry is valid in the following format: weekswdaysdhourshminutesm For example, 4 weeks and 5 days is entered as 4w5d. If you enter only a number and no weeks, days, or hours designation, the designation defaults to hours. If you end the lifepan with a number and no weeks, days, or hours designation, the number with no designation defaults to seconds. For example, 12w30 is assumed to be 12 weeks thirty seconds.
1.10 – secd
NAME secd - The DCE Security Server SYNOPSIS secd [-b[ootstrap]] [-lockpw] [-locksm[ith]] [pname] [-rem[ote]] [-master_seqno new_master_seqno] [-cpi time] [-restore_master] [-v[erbose]] OPTIONS -locksm[ith] Restarts the master Security Server in locksmith mode. Use this mode if you cannot access the registry as the principal with full registry access, because that principal's account has been inadvertently deleted or its password lost. -pname The pname argument is the name of the locksmith principal. If no registry account exists for this principal, secd creates one. -lockpw Prompt for a new locksmith password when running in locksmith mode. This option allows you to specify a new password for the locksmith account when the old one is unknown. -rem[ote] Allows the locksmith principal to log in remotely. If this option is not used, the principal must log in from the local machine on which secd will be started. -bo[otstrap] Always waits only one minute between tries to export binding information to the Cell Directory Service during DCE config- uration. If you do not specify this option, during initial- ization secd sleeps for 1 minute if CDS is not available when it tries to export binding information. If the export fails a second time, it sleeps for 2 minutes before it tries again. If it still fails, it sleeps for 4, 8, and 16 minutes between retries. Then, sleep time stays at 16 minutes until the binding export succeeds. -master_seqno Sets a new master sequence number for the master replica. This option is used only in unusual situations when a replica that you want to be the master has a master sequence number that is lower than (or equal to) another master sequence number in the system. When the master detects that its master sequence number is lower than another one in the system, it marks itself as a duplicate master and its process exits. Each time you start the master replica, it will notice that it has been deemed a duplicate master, and its process will again exit. Use this option to assign a new master sequence number to the replica you want to be master. The new sequence number should be one digit higher than the highest master sequence number in the system. (Use the dcecp registry show -replica command for each replica to find the highest master sequence number.) -cpi The checkpoint interval for the mater registry database. This is the interval in seconds at which the master will read its database to disk. The default is one hour. -restore_master Marks all slave replicas for initialization during the master restart. Use this option only to recover from a catastrophic failure of the master security server (for example, if the database is corrupted and then restored from a backup tape). -v[erbose]] Runs in verbose mode. All options start the Security Server on the local node. DESCRIPTION The secd daemon is the Security Server. It manages all access to the registry database. You must have root privileges to invoke the secd. The Security Server can be replicated, so that several copies of the registry database exist on a network, each managed by a secd process. Only one Security Server, the master replica, can perform database update operations (such as adding an account). Other servers, the slave replicas, can perform only lookup operations (such as validating a login attempt). A DCE Host daemon (dced) must be running on the local node when secd is started. Typically, dced and secd are started at boot time. The secd server places itself in the background when it is ready to service requests. LOCKSMITH MODE The secd -locksmith option starts secd in locksmith mode. The -locksmith option can be used only with the master replica. In locksmith mode, the principal name you specify to secd with pname becomes the locksmith principal. As the locksmith principal, you can repair malicious or accidental changes that prevent you from logging in with full registry access privileges. If no account exists for pname, secd establishes one and prompts you for the account's password. (Use this password when you log in to the account as the locksmith principal.) If an account for pname exists, secd changes the account and policy information as described in the tables titled "Locksmith Account Changes Made by the Security Server" and "Registry Policy Changes Made by the Security Server." These changes ensure that even if account or registry policy was tampered with, you will now be able to log in to the locksmith account. In locksmith mode, all principals with valid accounts can log in and operate on the registry with normal access checking. The locksmith principal, however, is granted special access to the registry: no access checking is performed for the authenticated locksmith principal. This means that, as the locksmith principal, you can operate on the registry with full access. The following table shows locksmith account changes that can be made by the security server. IF THE SECURITY SERVER FINDS IT CHANGES Password-Valid flag is set to no Password-Valid flag to yes ________________________________________________________________________ Account Expiration date is set to Account Expiration date to less than the current time plus one the current time plus one hour hour ________________________________________________________________________ Client flag is set to no Client flag to yes ________________________________________________________________________ Account-Valid flag is set to no Account-Valid flag to yes ________________________________________________________________________ Good Since date is set to greater Good Since date to the than the current time current time ________________________________________________________________________ Password Expiration date is set Password Expiration date to less than current time plus to the current time plus one hour one hour ------------------------------------------------------------------------ The following table shows registry policy changes that can be made by the security server. IF THE SECURITY SERVER FINDS IT CHANGES Account Lifespan is set to Account Lifespan to the less than the difference current time plus one hour between the locksmith minus the locksmith account creation date and account creation date the current time plus one hour _________________________________________________________ Password Expiration date is Password Expiration date set to greater than the time to the current time plus the password was last one hour changed but less than the current time plus one hour Use the -lockpw option if the locksmith account exists but you do not know its password. This option causes secd to prompt for a new lock- smith password and replace the existing password with the one entered. Use the -remote option to allow the locksmith principal to log in from a remote machine. The secd program normally runs in the background. When you start secd in locksmith mode, it runs in the foreground so that you can answer prompts. EXAMPLES All of the commands shown in the following examples must be run by a privileged process: 1. Start a Security Server after you create the database with sec_create_db. $ run sys$system:dce$secd 2. Restart an existing replica (master or slave). $ run sys$system:dce$secd 3. Start the Security Server in locksmith mode and allow the master_admin principal to log in on a remote machine. $ secd :== $sys$system:dce$secd.exe $ secd -locksmith master_admin -remote
1.11 – sec_admin
NAME sec_admin - Registry replica administration tool SYNOPSIS sec_admin [-site name] [-nq] OPTIONS -site name The -site option causes sec_admin to bind to the replica specified by the name argument. If the option is not supplied, sec_admin binds randomly to any replica in the local cell. The name argument can be: + A specific cell_name (or /.: for the local cell) to bind to any replica in the named cell. + The global name of a replica to bind to that specific replica in that specific cell. + The name of a replica as it appears on the replica list to bind to that replica in the local cell. + A string binding to a specific replica. An example of a string binding is ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.163. This form is used primarily for debugging or if the Cell Directory Service is not available. -nq The -nq flag turns off queries initiated by certain sec_admin subcommands before they perform a specified operation. For example the delrep subcommand deletes a registry replica. Before sec_admin performs the deletion, it prompts for verifi- cation. If you invoke sec_admin with the -nq option, the subcommand performs the deletion without prompting. NOTES With the exception of the following subcommands, this command is replaced at Revision 1.1 by the dcecp command. This command may be fully replaced by the dcecp command in a future release of DCE, and may no longer be supported at that time. + monitor + exit + help + quit DESCRIPTION The registry database is replicated: each instance of a registry server, secd, maintains a working copy of the database in virtual memory and on disk. One server, called the master replica, accepts updates and handles the subsequent propagation of changes to all other replicas. All other replicas are slave replicas, which accept only queries. Each cell has one master replica and numerous slave replicas. Using the sec_admin command you can: + View a list of replicas + Delete a replica + Reinitialize a replica + Stop a replica + Put the master replica into and out of the maintenance state + Generate a new master key used to encrypt principal keys + Turn the master registry into a slave registry and a slave registry into the master registry.. Note that sec_admin cannot add, delete, or modify information in the database, such as names and accounts. Use rgy_edit to modify registry database entries. THE DEFAULT REPLICA AND DEFAULT CELL Most sec_admin commands are directed to a default replica. When sec_admin is invoked, it automatically binds to a replica in the local cell. This replica becomes the default replica. Identifying the Default Replica and the Default Cell You use the site subcommand to change the default replica and, optionally, the default cell. When you use the site command, you can supply the name of a specific replica, or you can simply supply the name of a cell. If you supply a cell name, sec_admin binds to a replica in that cell randomly. If you supply a specific replica name, sec_admin binds to that replica. Specifically, you can supply any of the following names to the site subcommand: + A cell name. If you enter a cell name, the named cell becomes the default cell. The sec_admin command randomly chooses a replica to bind to in the named cell, and that replica becomes the default replica. + The global name given to the replica when it was created. A global name identifies a specific replica in a specific cell. That cell becomes the default cell and that replica the default replica. + The replica's name as it appears on the replica list (a list main- tained by each Security Server containing the network addresses of each replica in the local cell). That replica becomes the default replica and the cell in which the replica exists becomes the default cell. + The network address of the host on which the replica is running. The replica on that host becomes the default replica, and the cell in which the host exists becomes the default cell. Naming the Default Replica As an example, assume a replica named subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2: + Exists in the local cell /.../dresden.com + Has a global name of /.../dresden.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2 + Is named subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2 on the replica list + Runs on a host whose ip network address is 15.22.144.248 This replica can then be identified to the site subcommand in any of the following ways: + /.../dresden.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2 - The replica's full global name. + subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2 - The replica's cell-relative name on the replica list. + ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248 - The network address of the host on which the replica runs. Naming the Default Cell When a default replica is identified specifically, its cell becomes the default cell. In the example in "Naming the Default Replica" above, the default cell is /.../dresden.com. You can specify simply a cell name to the site subcommand. When this is done, any replica in that cell is selected as the default replica. For example, assume /.../bayreuth.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_300_1 and /.../bayreuth.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_300_2 are replicas in the cell /.../bayreuth.com. If you type site /.../bayreuth.com then /.../bayreuth.com becomes the default cell and either /.../bayreuth.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_300_1 or /.../bayreuth.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_300_2 becomes the default replica. AUTOMATIC BINDING TO THE MASTER Some of the sec_admin subcommands can act only on the master registry and thus require binding to the master registry. If you execute a sub- command that acts only on the master and the master is not the default replica, sec_admin attempts to bind to the master replica in the current default cell automatically. If this attempt is successful, sec_admin displays a warning message informing you that the default replica has been changed to the master registry. The master registry will then remain the default replica until you change it with the site subcommand. If the attempt to bind is not successful, sec_admin displays an error message, and the subcommand fails. INVOKING sec_admin When you invoke sec_admin, it displays the current default replica's full global name and the cell in which the replica exists. Then it displays the sec_admin> prompt. $ sec_admin Default replica: /.../dresden.com/subsys/dce/sec/music Default cell: /.../dresden.com sec_admin> At the sec_admin> prompt, you can enter any of the sec_admin subcommands. SUBCOMMANDS The subcommand descriptions that follow use default_replica to indicate the default replica and other_replica to indicate a replica other than the default. other_replica must identify a replica in the default cell. It is specified by its name on the cell's replica list (that is, by its cell-relative name). Use the lrep subcommand to view the default cell's replica list. become [ -master ] [ -slave ] The -master option makes the current default replica (which must be a slave) the master replica. The -slave option makes the current default replica (which must be the master) a slave replica. This method of changing to master or slave can cause updates to be lost. The change_master subcommand is the preferred means of designating a different master replica. However, you may find the become -master command useful if the master server is irrevocably damaged and you are unable to use change_master. change_master -to other_replica Make the replica specified by other_replica the master replica. To perform this operation, other_replica must be a slave, and the current default replica must be the master. If the current default replica is not the master, sec_admin attempts to bind to the master. If the change operation is successful, the current master: 1. Applies all updates to other_replica 2. Becomes a slave 3. Tells other_replica to become the master delr[ep] other_replica [-force ] Delete the registry replica identified by other_replica. To perform this operation, the current default replica must be the master. If it is not, sec_admin attempts to bind to the master. If the delete operation is successful, the master: 1. Marks other_replica as deleted 2. Propagates the deletion to all replicas on its replica list 3. Delivers the delete request to other_replica 4. Removes other_replica from its replica list The -force option causes a more drastic deletion. It causes the master to first delete other_replica from its replica list and then to propagate the deletion to the replicas that remain on its list. Since this operation never communicates with the deleted replica, you should use -force only when the replica has died irrecoverably. If you use -force while other_replica is still running, you should then use the destroy subcommand to eliminate the deleted replica. h[elp] [command] Lists the sec_admin subcommands and shows their allowed abbreviations. If command is specified, displays help for the specified command. info [-full] Displays status information about the default replica. The info subcommand contacts the default replica to obtain the appropriate information. If this information is not available, info prints the replica name and a message stating the information is not available. Without the -full option, info displays: + The default replica's name and the name of the cell in which the replica exists + Whether the replica is a master or a slave + The date and time the replica was last updated and the update sequence number + An indication of the replica's state, as follows: - Bad State - The state of the replica prohibits the requested operation. - Uninitialized - The database is a stub database that has not been initialized by the master replica or another up-to-date replica - Initializing - The replica is in the process of being initialized by the master replica or another up-to-date replica - In Service - The replica is available for queries and propagation updates if it is a slave replica or queries and updates if it is the master replica - Copying Database - The replica is in the process of initializing (copying its database to) another replica - Saving Database - The replica is in the process of saving its database to disk. - In Maintenance - The replica is unavailable for updates but will accept queries - Changing Master Key - The replica is in the process of having its master key changed - Becoming Master- The replica is in the process of becoming the master replica (applicable to slave replicas only) - Becoming Slave- The master replica is in the process of becoming a slave replica (applicable to the master replicas only) - Closed - The replica is in the process of stopping - Deleted - The replica is in the process of deleting itself - Duplicate Master - The replica a duplicate master and should be deleted. The master replica is available for queries when it is in the in-service, copying-database, in-maintenance, master-key- changing and becoming-slave states. It is available for updates only when it is in the in-service state. A slave replica is available for queries when it is in the in- service, copying-database, master-key-changing and becoming- master states. It accepts updates from the master replica only when it is in the in-service state. It accepts a request from the master replica to initialize only when it is in the uninitialized or in-service state. The -full option displays all the above information and the following information: + The default replica's unique identifier + The replica's network addresses + The unique identifier of the cell's master replica + The network addresses of the cell's master replica + The master sequence number, which is the sequence number of the event that made the replica the master + If the replica is the master replica, the update sequence numbers that are still in the propagation queue and have yet to be propagated + The DCE software version number. initr[ep] other_replica Reinitializes a replica by copying an up-to-date database to other_replica. The master replica initiates and guides the operation. If th operation is successful 1. The master replica a. Marks other_replica for reinitialization b. Tells other_replica to reinitialize itself c. Gives other_replica a list of replicas with up-to-date databases 2. The other_replica picks a replica from the list and asks that replica to initialize it (that is, to copy its database to other_replica) To perform this operation, other_replica must be a slave, and the current default replica must be the master. If the current default replica is not the master, sec_admin attempts to bind to the master. This subcommand is generally not used under normal conditions. lr[ep] [-s[tate]] [-u[uid]] [-a[ddr]] [-p[rop]] [-al[l]] Lists the replicas on the default replica's replica list. If you enter no options, the display includes the replica name and whether or not it is the master replica. In addition if the master replica's list is being displayed, slave replicas marked for deletion are noted. With options, the display includes this information and the information described in the following paragraphs. The -state option shows each replica's current state, the date and time the replica was last updated, and the update sequence number. To obtain this information, lrep contacts each replica. If this information is not available from the replica, lrep prints the replica name and a message stating the information is not available. The -addr option shows each replica's network addresses. The -uuid option shows each replica's unique identifier. The -prop option shows: + The date and time of the last update the master sent to each slave replica + The sequence number of the last update to each slave replica + The number of updates not yet applied to each slave replica + The status of the master replica's last communication with each slave replica + The propagation state of each slave replica. This state, illustrates how the master replica views the slave replica, can be any of the following: - Bad State-The state of the replica prohibits the requested operation. - Marked for Initialization-The replica has been marked for deletion by the master replica. - Initialized-The replica has been marked for initializa- tion by the master replica. - Initializing-The replica is in the process of being ini- tialized by the master replica. - Ready for Updates-The replica has been initialized by the master replica and in now available for propagation updates from the master replica. - Marked for Deletion-The replica has been marked for deletion by the master replica. This information is obtained from the master replica; the slave replicas are not contacted for this information. The -prop option is valid only for the master. For slave replicas, the -all option shows all the information above except that displayed by the -prop option. For the master replica, the -all option shows all the information. mas[ter_key] Generates a new master key for the default replica and re- encrypts account keys using the new key. The new master key is randomly generated. Each replica (master and slaves) maintains its own master key used to access the data in its copy of the database. monitor [-r m] Periodically list the registry replicas stored in the current default replica's replica list. The list includes each replica's current state, the date and time the replica was last updated and the update sequence number. Note that this is the same information as that displayed by the info sub- command with no options. The monitor subcommand contacts each replica to obtain the information it displays. If this information is not available from the replica, monitor prints the replica name and a message stating the information is not available. The -r option causes the replicas to be listed at intervals you specify. m is a number of minutes between intervals. The default is 15 minutes. destroy default_replica Destroy the current default replica. To perform this operation, the current default replica and the default replica you name as default_replica must be the same. This is to confirm your desire to perform the deletion. If the operation is successful, the default replica deletes its copy of the registry database and stops running. This subcommand does not delete default_replica from the replica lists. Use the delrep -force subcommand to delete the replica from the other replica lists. The preferred way to delete replicas is to use the delrep subcommand. However, the destroy subcommand can be used if delrep is unusable because the master is unreachable or the replica is not on the master's replica list. site [name [-u[pdate]]] Set or display the default cell and the default replica. The name argument identifies the replica to set as the default replica and, as a consequence, the default cell. It can be: + A specific cell_name (or /.: for the local cell) to make any replica in the named cell the default. + The global name of a replica to make the specified replica in the specified cell the default. + The name of a replica as it appears on the replica list to make the named replica (which exists in the default cell) the default replica. + A string binding to a specific replica. An example of a string binding is ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.163. This form is used primarily for debugging or if the Cell Directory Service is not available. The -u option specifies that sec_admin should find the master replica. Normally you specify the name of a cell for name in conjunction with the -u option. In this case sec_admin finds the master replica in that cell. If you use a replica name for name, sec_admin queries the named replica to find the master replica in the named replica's cell. If you supply no arguments, sec_admin displays the current default replica and default cell. stop Stops the Security Server (secd) associated with the default replica. sta[te] -maintenance | -service Puts the master replica into maintenance state or takes it out of maintenance state. This subcommand is useful for performing backups of the registry database. If the current default replica is not the master, sec_admin attempts to bind to the master. The -maintenance flag causes the master replica to save its database to disk and refuse any updates. The -service flag causes the master replica to return to its normal "in service" state and start accepting updates. e[xit] or q[uit] The quit and exit subcommands end the sec_admin session. EXAMPLES 1. The following example, invokes sec_admin and uses the lrep sub- command to list replicas on the replica list and their states: $ r sys$system:dce$sec_admin Default replica: /.../dresden.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_ Default cell: /.../dresden.com sec_admin> lrep -st Replicas in cell /.../dresden.com (master) subsys/dce/sec/master state: in service Last update received at: 1993/11/16.12:46:59 Last update's seqno: 0.3bc subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2 state: in service Last update received at: 1993/11/16.12:46:59 Last update's seqno: 0.3bc subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_3 state: in service Last update received at: 1993/11/16.12:46:59 Last update's seqno: 0.3bc sec_admin> 2. The following example, sets the default replica to the master in the local cell: sec_admin> site /.: -u Default replica: /.../dresden.com/subsys/dce/sec/master Default cell: /.../dresden.com sec_admin>
1.12 – sec_create_db
NAME sec_create_db - registry database creation utility SYNOPSIS sec_create_db {-master | -slave} -my[name] my_server_name [-cr[eator] creator_name] [-cu[nix_id] creator_unix_id] [-g[roup_low_id] g_unix_id] [-k[eyseed] keyseed] [-ma[x_unix_id] max_unix_id] [-o[rg_low_unix_id] o_unix_id] [-pa[ssword] default_password] [-p[erson_low_unix_id] p_unix_id] [-u[uid cell_uuid] [-v[erbose]] OPTIONS {-master | -slave} Specifies whether the database for the master replica should be created (-master) or a database for a slave replica should be created (-slave). All other sec_create_db options can be used with the -master option. Only the -myname, -keyseed, and -verbose options can be used with the -slave option. -my[name] Specifies the name that will be used by the Directory Service to locate the machine on which the cell's Security Server is running. -cr[eator] Specifies the principal name of the initial privileged user of the registry database (known as the "registry creator"). -cu[nix_id] Specifies the UNIX ID of the initial privileged user of the registry database. If you do not enter the UNIX ID, it is assigned dynamically. -g[roup_low_unix_id] Specifies the starting point for UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when groups are added with the rgy_edit command. k[eyseed] Specifies a character string used to seed the random key generator in order to create the master key for the database you are creating. It should be string that cannot be easily guessed. The master key is used to encrypt all account pass- words. Each instance of a replica (master or slave) has its own master key. You can change the master key using the sec_admin command. ma[x] Specifies the highest UNIX ID that can be assigned to a principal, group, or organization. -o[rg_low_unix_id] Specifies the starting point for UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when organizations are added with the rgy_edit command. -pa[ssword] The default password assigned to the accounts created by sec_create_db, including the account for the registry creator. If you do not specify a default password, -dce- is used. (Note that the hosts/local_host/self none none, krbtgt/cell_name none none, and nobody none none accounts are not assigned the default password, but instead a randomly generated password.) -p[erson_low_unix_id] Specifies the starting point for UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when principals are added with the rgy_edit command. -u[uid] Specifies the cell's UUID. If you do not enter this UUID, it is assigned dynamically. -v[erbose] Specifies that sec_create_db runs in verbose mode and displays all activity. DESCRIPTION The sec_create_db tool creates new master and slave databases in DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.RGY_DATA] on the machine from which sec_create_db is run. Normally, these databases are created only once by the system configuration tool, dce_config. However, you can use sec_create_db if you need to re-create the master or a slave database from scratch. You must be privileged to invoke sec_create_db. The sec_create_db -master option creates the master database on the machine on which it is run. This database is initialized with names and accounts, some of them reserved. You must use the rgy_edit command to populate the database with objects and accounts. When the master registry database is created, default ACL entries for registry objects are also created. These entries give the most privileged permission set to the principal named in the -cr[eator] option. If the principal is not one of the reserved names and accounts, sec_create_db adds it as a new principal and adds an account for that new principal. If the -cr option is not used, DCE$SERVER is the creator. The sec_create_db -slave option creates a slave database on the machine on which it is run. This command creates a stub database on the local node in DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.RGY_DATA] and adds the newly created replica to the master's replica list. The master then marks the replica to be initialized when a Security Server is started on the slave's node. The sec_create_db command also creates a registry configuration file, named DCE$LOCAL:[ETC.SECURITY]PE_SITE.;, that contains the network address of the machine on which the database is created. This file supplies the binding address of the secd master server if the Naming Service is not available. FILES DCE$LOCAL:[ETC.SECURITY]PE_SITE.; The file containing the network address of the machine on which the security database is created. DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.RGY_DATA] The directory in which the registry database files are stored.
1.13 – sec_salvage_db
NAME sec_salvage_db - Recover a corrupted registry database. The sec_salvage_db -check and -fix options are not currently available. SYNOPSIS sec_salvage_db -print [-dbpath db_pathname] [-prtpath print_pathname] [print_options] [-verbose] sec_salvage_db -reconstruct [-dbpath db_pathname] [-prtpath print_pathname] [reconstruct_options] [-verbose] sec_salvage_db -check [-dbpath db_pathname] [db_options] [-verbose] sec_salvage_db -fix [-dbpath db_pathname] [db_options] [-force] [-verbose] OPTIONS -check Check the database elements specified by db_options for incon- sistencies. This option sends a list to standard output of all bad list links, internal id references, and database keys and any detectable data inconsistencies. The -check option does not check fields for legal values. db_options Specify the database elements to be acted on by the -check or -fix options. If no db_options are specified, all are selected. The db_options are + -princ - Principals + -group - Groups + -org - Organizations + -acct - Accounts + -acl - ACLs + -policy - Policy + -state - Database State + -replicas - Replicas The .mkey.prt file and the princ.prt file contain unencrypted authentication keys. Ensure that only the privileged account can access these files and that they are never transferred over a network for viewing or backup. -fix Check the database for inconsistencies and prompt for whether to fix each inconsistency. After all inconsistencies have been processed, the option prompts for whether to save all fixes. -force Check the database for inconsistencies and fix each one with- out prompting. After all inconsistencies have been processed, the option prompts for whether to save all fixes. This option is valid only when used with the -fix option. -print Create files containing ASCII-formatted database records. These files are used by the -reconstruct option as a source for recreating the database. You can also manually edit the files to change information or fix problems. A separate file is created for each of the print_options specified. By default the -print option stores the master key file in the current directory and the database files in the rgy_print directory in the current directory. The -prtpath option lets you specify a different directory. print_options Specify the database elements to be acted on by the -print option. If the files exist, they are overwritten. If no print_options are specified, all are selected. The print_options and the files they create are + -princ - Put principal records in the file princ.prt and master key information in the file .mkey.prt. + -group - Put group records in the file group.prt. + -org - Put organization records in the file org.prt. + -policy - Put policy records in the file policy.prtt. + -state - Put information about the state of the database in the file rgy_state.prt. + -replicas - Put replica information in the file replicas.prt. -reconstruct Reconstruct the registry database from the ASCII-formatted print files created by the -print option. The reconstruct_options specify the print files to use. Specifies which elements of the registry database to re- construct. If no reconstruct_options are specified, all are selected. The reconstruct_options are + -pgo - Use data in the princ.prt, group.prt, org.prt, and .mkey.prt files to reconstruct: - Principals, groups, organizations - Principal's accounts - ACL's on database objects - The master key file + -policy - Use data from the policy.prt file to re- construct registry policies. + -state - Use data from the rgy_state.prt file to re- construct information about the state of the database. + -replicas - Use data from the replicas.prt file to reconstruct the master replica list. -dbpath db_pathname For the -print and -check options, -dbpath specifies the directory in which the registry database and the master key file are located. For the -reconstruct and -fix options, -dbpath specifies the directory in which to store the re- constructed or salvaged database. The -print and -check options expects to find the master key file, .mkey, in the directory above the directory that holds the database files. For example, if db_pathname is DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.NEW_RGY], the options look for the master key file in DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY] and the database files in DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.NEW_RGY]. If this option is not specified, the default pathname is DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.RGY_DATA]. db_pathname can be a global pathname or a cell-relative name. -prtpath print_pathname For the print and -reconstruct options only, -prtpath specifies the directory in which to create (-print) the print files, or find (-reconstruct) the print files from which to reconstruct the database. By default the -print option creates and the -reconstruct option looks for the master key file in the current directory and the database files in the rgy_print subdirectory of the current directory. The -prtpath option lets you specify the directory that should be used instead of the current directory. For example, if you specify print_pathname as DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.REGISTRY], the master key print file will be created in that directory and the database print files in DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.REGISTRY.RGY_PRINT]. If any or all of the print files exist in print_pathname or the default directory, their contents are overwritten. print_pathname can be a global pathname or a cell-relative name. DESCRIPTION The sec_salvage_db tool is an aid to database administration and troub- leshooting. Although day-to-day administration is handled by the rgy_edit command, sec_salvage_db can be useful for listing registry data, reconstructing databases, and salvaging corrupted databases. The sec_salvage_db command supports two methods of operation: the check and fix method and the print and reconstruct method. These methods can be used in tandem. CHECK AND FIX METHOD The -check and -fix options are not currently available. The check and fix method recovers data from a corrupted database, fixing corrupted data links, data retrieval keys, and other internal references. You can use it on a database so corrupted that it prevents the Security Server (secd) from running or registry clients from operating correctly. The check and fix method repairs the database structure so that secd can run. (Note that data may be lost if corrupted pointers in the registry data files irreversibly sever the links between records.) The check and fix method uses the sec_salvage_db -check, -fix, and -force options. The -check option accesses each record in the database and reports all errors, but makes no fixes. Although you can run it to see the state of the database before you run the -fix option, it is not required to be run. The -fix option also accesses each record in the database and reports all errors, but as it finds each error, it prompts for whether or not to fix the error. When processing is complete, sec_salvage_db prompts for whether or not to save the changes. The -force option can only be used with the -fix option. If you use it, sec_salvage_db does not prompt for confirmation before it fixes each error it finds. sec_salvage_db will still prompt for confirmation before it saves the changes. THE PRINT AND RECONSTRUCT METHOD The print and reconstruct method allows you to reconstruct a database. It first creates ASCII files, called print files, that contain all accessible data in the database. Then, it reads the data in these files to construct a new database. If you cannot start a Security Server on the database host machine, you cannot use the print and re- construct method, but must use the check and fix method. (Note that before you run sec_salvage_db with the -print and -reconstruct options, you must stop the Security Server.) In addition to reconstructing the database, the print and reconstruct method has other uses. You can use it to + Make changes to the database by manually editing the print files created by the -print option and then reconstructing them from the changed print files. This can be especially useful for changing many user passwords, which may be necessary if the master key file is corrupted. + Obtain a listing of database contents. + Copy databases between different platforms. To use the print and reconstruct method run sec_salvage_db first with the -print option and then with the -reconstruct option. The -print option creates the ASCII print files from the registry data- base files. These files can be reviewed and edited to correct faulty information, such as name-to-UNIX ID mismatches or missing data, or to update existing data. The -reconstruct option recreates the registry database files from the print files. Because the -print option creates files containing all data in the data- base and the -reconstruct option recreates the database based on these files, you can use this method to move a database to another machine or even another cell. For example, if you run sec_salvage_db -print on an uncorrupted database, you can then run sec_salvage_db -reconstruct and specify a pathname on a different machine for where the database should be created. EDITING THE PRINT FILES To edit the print files, your entries must be in the following format: field_name optional_white_space=optional_white_space value Although you can leave spaces between the field name, the equals sign, and the value, field names and values cannot contain white space. A sample org.prt file follows: Record_Number = 2 Object_Type = ORG Name = org/none UUID = 0000000C-D751-21CA-A002-08001E039D7D Unix_ID = 12 Is_Alias_Flag = false Is_Required_Flag = false Fullname = Member_Name = nobody Member_Name = root Member_Name = daemon Member_Name = uucp Member_Name = bin Member_Name = dce-ptgt Member_Name = dce-rgy Member_Name = krbtgt/abc.com Member_Name = hosts/zebra/self Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name = /.../abc.com Obj_Acl_Entry = unauthenticated:r-t----- Obj_Acl_Entry = user:root:rctDnfmM Obj_Acl_Entry = other_obj:r-t----- Obj_Acl_Entry = any_other:r-t----- To update existing entries, simply supply a new value. For example, to update a principal's full name, the entry in the princ.prt file is Fullname = fullname The fullname variable is the principal's full name. The princ.prt file contains the following entry that allows you to update a principal's password in plain text: Plaintext_Passwd = This field does not display the principal's password. To update the password, simply enter the new one in plain text after the equals sign. When the database is reconstructed, the password is encrypted and any keys derived from that password are regenerated and used to overwrite any existing encryption key entries. To specify a NULL value, delete the existing value. For example, to specify a NULL value for a fullname in the princ.prt file, the entry is Fullname = PRINT FILE FIELDS AND VALUES The following lists describe the fields in the princ.prt, group.prt, org.prt, .mkey.prt, policy.prt, rgy_state.prt, and replicas.prt files. In the lists, an * (asterisk) indicates a segment or field that can appear multiple times in succession; a + (plus sign) indicates that if a stored UUID does not map to a name required for the field, the UUID is displayed. THE PRINC.PRT FILE The fields in the princ.prt file follow: + For all records: Record_Number The sequential number of the record in the database. Object_Type An indication of the type of object: PRINC=principal, DIR=directory. Name Name of the object. UUID Unique Identifier of the object. + For principals: Unix_ID The principal's Unix ID. Is_Alias_Flag An indication of whether or not the principal name is an alias or a primary name: true=alias, false=primary. Is_Required_Flag An indication of whether or not the principal is reserved: true=principal is reserved and cannot be deleted, false=principal is not reserved. Quota The principal's object creation quota: a non- negative integer or unlimited. Fullname The principal's fullname: a text string. Member_Name* The names of the groups to which the principal belongs. Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name The default cell name of this principal's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the principals object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the principal's object ACL. Acct_Group_Name The account's group name. Acct_Org_Name The account's organization name. Acct_Creator_Name The name of principal who created this account. Acct_Creation_Time The date and time the account was created in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. The first two digits of the year, the hours, and the minutes are optional. Acct_Changer_Name Name of principal who last changed the account. Acct_Change_Time The date and time the account was last changed in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) Acct_Expire_Time The date and time the account expires or none for no expiration date. The date and time are in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) Acct_Good_Since_Time The date and time the principal's account was last known to be in an uncompromised state in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm, format or no for current time and date. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) Acct_Valid_For_Login_Flag An indication of whether or not the account can be logged into: true=account is valid for login, false=account cannot be logged into. Acct_Valid_As_Server_Flag Indicates whether or not the account is a server and can engage in authenticated communication: true=account is a server, false=account is not server. Acct_Valid_As_Client_Flag Indicates whether or not the account is a client and can log in, acquire tickets, and be authenticated: true=account is a client, false=account is not a client. Acct_Post_Dated_Cert_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not tickets with a start time some time in the future can be issued to the account's principal: true=postdated tickets can be issued, false=postdated tickets cannot be issued. Acct_Forwardable_Cert_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not a new ticket-granting ticket with a network address that differs from the present ticket-granting address can be issued to the account's principal: true=account can get forwardable certificates, false=account cannot. Acct_TGT_Auth_Cert_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not tickets issued to the account's principal can use the ticket-granting- ticket authentication mechanism: true=tickets can use the ticket-granting-ticket authentication mechanism, false=they cannot. Acct_Renewable_Cert_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not tickets issued to the principal's ticket-granting ticket to be renewed: true=tickets can be renewed, false=tickets cannot be renewed. Acct_Proxiable_Cert_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not a new ticket with a different network address than the present ticket can be issued to the account's principal: true=such a ticket can be issued, false=such a ticket cannot be issued. Acct_Dup_Session_Key_Ok_Flag Indicates whether or not tickets issued to the account's principal can have duplicate keys: true=account can have duplicate session keys, false=account cannot. Unix_Key The account principal's encrypted UNIX password: ASCII string. Plaintext_Passwd Stores the principal's password in plain text. This field is provided to allow principal's passwords to be changed. When the princ.prt file is processed by the sec_salvage_db -reconstruct option, this pass- word is encrypted using UNIX system encryption. This encrypted password is then stored as the principal's encrypted UNIX password in the Unix_Key field. Home_Dir The account principal's home directory: text string. Shell The account principal's login shell: text string. Gecos The account's GECOS information: text string. Passwd_Valid_Flag Indicates whether or not the account principal's password is valid: true=password is valid, false=password not valid. Passwd_Change_Time The date and time the account principal's password was last changed in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format or now for the current date and time. The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional. Max_Certificate_Lifetime The number of hours before the Authentication Service must renew the account principal's service certificates: an integer indicating the time in hours or default-policy to use the registry default. Max_Renewable_Lifetime The number of hours before a session with the account principal's identity expires and the principal must log in again to reauthenticate: an integer indicating the time in hours or default-policy to use the registry default. Master_Key_Version The version of the master key used to encrypt the account principal's key. Num_Auth_Keys The number of the account principal's authentication keys. Auth_Key_Version* A list of the version numbers of the account principal's authentication key. The first version number on the list represents the current authenti- cation key. Auth_Key_Pepper* The pepper algorithm used for the account principal's key: a text string or blank to use the default pepper algorithm. Auth_Key_Len* The length in bytes of the account principal's authentication key. Auth_Key* The account principal's authentication key: hex string. Auth_Key_Expire_Time* The date and time the account principal's authenti- cation key expires or none for no expiration. Date and time are in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) + For directories: Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial container ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial container ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial container ACL. THE GROUP.PRT FILE The fields in the group.prt file follow: + For all records: Record_Number The sequential number of the record in the database. Object_Type An indication of the type of object: GROUP=group, DIR=directory. Name Name of the object. UUID Unique Identifier of the object. + For groups: Unix_ID Unix ID of the group. Is_Alias_Flag An indication of whether or not the group name is an alias or a primary name: true=alias, false=primary. Is_Required_Flag An indication of whether or not the group is reserved: true=group is reserved and cannot be deleted, false=group is not reserved. Projlist_Ok_Flag An indication of whether or not the group can be included in project lists: true=group can be included on project lists, false=group cannot be included. Fullname The group's fullname: a text string. Member_Name* The names of the group's members. Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of this group's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the group's object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*: The contents of the group's object ACL. + For directories: Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of this directory's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry* The contents of the directory's object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial container ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial container ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial container ACL. THE ORG.PRT FILE The fields in the org.prt file follow: + For all records: Record_Number The sequential number of the record in the database. Object_Type An indication of the type of object: ORG=organization, DIR=directory. Name Name of the object. UUID Unique Identifier of the object. + For organizations: Unix_ID Unix ID of the organization. Is_Alias_Flag An indication of whether or not the organization is an alias or a primary name: true=alias, false=primary. Is_Required_Flag An indication of whether or not the organization is reserved: true=organization is reserved and cannot be deleted, false=organization is not reserved. Fullname The organization's fullname: a text string. Member_Name* The names of the organization's members. Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name The default cell name of this organization's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the organization's object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the organization's object ACL. + For organizations with policy: Acct_Lifetime The period during which accounts for the organiza- tion are valid: a integer number representing days or forever. Passwd_Min_Len The minimum length of the organization's password: a non-negative integer. Passwd_Lifetime The span in days of the lifetime of the organiza- tion's password: an integer or forever. Passwd_Expire_Time The date and time the organization's password expires in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) Passwd_All_Spaces_Ok An indication of whether or not the organization's password can consist of all spaces: true=can consist of spaces, false=cannot. Passwd_All_Alphanumeric_Ok An indication of whether or not the organization's password can consist of all alphanumeric characters: true=can be all alphanumeric, false=cannot. + For directories: Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial object ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Def_Cell_Name+ The default cell name of the directory's initial container ACL. Num_Acl_Entries The number of entries in the directory's initial container ACL. Init_Cont_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the directory's initial container ACL. THE .MKEY.PRT FILE The fields in the .mkey.prt file follow: Master_Key_Version The integer version of the master key. Master_Key_Keytype Always des. Master_Key_Length The length of the master key in bytes. Master_Key The master key in hex string format. The policy.prt File The fields in the policy.prt file follow: Rgy_Policy_File_Version An integer representing the version of the policy information. Prop_Read_Version A number indicating the property record's read version. Prop_Write_Version A number indicating the property record's write version. Min_Certificate_Lifetime The minimum amount of time before the principal's ticket must be renewed in weekswdaysdhourshminutesm format. Default_Certificate_Lifetime The the default lifetime for tickets issued to principals in this cell's registry in weekswdaysdhourshminutesm format. Low_Unix_ID_Principal The starting point for principal UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when a principal is added: an integer, which must be less than Max_Unix_ID. Low_Unix_ID_Group The the starting point for UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when a group is added: an integer, which must be less than Max_Unix_ID. Low_Unix_ID_Org The starting point for UNIX IDs automatically generated by the Security Service when an organization is added using: an integer, which must be less than Max_Unix_ID. Max_Unix_ID The highest number that can be supplied as a UNIX ID when principals are created: an integer. Rgy_Readonly_Flag An indication of whether or not the registry is read-only: true=read only, false=updateable. Auth_Certificate_Unbound_Flag An indication of whether or not certificates are generated for use on any machine: true=yes, false=no. Shadow_Passwd_Flag Determines whether encrypted passwords are sent over the network: true=encrypted passwords are not sent over the network, false=encrypted passwords are sent over the network. Embedded_Unix_ID_Flag Determines if UNIX IDs are embedded in person, group, and organization UUIDs: true=UNIX IDs are embedded, false=UNIX IDs are not embedded. Realm_Name The name of the full global pathname of realm running the secd. Realm_UUID The UUID of the realm running the secd. Unauthenticated_Quota The quota of unauthenticated users: a number or unlimited. Acct_Lifetime The period during which accounts are valid: a integer number representing days or forever. Passwd_Min_Len The minimum length of passwords: a non-negative integer. Passwd_Lifetime The span in days of the password lifetimes: an integer or forever. Passwd_Expire_Time The date and time the passwords expire in yyyy/mm/dd.hh:mm format. (The first two digits of the year, the hours and the minutes are optional.) Passwd_All_Spaces_Ok An indication of whether or not passwords can consist of all spaces: true=can consist of spaces, false=cannot. Passwd_All_Alphanumeric_Ok Am indication of whether or not passwords can consist of all alphanumeric characters: true=can be all alpha- numeric, false=cannot. Max_Certificate_Lifetime The number of hours before the Authentication Service must renew service certificates: an integer indicating the time in hours or default-policy to use the registry default. Max_Renewable_Lifetime The number of hours before sessions expire and the session principal must log in again to reauthenticate: an integer indicating the time in hours or default- policy to use the registry default. Princ_Cache_State The timestamp of the principal cache. Group_Cache_State The timestamp of the group cache. Org_Cache_State The timestamp of the organization cache. My_Name The cell-relative name of the security server. Master_Key_Version The integer version of current master key. Master_Key_Keytype Always des. Master_Key_Length The length of the master key in bytes. Master_Key The master key in hex string format. Old_Master_Key_Version The version of the previous master key. Old_Master_Key_Keytype Always des. Old_Master_Key_Length: The length of the previous master key in bytes. Old_Master_Key: The previous master key in hex string format. Obj_Acl_Def_Cell_Name: The default cell name of the policy object ACL. Num_Acl_Entries: The number of entries in the policy object ACL. Obj_Acl_Entry*+ The contents of the policy object ACL. The rgy_state.prt File The fields in the rgy_state.prt file follow: Rgy_State_File_Version The integer version number of the format of the rgy_state file. Replica_State The state of the master registry: unknown_to_master, uninitialized, in_service, in_maintenance, closed, deleted, or initializing. Cell_UUID The UUID of cell in which the secd resides. Server_UUID The UUID of this secd. Initialization_UUID The UUID of the last initialization event. Master_File_Version The version number of the master replica. Master_Known_Flag An indicate of whether or not the master replica is known to this replica: true=known, false=not known. Only if this field is true do the other master field contain valid information. Master_UUID The UUID of the master replica. Master_Seqno: The 2-digit sequence number of the event when the master became the master in n.n format. The replicas.prt File The fields in the replicas.prt file follow: Record_Number The sequential number of the record in the database. Replica_UUID The UUID listed for the replica in the replica list. Replica_Name The name of the replica as known to the Cell Directory Service. Num_Towers The number of towers. Tower_Length* The Length of the next tower (in bytes). Tower* The tower used to communicate with the replica (a byte stream that can be broken on word boundaries). Propagation_Type An indication of whether the replica is initialized, initializing, in the process of being updated, or in the process of being deleted. Initialization_UUID UUID of the last initialization. ERROR CONDITIONS You receive the following error message if the default rgy_data directory is being used and there is an advisory lock on the rgy_state data file: Registry: Error - database is locked. Put secd into maintenance mode or clear advisory lock on rgy_state file in db_pathname The existence of the advisory lock implies that secd is in service. Use the sec_admin command to put secd in maintenance mode. If secd is not running, the advisory lock may be the result of an ungraceful shutdown of secd. To remove the advisory lock, use the rename command to rename the DCE$LOCAL:[VAR.SECURITY.RGY_DATA]RGY_STATE.; file, and then change it back to its original name. Then rerun the sec_salvage_db command.
2 – Admin File
This section describes v5srvtab, a DCE Security file used for system administration. NAME v5srvtab - The server and machine keytab file DESCRIPTION The DCE$LOCAL:[KRB5]V5SRVTAB.; file is a file on the local node created by the rgy_edit command, the sec_create_db command, or any application that makes sec_key_mgmt() calls. The file contains passwords for servers and machine accounts. To view or manipulate the contents of this file, use the sec_key_mgmt API, described in the OSF DCE Application Development Guide - Core Components and the OSF DCE Application Development Reference. RELATED INFORMATION BOOKS: OSF DCE Application Development Guide - Core Components OSF DCE Application Development Reference
3 – API Intro
NAME sec_intro - Application Program Interface to the DCE Security Service DESCRIPTION The Distributed Computing Environment (DCE) Security Service Application Program Interface (API) allows developers to create network services with complete access to all the authentication and authorization capabilities of DCE Security Service and facilities. The transaction of a network service generally consists of a client process requesting some action from a server process. The client may itself be a server, or a user, and the server may also be a client of other servers. Before the targeted server executes the specified action, it must be sure of the client's identity, and it must know whether the client is authorized to request the service. The Security Service API consists of the following sets of Remote Procedure Calls (RPCs) used to communicate with various security- related services and facilities: + rgy - Maintains the network registry of principal identities. + era - Maintains extended registry attributes. + login - Validates a principal's network identity and establish delegated identities. + epa - Extracts privilege attributes from an opaque binding handle. + acl - Implements an Access Control List (ACL) protocol for the authorization of a principal to network access and services. + key - Provides facilities for the maintenance of account keys for daemon principals. + id - Maps file system names to Universal Unique IDs (UUIDs). + pwd_mgmt - Provides facilities for password management. All the calls in this API have names beginning with the sec_ prefix. These are the same calls used by various user-level tools provided as part of the DCE. For example, the sec_create_db tool is written with sec_rgy calls, acl_edit is written with sec_acl calls, and the login program, with which a user logs in to a DCE system, is written using sec_login calls. Most sites will find the user-level tools adequate for their needs, and only must use the Security Service API to customize or replace the functionality of these tools. Though most of the calls in the Security Service API represent RPC transactions, code has been provided on the client side to handle much of the overhead involved with making remote calls. These "stubs" handle binding to the requested security server site, the marshalling of data into whatever form is needed for transmission, and other bookkeeping involved with these remote calls. An application programmer can use the Security Service interfaces as if they were composed of simple C functions. This reference page introduces each of the following APIs: + Registry APIs + Login APIs + Extended Privilege Attributes APIs + Extended Registry Attributes APIs + ACL APIs + Key Management APIs + ID Mapping APIs + Password Management APIs The section for each API is organized as follows: + Synopsis + Data Types + Constants + Files
3.1 – REGISTRY_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rgybase.h> DATA TYPES The following data types are used in sec_rgy_ calls: sec_rgy_handle_t A pointer to the registry server handle. The registry server is bound to a handle with the sec_rgy_site_open() routine. sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t A enumeration that defines whether or not the binding is authenticated. This data type is used in conjunction with the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t data type to set up the authorization method and parameters for a binding. The sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t type consists of the following elements: + sec_rgy_bind_auth_none-The binding is not authenticated. + sec_rgy_bind_auth_dce-The binding uses DCE shared-secret key authentication. sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t A discriminated union that defines authorization and authentication parameters for a binding. This data type is used in conjunction with the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t data type to set up the authorization method and parameters for a binding. The sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t data type consists of the following elements: info_type A sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t data type that specifies whether or not the binding is authenticated. The contents of the union depend on the value of sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t. For unauthenticated bindings (sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t = sec_rgy_bind_auth_none), no parameters are supplied. For authenticated bindings (sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_type_t = sec_rgy_bind_auth_dce), the dce_info structure is supplied. dce_info A structure that consists of the following elements: authn_level An unsigned 32 bit integer indicating the protection level for RPC calls made using the server binding handle. The protection level determines the degree to which authenticated communications between the client and the server are protected by the authentication service specified by authn_svc. If the RPC runtime or the RPC protocol in the bound protocol sequence does not support a specified level, the level is automatically upgraded to the next higher supported level. The possible protection levels are as follows: + rpc_c_protect_level_default - Uses the default protection level for the specified authentication service. The default protection level for DCE shared-secret key authentication is rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_value + rpc_c_protect_level_none - Performs no authentication: tickets are not exchanged, session keys are not established, client PACs or names are not certified, and trans- missions are in the clear. Note that although uncertified PACs should not be trusted, they may be useful for debugging, tracing, and measurement purposes. + rpc_c_protect_level_connect - Authenticates only when the client establishes a rela- tionship with the server. + rpc_c_protect_level_call - Authenticates only at the beginning of each remote procedure call when the server receives the request. This level does not apply to remote procedure calls made over a connection-based protocol sequence (that is, ncacn_ip_tcp). If this level is specified and the binding handle uses a connection-based protocol sequence, the routine uses the rpc_c_protect_level_pkt level instead. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt - Ensures that all data received is from the expected client. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_integ - Ensures and verifies that none of the data trans- ferred between client and server has been modified. This is the highest protection level that is guaranteed to be present in the RPC runtime. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_privacy - Authenticates as specified by all of the previous levels and also encrypts each RPC argument value. This is the highest protection level, but is not guaranteed to be present in the RPC runtime. authn_svc Specifies the authentication service to use. The exact level of protection provided by the authentication service is specified by protect_level. The supported authentication services are as follows: + rpc_c_authn_none - No authentication: no tickets are exchanged, no session keys established, client PACs or names are not transmitted, and transmissions are in the clear. Specify rpc_c_authn_none to turn authentication off for remote procedure calls made using this binding. + rpc_c_authn_dce_secret - DCE shared-secret key authentication. + rpc_c_authn_default - Default authentica- tion service. The current default authen- tication service is DCE shared-secret key; therefore, specifying rpc_c_authn_default is equivalent to specifying rpc_c_authn_dce_secret . + rpc_c_authn_dce_public - DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). authz_svc Specifies the authorization service implemented by the server for the interface. The validity and trustworthiness of authorization data, like any application data, is dependent on the authentication service and protection level specified. The supported authorization services are as follows: + rpc_c_authz_none - Server performs no authorization. This is valid only if authn_svc is set to rpc_c_authn_none, specifying that no authentication is being performed. + rpc_c_authz_name - Server performs authorization based on the client principal name. This value cannot be used if authn_svc is rpc_c_authn_none. + rpc_c_authz_dce - Server performs authorization using the client's DCE Privilege Attribute Certificate (PAC) sent to the server with each remote procedure call made with this binding. Generally, access is checked against DCE Access Control Lists (ACLs). identity A value of type sec_login_handle_t that represents a complete login context. sec_timeval_sec_t A 32-bit integer containing the seconds portion of a UNIX timeval_t, to be used when expressing absolute dates. sec_timeval_t A structure containing the full UNIX time. The structure contains two 32-bit integers that indicate seconds (sec) and microseconds (usec) since 0:00, January 1, 1970. sec_timeval_period_t A 32-bit integer expressing seconds relative to some well-known time. sec_rgy_acct_key_t Specifies how many parts (person, group, organization) of an account login name will be enough to specify a unique abbreviation for that account. sec_rgy_cursor_t A structure providing a pointer into a registry database. This type is used for iterative operations on the registry information. For example, a call to sec_rgy_pgo_get_members() might return the 10 account names following the input sec_rgy_cursor_t position. Upon return, the cursor position will have been updated, so the next call to that routine will return the next 10 names. The components of this structure are not used by application programs. sec_rgy_pname_t A character string of length sec_rgy_pname_t_size. sec_rgy_name_t A character string of length sec_rgy_name_t_size. sec_rgy_login_name_t A structure representing an account login name. It contains three strings of type sec_rgy_name_t: pname The person name for the account. gname The group name for the account. oname The organization name for the account. sec_rgy_member_t A character string of length sec_rgy_name_t_size. LI "sec_rgy_foreign_id_t" The representation of a foreign ID. This structure contains two components: cell A string of type uuid_t representing the UUID of the foreign cell. principal A string of type uuid_t representing the UUID of the principal. sec_rgy_sid_t A structure identifying an account. It contains three fields: person The UUID of the person part of the account. group The UUID of the group part of the account. org The UUID of the organization part of the account. sec_rgy_unix_sid_t A structure identifying an account with UNIX ID numbers. It contains three fields: person The UNIX ID of the person part of the account. group The UNIX ID of the group part of the account. org The UNIX ID of the organization part of the account. sec_rgy_domain_t This 32-bit integer specifies which naming domain a character string refers to: person, group, or organization. sec_rgy_pgo_flags_t A 32-bit bitset containing flags pertaining to registry entries. This type contains the following three flags: sec_rgy_pgo_is_an_alias If set, indicates the registry entry is an alias of another entry. sec_rgy_pgo_is_required If set, the registry item is required and cannot be deleted. An example of a required account is the one for the registry server itself. sec_rgy_pgo_projlist_ok If the accompanying item is a person entry, this flag indicates the person may have concurrent group sets. If the item is a group entry, the flag means this group can appear in a concurrent group set. The flag is undefined for organization items. sec_rgy_pgo_item_t The structure identifying a registry item. It contains five com- ponents: id The UUID of the registry item, in uuid_t form. unix_num A 32-bit integer containing the UNIX ID number of the registry item. quota A 32-bit integer representing the maximum number of user- defined groups the account owner can create. flags A sec_rgy_pgo_flags_t bitset containing information about the entry. fullname A sec_rgy_pname_t character string containing a full name for the registry entry. For a person entry, this field might contain the real name of the account owner. For a group, it might contain a description of the group. This is just a data field, and registry queries cannot search on the fullname entry. sec_rgy_acct_admin_flags_t A 32-bit bitset containing administration flags used as part of the administrator's information for any registry account. The set contains three flags: sec_rgy_acct_admin_valid Specifies that the account is valid for login. sec_rgy_acct_admin_server If set, the account's name can be used as a server name in a ticket-granting ticket. sec_rgy_acct_admin_client If set, the account's name can be used as a client name in a ticket-granting ticket. Note that you can prevent the principal from being authenticated, by turning off both the sec_rgy_acct_admin_server and the sec_rgy_acct_admin_client flags. sec_rgy_acct_auth_flags_t A 32-bit bitset containing account authorization flags used to implement authentication policy as defined by the Kerberos Version 5 protocol. The set contains six flags: sec_rgy_acct_auth_post_dated Allows issuance of post-dated certificates. sec_rgy_acct_auth_forwardable Allows issuance of forwardable certificates. sec_rgy_acct_auth_tgt Allows issuance of certificates based on Ticket-Granting Ticket (TGT) authentication. If this flag is not set, a client requesting a service may have to supply a password directly to the server. sec_rgy_acct_auth_renewable Allows issuance of renewable certificates. sec_rgy_acct_auth_proxiable Allows issuance of proxiable certificates. sec_rgy_acct_auth_dup_session_key Allows issuance of duplicate session keys. sec_rgy_acct_admin_t The portion of a registry account item containing components relevant to administrators. This structure consists of the fields listed below. Note that only expiration_date, good_since_date, flags, and authentication_flags can be modified by an administrator; the remaining fields are set by the Security server. creator This field, in foreign_id_t format, identifies the administrator who created the registry account. creation_date Specifies the creation date of the account, in sec_timeval_sec_t format. last_changer Identifies the last person to change any of the account information, in foreign_id_t format. change_date Specifies the date of the last modification of the account information, in sec_timeval_sec_t format. expiration_date The date after which the account will no longer be valid. In sec_timeval_sec_t format. good_since_date The Kerberos Version 5 TGT revocation date. TGTs issued before this date will not be honored. In sec_timeval_sec_t format. flags Administrative flags in sec_rgy_acct_admin_flags_t format. authentication_flags Authentication flags in sec_rgy_acct_auth_flags_t format. sec_rgy_acct_user_flags_t A 32-bit bitset containing flags controlling user-modifiable information. There is only one flag currently implemented. If sec_rgy_acct_user_passwd_valid is set, it indicates the user pass- word is valid. If it is not set, this flag prompts the user to change the password on the next login attempt. sec_rgy_acct_user_t A structure containing registry account information. The structure consists of the fields listed below. Note that only the gecos, homedir, shell, and flags fields can be modified by the account owner or other authorized useer; the remaining fields are set by the Security server. gecos This is a character string (in sec_rgy_pname_t format) containing information about the account user. It generally consists of everything after the full name in the UNIX gecos format. homedir The login directory for the account user, in sec_rgy_pname_t format. shell The default shell for the account user, in sec_rgy_pname_t format. passwd_version_number An unsigned 32-bit integer, indicating the password version number. This value is used as output only. passwd The UNIX encrypted account password, in sec_rgy_unix_passwd_buf_t format. This value is used as output only. passwd_dtm The date the password was established, in sec_timeval_sec_t format. flags Account user flags, in sec_rgy_acct_user_flags_t format. sec_rgy_plcy_pwd_flags_t A 32-bit bitset containing two flags about password policy: sec_rgy_plcy_pwd_no_spaces If set, will not allow spaces in a password. sec_rgy_plcy_pwd_non_alpha If set, requires at least one nonalphanumeric character in the password. sec_rgy_plcy_t A structure defining aspects of registry account policy. It contains five components: passwd_min_len A 32-bit integer describing the minimum number of characters in the account password. passwd_lifetime The number of seconds after a password's creation until it expires, in sec_timeval_period_t format. passwd_exp_date The expiration date of the account password, in sec_timeval_sec_t format. acct_lifespan The number of seconds after the creation of an account before it expires, in sec_timeval_period_t format. passwd_flags Account password policy flags, in sec_rgy_plcy_pwd_flags_t format. sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t This type describes authentication policy. It is a structure containing two time periods, in sec_timeval_period_t format. One, max_ticket_lifetime, specifies the maximum length of the period during which a Ticket-Granting Ticket (TGT) will be valid. The other, max_renewable_lifetime, specifies the maximum length of time for which such a ticket may be renewed. This authentication policy applies both to the registry as a whole as well as individual accounts. The effective policy for a given account is defined to bethe more restrictive of the site and principal authen- tication policy. sec_rgy_properties_t A structure describing some registry properties. It contains the following: read_version A 32-bit integer describing the earliest version of the secd software that can read this registry. write_version A 32-bit integer describing the version of the secd soft- ware that wrote this registry. minimum_ticket_lifetime The minimum lifetime of an authentication certificate, in sec_timeval_period_t format. default_certificate_lifetime The "normal" lifetime of an an authentication certificate (ticket-granting ticket in Kerberos parlance), in sec_timeval_period_t format. Processes may request authentication certificates with longer lifetimes up to, but not in excess of, the maximum allowable lifetime as determined by the effective policy for the account. low_unix_id_person The lowest UNIX number permissible for a person item in the registry. low_unix_id_group The lowest UNIX number permissible for a group item in the registry. low_unix_id_org The lowest UNIX number permissible for an organization item in the registry. max_unix_id The largest UNIX number permissible for any registry entry. flags Property flags, in sec_rgy_properties_flags_t format. realm The name of the cell, in sec_rgy_name_t form, for which this registry is the authentication service. realm_uuid The UUID of the same cell. sec_rgy_properties_flags_t A 32-bit bitset, containing flags concerning registry properties: sec_rgy_prop_readonly If set (TRUE), indicates that this registry is a query site. sec_rgy_prop_auth_cert_unbound If set (TRUE), the registry server will accept requests from any site. sec_rgy_prop_shadow_passwd If the shadow password flag is set (TRUE), the registry server will not include the account password when responding to a request for the user data from a specified account. This helps minimize the risk of an account password being intercepted while traveling over the network. sec_rgy_prop_embedded_unix_id Indicates that all UUIDs in this registry contain a UNIX number embedded. This implies that the UNIX numbers of objects in the registry cannot be changed, since UUIDs are immutable. sec_rgy_override_t A 32-bit integer used as a flag for registry override mode. Currently, its possible values are the constants sec_rgy_no_override and sec_rgy_override. When this mode is enabled, override data supplied by the node administrator will replace some of the data gotten from the registry for a given person/account under certain conditions. These conditions are as follows: 1. The registry permits the requested overrides to be set for this machine. 2. The override data is intended for person/account at hand. When the mode is "override off," data from the registry is returned to the end user or the application remains untouched. sec_rgy_mode_resolve_t A 32-bit integer used as a flag for resolve mode. Currently, its possible values are the constants sec_rgy_no_resolve_pname and sec_rgy_resolve_pname. When the mode is enabled, pathnames containing leading // (slashes) will be translated into a form understandable by the local machine's NFS. sec_rgy_unix_passwd_buf_t A character array of UNIX password strings. CONSTANTS The following constants are used in sec_rgy_ calls: sec_rgy_default_handle The value of an unbound registry server handle. sec_rgy_acct_key_t Constants The following 32-bit integer constants are used with the sec_rgy_acct_key_t data type: sec_rgy_acct_key_none Invalid key. sec_rgy_acct_key_person The person name alone is enough. sec_rgy_acct_key_group The person and group names are both necessary for the account abbreviation. sec_rgy_acct_key_org The person, group, and organization names are all necessary. sec_rgy_acct_key_last Key values must be less than this constant. sec_rgy_pname_t_size The maximum number of characters in a sec_rgy_pname_t. sec_rgy_name_t_size The maximum number of characters in a sec_rgy_name_t. sec_rgy_domain_t Constants The following 32-bit integer constants are the possible values of the sec_rgy_domain_t data type: sec_rgy_domain_person The name in question refers to a person. sec_rgy_domain_group The name in question refers to a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name in question refers to an organization. sec_rgy_pgo_flags_t A 32-bit constant equal to a variable of type sec_rgy_pgo_flags_t with no flags set. sec_rgy_quota_unlimited A 32-bit integer. Set the quota field of the sec_rgy_pgo_item_t type to this constant to override the registry quota limitation. sec_rgy_acct_admin_flags_t A 32-bit integer. This is the value of the sec_rgy_acct_admin_flags_t bitset when none of its flags are set. sec_rgy_acct_auth_flags_none A 32-bit integer. This is the value of the sec_rgy_acct_auth_flags_t bitset when none of its flags are set. sec_rgy_acct_user_flags_t A 16-bit integer. This is the value of the sec_rgy_acct_user_flags_t bitset when none of its flags are set. sec_rgy_plcy_pwd_flags_t A 16-bit integer. This is the value of the sec_rgy_policy_pwd_flags_t bitset when none of its flags are set. sec_rgy_properties_flags_t A 16-bit integer. This is the value of the sec_rgy_properties_flags_t bitset when none of its flags are set. sec_rgy_override A 32-bit integer, which turns registry override mode on. When this mode is enabled, override data supplied by the node administrator will replace some of the data gotten from the registry for a given person/account under certain conditions. sec_rgy_no_override A 32-bit integer, which turns off registry override mode. sec_rgy_resolve_pname A 32-bit integer, which turns on registry resolve mode. When the mode is enabled, pathnames containing leading // (slashes) will be translated into a form understandable by the local machine's NFS. sec_rgy_no_resolve_pname A 32-bit integer, which turns off registry resolve mode. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RGYBASE.IDL The idl file from which rgybase.h was derived.
3.2 – EXTENDED_REGISTRY_ATTRIBUTE_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_attr_base.h> DATA TYPES The following data types are used in sec_rgy_attr calls: sec_attr_twr_ref_t A pointer to a tower. This data type is used with the sec_attr_twr_set_t data type to allow a client to pass an unallocated array of towers, which the server must allocate. Both data types are used in conjunction with the sec_attr_bind_type_t data type. sec_attr_twr_set_t A structure that defines an array of towers. This data type is used with the sec_attr_twr_ref_t data type to allow a client to pass an unallocated array of towers, which the server must allocate. Both data types are used in conjunction with the sec_attr_bind_type_t data type. The sec_attr_twr_set_t structure consists of the following elements: count An unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the number of towers in the array. towers[] An array of pointers (of type sec_attr_twr_ref_t) to towers. sec_attr_bind_type_t A 32-bit integer that specifies the type of binding used by an attribute interface. The data type (which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_binding_t data type) uses the following constants: sec_attr_bind_type_string An RPC string binding. sec_attr_bind_type_twrs A DCE protocol tower representation of a bindings. sec_attr_bind_type_svrname A name in rpc_c_ns_syntax format that identifies a CDS entry containing the server's binding information. This constant has the following structure: name_syntax Must be rpc_c_ns_syntax_dce to specify that DCE naming rules are used to specify name. name A pointer to a name of a CDS entry in rpc_c_ns_syntax_dce syntax. sec_attr_binding_t A discriminated union that supplies information to generate a binding handle for a attribute trigger. This data type, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_bind_info_t data type, is composed of the following elements: bind_type A value of type sec_attr_bind_type_t that defines the type of binding used by an attribute interface. The contents of tagged union (below) depend on the value of sec_attr_bind_type_t. tagged_union A tagged union specifying the binding handle. The contents of the tagged union depend on the value of bind_type as follows: If bind_type is... Then tagged_union is... _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_bind_type_string A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit character string specifying an attribute's RPC string binding. _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_bind type_twrs An attribute's tower binding representation of type sec_attr_twr_set_t. _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_bind_svrname A pointer to a name of type sec_attr_bind_type_t that specifies a Cell Directory Service entry containing an attribute trigger's binding information. sec_attr_binding_p_t A pointer to a sec_attr_binding_t union. sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t An enumeration that defines whether or not the binding is authenti- cated. This data type is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_bind_auth_info_t data type to set up the authorization method and parameters for an RPC binding. The sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t type consists of the following elements: + sec_attr_bind_auth_none-The binding is not authenticated. + sec_attr_bind_auth_dce-The binding uses DCE shared-secret key authentication. sec_attr_bind_auth_info_t A discriminated union that defines authorization and authentication parameters for a binding. This data type is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t data type to set up the authorization method and parameters for an RPC binding. The sec_attr_bind_auth_info_t data type consists of the following elements: info_type A sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t data type that specifies whether or not the binding is authenticated. The contents of tagged union (below) depend on the value of sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t. tagged_union A tagged union specifying the method of authorization and the authorization parameters. For unauthenticated bindings (sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t = sec_attr_bind_auth_none) no parameters are supplied. For authenticated bindings (sec_attr_bind_auth_info_type_t = sec_attr_bind_auth_dce), the following union is supplied: svr_princ_name A pointer to a character string that specifies the principal name of the server referenced by the binding handle. protect_level An unsigned 32 bit integer indicating the protection level for RPC calls made using the server binding handle. The protection level determines the degree to which authenticated communications between the client and the server are protected by the authentication service specified by authn_svc. If the RPC runtime or the RPC protocol in the bound protocol sequence does not support a specified level, the level is automatically upgraded to the next higher supported level. The possible protection levels are as follows: + rpc_c_protect_level_default - Uses the default protection level for the specified authentication service. The default protection level for DCE shared-secret key authentication is rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_value + rpc_c_protect_level_none - Performs no authentication: tickets are not exchanged, session keys are not established, client PACs or names are not certified, and transmissions are in the clear. Note that although uncertified PACs should not be trusted, they may be useful for debugging, tracing, and measurement purposes. + rpc_c_protect_level_connect - Authenticates only when the client establishes a relationship with the server. + rpc_c_protect_level_call - Authenticates only at the beginning of each remote procedure call when the server receives the request. This level does not apply to remote procedure calls made over a connection-based protocol sequence (that is, ncacn_ip_tcp). If this level is specified and the binding handle uses a connection-based protocol sequence, the routine uses the rpc_c_protect_level_pkt level instead. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt - Ensures that all data received is from the expected client. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_integ - Ensures and verifies that none of the data trans- ferred between client and server has been modified. This is the highest protection level that is guaranteed to be present in the RPC runtime. + rpc_c_protect_level_pkt_privacy - Authenticates as specified by all of the previous levels and also encrypts each RPC argument value. This is the highest protection level, but is not guaranteed to be present in the RPC runtime. authn_svc Specifies the authentication service to use. The exact level of protection provided by the authentication service is specified by protect_level. The supported authentication services are as follows: + rpc_c_authn_none - No authentication: no tickets are exchanged, no session keys established, client PACs or names are not transmitted, and transmissions are in the clear. Specify rpc_c_authn_none to turn authentication off for remote procedure calls made using this binding. + rpc_c_authn_dce_secret - DCE shared-secret key authentication. + rpc_c_authn_default - Default authentica- tion service. The current default authen- tication service is DCE shared-secret key; therefore, specifying rpc_c_authn_default is equivalent to specifying rpc_c_authn_dce_secret. + rpc_c_authn_dce_public - DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). authz_svc Specifies the authorization service implemented by the server for the interface. The validity and trustworthiness of authorization data, like any application data, is dependent on the authentication service and protection level specified. The supported authorization services are as follows: + rpc_c_authz_none - Server performs no authorization. This is valid only if authn_svc is set to rpc_c_authn_none, specifying that no authentication is being performed. + rpc_c_authz_name - Server performs authorization based on the client principal name. This value cannot be used if authn_svc is rpc_c_authn_none. + rpc_c_authz_dce - Server performs authorization using the client's DCE Privilege Attribute Certificate (PAC) sent to the server with each remote procedure call made with this binding. Generally, access is checked against DCE Access Control Lists (ACLs). sec_attr_bind_info_t A structure that specifies attribute trigger binding information. This data type, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type, contains of the following elements: auth_info The binding authorization information of type sec_attr_bind_auth_info_t. num_bindings An unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the number of binding handles in bindings. bindings An array of sec_attr_binding_t data types that specify binding handles. sec_attr_bind_info_p_t A pointer to a sec_attr_bind_info_t union. sec_attr_encoding_t An enumerator that contains attribute encoding tags used to define the legal encodings for attribute values. The data type, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_value_t and sec_attr_schema_entry_t data types, consists of the following elements: sec_attr_enc_any The attribute value can be of any legal encoding type. This encoding tag is legal only in a schema entry. An attribute entry must contain a concrete encoding type. sec_attr_enc_void The attribute has no value. It is simple a marker that is either present or absent. sec_attr_enc_printstring The attribute value is a printable IDL string in DCE Portable Character Set. sec_attr_enc_printstring_array The attribute value is an array of printstrings. sec_attr_enc_integer The attribute value is a signed 32-bit integer. sec_attr_enc_bytes The attribute value is a string of bytes. The string is assumed to be a pickle or some other self describing type. (See also the sec_attr_enc_bytes_t data type.) sec_attr_enc_confidential_bytes The attribute value is a string of bytes that have been encrypted in the key of the principal object to which the attribute is attached. The string is assumed to be a pickle or some other self describing type. This encoding type is useful only when attached to a principal object, where it is decrypted and encrypted each time the principal's password changes. (See also the sec_attr_enc_bytes_t data type.) sec_attr_enc_i18n_data The attribute value is an "internationalized" string of bytes with a tag identifying the OSF registered codeset used to encode the data. (See also the sec_attr_i18n_data_t data type.) sec_attr_enc_uuid The attribute is a value of type uuid_t, a DCE UUID. sec_attr_enc_attr_set The attribute value is an attribute set, a vector of attribute UUIDs used to associate multiple related attribute instances which are members of the set. (See also the sec_attr_enc_attr_set_t data type.) sec_attr_enc_binding The attribute value is a sec_attr_bind_info_t data type that specifies DCE server binding information. sec_attr_enc_trig_binding This encoding type is returned by rs_attr_lookup call. It informs the client agent of the trigger binding informa- tion of an attribute with a query trigger. Unless sec_attr_enc_void or sec_attr_enc_any is specified, the attribute values must conform to the attribute's encoding type. sec_attr_enc_bytes_t A structure that defines the length of attribute encoding values for attributes encoded as sec_attr_enc_bytes and sec_attr_enc_confidential_bytes. The structure, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_value_t data type, consists of: An unsigned 32-bit integer that defines the data length. data[] An array of bytes specifying the length of attribute encoding data. sec_attr_i18n_data_t A structure that defines the codeset used for attributes encoded as sec_attr_enc_il8n_data and the length of the attribute encoding values. The structure, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_value_t data type, consists of: An unsigned 32-bit identifier of a codeset registered with the Open Software Foundation. An unsigned 32-bit integer that defines the data length. data[] An array of bytes specifying the length of attribute encoding data. sec_attr_enc_attr_set_t A structure that that supplies the UUIDs of each member of an attribute set. The structure, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_value_t data type, consists of: num_members An unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the total number of attribute's in the set. members[] An array containing values of type uuid_t, the UUID of each member in the set. sec_attr_enc_printstring_t A structure that contains a printstring. sec_attr_enc_printstring_p_t A pointer to a sec_attr_enc_printstring_t structure. sec_attr_enc_str_array_t A structure that defines a printstring array. It consists of: num_strings An unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the number of strings in the array. strings[] An array of pointers (of type sec_attr_enc_print_string_p_t) to printstrings. sec_attr_value_t A discriminated union that defines attribute values. The union, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_t data type, consists of the following elements: attr_encoding A sec_attr_encoding_t data type that defines attribute encoding. The contents of tagged union (below) depend on the value of sec_attr_encoding_t. tagged_union A tagged union whose contents depend on attr_encoding as follows: If attr_encoding is... Then tagged_union is... _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_void NULL _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_printstring A pointer to printstring _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_printstring_array A pointer to an array of printstrings _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_integer signed_int, a 32-bit signed integer _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_bytes bytes, a pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_enc_bytes_t _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_confidential_bytes bytes, a pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_enc_bytes_t _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_i18n_data idata, a pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_i18n_data_t _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_end_uuid uuid, a value of type uuid_t _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_attr_set attr_set, a pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_enc_attr_set_t _______________________________________________________________________ sec_attr_enc_binding binding, a pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_binding_info_t sec_attr_t A structure that defines an attribute. The structure consists of: attr_id A value of type uuid_t, the UUID of the attribute. attr_value A value of type sec_attr_value_t. sec_attr_acl_mgr_info_t A structure that contains the access control information defined in a schema entry for an attribute. The structure, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type, consists of the following elements: acl_mgr_type The value of type uuid_t that specifies the UUID of the ACL manager type that supports the object type to which the attribute can be attached. This field provides a well-defined context for evaluating the permission bits needed to operate on the attribute. The following table lists the ACL Manager types for registry objects. Registry Object ACL Manager Type Valid Type Permissions ____________________________________________________________________ principal 06ab9320-0191-11ca-a9e8-08001e039d7d rcDnfmaug ____________________________________________________________________ group 06ab9640-0191-11ca-a9e8-08001e039d7d rctDnfmM ____________________________________________________________________ organization 06ab9960-0191-11ca-a9e8-08001e039d7d rctDnfmM ____________________________________________________________________ directory 06ab9c80-0191-11ca-a9e8-08001e039d7d rcidDn ____________________________________________________________________ policy 06ab8f10-0191-11ca-a9e8-08001e039d7d rcma ____________________________________________________________________ replist 2ac24970-60c3-11cb-b261-08001e039d7d cidmAI query_permset Data of type sec_acl_permset_t that defines the permission bits needed to access the attribute's value. update_permset Data of type sec_acl_permset_t that defines the permission bits needed to update the attribute's value. test_permset Data of type sec_acl_permset_t that defines the permission bits needed to test the attribute's value. delete_permset Data of type sec_acl_permset_t that defines the permission bits needed to delete an attribute instance. sec_attr_acl_mgr_info_p_t A pointer to a sec_attr_acl_mgr_info_t structure. sec_attr_acl_mgr_info_set_t A structure that defines an attribute's ACL manager set. The structure consists of the following elements: num_acl_mgrs An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of ACL managers in the ACL manager set. mgr_info[] An array of pointers of type sec_attr_mgr_info_p_t that define the ACL manager types in the ACL manager set and the permission sets associated with the ACL manager type. sec_attr_intercell_action_t An enumerator that specifies the action that should be taken by the Privilege Service when it reads acceptable attributes from a foreign cell. A foreign attribute is acceptable only if there is either a schema entry for the foreign cell or if sec_attr_intercell_act_accept is set to true. This enumerator, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type, is composed of the following ele- ments: sec_attr_intercell_act_accept If the unique flag in the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type is not set on, retain the attribute. If the unique flag is set on, retain the attribute only if its value is unique among all attribute instances of the same attribute type within the cell. sec_attr_intercell_act_reject Discard the input attribute. sec_attr_intercell_act_evaluate Use the binding information in the trig_binding field of this sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type to make a sec_attr_trig_query call to a trigger server. That server determines whether to retain the attribute value, discard the attribute value, or map the attribute to another value(s). sec_attr_trig_type_t Specifies the trigger type, a flag that determines whether an attribute trigger should be invoked for query operations. The data type, which is used in conjunction with the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type, uses the following constants: The attribute trigger server is invoked for query opera- tions. sec_attr_trig_type_query The attribute trigger server is invoked for update opera- tions. sec_attr_schema_entry_t A structure that defines a complete attribute entry for the schema catalog. The entry is identified by both a unique string name and a unique attribute UUID. Although either can either can be used as a retrieval key, the string name should be used for interactive access to the attribute and the UUID for programmatic access. The attribute UUID is used to identify the semantics defined for the attribute type in the schema. The sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type consists of the following ele- ments: attr_name A pointer to the attribute name. attr_id A value of type uuid_t that identifies the attribute type. attr_encoding An enumerator of type sec_attr_encoding_t that specifies the attribute's encoding. acl_mgr_set A structure of type sec_attr_acl_mgr_info_set_t that specifies the ACL manager types that support the objects on which attributes of this type can be created and the permission bits supported by that ACL manager type. schema_entry_flags An unsigned integer of type sec_attr_sch_entry_flags_t that defines bitsets for the following flags: unique When set on, this flag indicates that each instance of this attribute type must have a unique value within the cell for the object type implied by the ACL Manager type. If this flag is not set on, uniqueness checks are not performed for attribute writes. multi_valued When set on, this flag indicates that this attribute type may be multi-valued; in other words, multiple instances of the same attribute type can be attached to a single registry object. If this flag is not set on, only one instance of this attribute type can be attached to an object. reserved When set on, this flag prevents the schema entry from being deleted through any interface or by any user. If this flag is not set on, the entry can be deleted by any authorized principal. use_defaults When set on, the system-defined default attribute value will be returned on a client query if an instance of this attribute does not exist on the queried object. If this flag is not set on, system defaults are not used. intercell_action An enumerator of type sec_attr_intercell_action_t that specifies how the Privilege Service will handle attributes from a foreign cell. trig_types A flag of type sec_attr_trig_type_t that specifies whether whether a trigger can perform update or query operations. trig_binding A pointer to a structure of type sec_attr_bind_info_t that supplies the attribute trigger binding handle. scope A pointer to a string that defines the objects to which the attribute can be attached. comment A pointer to a string that contains general comments about the attribute. sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t A 32-bit bitset containing flags that specify the schema entry fields that can be modified on a schema entry update operation. This data type contains the following flags: sec_attr_schema_part_name If set, indicates that the attribute name (attr_name) can be changed. sec_attr_schema_part_reserved If set, indicates that the setting of the flag that deter- mines whether or not the schema entry can be deleted (reserved) can be changed. sec_attr_schema_part_defaults If set, indicates that the flag that determines whether or not a query for a non-existent attribute will not result in a search for a system default (apply_default) can be changed. sec_attr_schema_part_trig_bind If set, indicates that the trigger's binding information (trig_binding) can be changed. sec_attr_schema_part_comment If set, indicates whether or not comments associated with the schema entry (comment) can be changed. sec_attr_component_name_t A pointer to a character string used to further specify the object to which the attribute is attached. (Note that this data type is analogous to the sec_acl_component_name_t data type in the ACL interface.) sec_attr_cursor_t A structure that provides a pointer into a registry database and is used for multiple database operations. This cursor must minimally represent the object indicated by xattrschema in the schema interfaces, or component_name in the attribute interfaces. The cursor may additionally represent an entry within that schema or an attribute instance on that component. sec_attr_srch_cursor_t A structure that provides a pointer into a registry database and is used for multiple database operations. The cursor must minimally represent the list of all objects managed by this server that possess the search attributes specified in the sec_attr_srch_cursor_init routine. It may additionally represent a given object within this list as well as attribute instance(s) possessed by that object. sec_attr_trig_cursor_t A structure that provides an attribute trigger cursor for inter- active operations. The structure consists of the following elements: source A value of type uuid_t that provides a UUID to identify the server that initialized the cursor. object_handle A signed 32 bit integer that identifies the object (specified by xattrschema in the schema interface or component_name in the attribute interface) upon which the operation is being performed. entry_handle A signed 32 bit integer that identifies the current entry (schema_entry in the schema interface or attribute instance in the attribute interface) for the operation. valid A boolean field with the following values: + true (1) - Indicates an initialized cursor. + false (0) - Indicates an uninitialized cursor. sec_attr_trig_timeval_sec_t A 32-bit integer containing the seconds portion of a UNIX timeval_t, to be used when expressing absolute dates. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_ATTR_BASE.IDL The idl file from which sec_attr_base.h was derived. CONSTANTS The following constants are used in sec_attr calls: sec_attr_bind_auth_dce The binding uses DCE shared-secret key authentication. sec_attr_bind_auth_none The binding is not authenticated. sec_attr_bind_type_string The attribute uses an rpc string binding. sec_attr_bind_type_svrname The attribute uses a name in rpc_c_ns_syntax format that identifies a CDS entry containing the server's binding information. This constant has the following structure: name_syntax Must be rpc_c_ns_syntax_dce to specify that DCE naming rules are used to specify name. name A pointer to a name of a CDS entry in rpc_c_ns_syntax_dce syntax. sec_attr_bind_type_twr The attribute uses a DCE protocol tower binding representation. sec_attr_trig_type_t Constants The following 32-bit constants are used with the sec_attr_trig_type_t data type: sec_attr_trig_type_query The trigger server can perform only query operations. sec_attr_trig_type_update The trigger server can perform only update operations. sec_attr_intercell_action_t Constants The following constants are used with the sec_attr_intercell_action_t data type sec_attr_intercell_act_accept If the unique flag in the sec_attr_schema_entry_t data type is not set on, retain attributes from a foreign cell. If the unique flag is set on, retain the foreign attribute only if its value is unique among all attribute instances of the same attribute type within the cell. sec_attr_intercell_act_reject Discard attributes from a foreign cell. sec_attr_intercell_act_evaluate A trigger server determines whether to retain foreign attributes, discard foreign attributes, or map foreign attribute to another value(s). sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t Constants The following constants are used with the sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t data type: sec_attr_schema_part_name Indicates that the attribute name can be changed in an schema update operation. sec_attr_schema_part_reserved Indicates that the setting of the reserved flag can be changed in a schema entry update. sec_attr_schema_part_defaults Indicates that the apply_default flag can be changed in a schema entry update operation. sec_attr_schema_part_trig_bind Indicates that trigger binding information can be changed in a schema entry update operation. sec_attr_schema_part_comment Indicates that comments associated with the schema entry can be changed in a schema entry update.
3.3 – LOGIN_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> DATA TYPES The following data types are used in sec_login_ calls: sec_login_handle_t This is an opaque pointer to a data structure representing a complete login context. The context includes a principal's network credentials, as well as other account information. The network credentials are also referred to as the principal's "ticket-granting ticket." sec_login_flags_t A 32-bit set of flags describing restrictions on the use of a principal's validated network credentials. Currently, only one flag is implemented, and the set can take on the following two values: sec_login_no_flags No special flags are set. sec_login_credentials_private Restricts the validated network credentials to the current process. If this flag is not set, it is permissible to share credentials with descendents of current process. sec_login_auth_src_t An enumerated set describing how the login context was authorized. The possible values are: sec_login_auth_src_network Authentication accomplished through the normal network authority. A login context authenticated this way will have all the network credentials it ought to have. sec_login_auth_src_local Authentication accomplished via local data. Authentication occurs locally if a principal's account is tailored for the local machine, or if the network authority is unavailable. Since login contexts authenticated locally have no network credentials, they may not be used for network operations. sec_login_auth_src_overridden Authentication accomplished via the override facility. sec_login_passwd_t The sec_login_get_pwent() call will return a pointer to a "password" structure, which depends on the underlying registry structure. In most cases, the structure will look like that supported by Berkeley 4.4BSD and OSF/1, which looks like this: struct passwd { char *pw_name; * user name * char *pw_passwd; * encrypted password * int pw_uid; * user uid * int pw_gid; * user gid * time_t pw_change; * password change time * char *pw_class; * user access class * char *pw_gecos; * Honeywell login info * char *pw_dir; * home directory * char *pw_shell; * default shell * time_t pw_expire; * account expiration * }; sec_passwd_rec_t A structure containing either a plaintext password or a preencrypted buffer of password data. The sec_passwd_rec_t structure consists of three components: version_number The version number of the password. pepper A character string combined with the password before an encryption key is derived from the password. key A structure consists of the following components: key_type The key type can be the following: sec_passwd_plain Indicates that a printable string of data is stored in plain. sec_passwd_des Indicates that an array of data is stored in des_key. tagged_union A structure specifying the password. The value of the structure depends on key_type. If key_type is sec_passwd_plain, structure contains plain, a character string. If key_type is sec_passwd_des, the structure contains des_key, a DES key of type sec_passwd_des_key_t. CONSTANTS The following constants are used in sec_login_ calls: sec_login_default_handle The value of a login context handle before setup or validation. sec_login_flags_t Constants The following two constants are used with the sec_login_flags_t type. sec_login_no_flags No special flags are set. sec_login_credentials_private Restricts the validated network credentials to the current process. If this flag is not set, it is permissible to share credentials with descendents of current process. sec_login_remote_uid Used in the sec_login_passwd_t structure for users from remote cells. sec_login_remote_gid Used in the sec_login_passwd_t structure for users from remote cells. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which sec_login.h was derived.
3.4 – EXTENDED_PRIVILEGE_ATTRIBUTE_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/id_epac.h> #include <dce/nbase.h> DATA TYPES The following data types are used in Extended Privilege Attribute calls and in the sec_login_cred calls that implement extended privilege attributes. sec_cred_cursor_t A structure that provides an input/output cursor used to iterate through a set of delegates in the sec_cred_get_delegate() or sec_login_cred_get_delegate() calls. This cursor is initialized by the sec_cred_initialize_cursor() or sec_login_cred_init_cursor() call. sec_cred_attr_cursor_t A structure that provides an input/output cursor used to iterate through a set of extended attributes in the sec_cred_get_extended_attributes() call. This cursor is initialized by the sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor() call. sec_id_opt_req_t A structure that specifies application-defined optional restrictions. The sec_id_opt_req_t data type is composed of the following elements: restriction_len An unsigned 16-bit integer that defines the size of the restriction data. restrictions A pointer to a byte_t that contains the restriction data. sec_rstr_entry_type_t An enumerator that specifies the entry types for delegate and target restrictions. This data type is used in conjunction with the sec_id_restriction_t data type where the specific UUID(s), if appropriate, are supplied. It consists of the following components: sec_rstr_e_type_user The target is a local principal identified by UUID. This type conforms with the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_rstr_e_type_group The target is a local group identified by UUID. This type conforms with the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_user The target is a foreign principal identified by principal and cell UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_group The target is a foreign group identified by group and cell UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_other The target is any principal that can authenticate to the foreign cell identified by UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_any_other The target is any principal that can authenticate to any cell, but is not identified in any other type entry. sec_rstr_e_type_no_other No pincipal can act as a target or delegate. sec_id_restriction_t A discriminated union that defines delegate and target restrictions. The union, which is used in conjunction with the sec_restriction_set_t data type, consists of the following elements: entry_type A sec_rstr_entry_type_t that defines the ACL entry types for delegate and target restrictions. The value of tagged_union depends on the value of entry_type. tagged_union A tagged union whose contents depend on entry_type as fol- lows: If entry_type is... Then tagged_union is... ________________________________________________________________ sec_rstr_e_type_any_other NULL ________________________________________________________________ sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_other foreign_id that identifies the foreign cell. ________________________________________________________________ sec_rstr_e_type_user id, a sec_id_t that sec_rstr_e_type_group identifies the user or group. ________________________________________________________________ sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_user foreign_id, a sec_id_foreign_t sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_group that identifies the foreign user or group. sec_id_restriction_set_t A structure that that supplies delegate and target restrictions. The structure consists of: num_restrictions A 16-bit unsigned integer that defines the number of restrictions in restrictions. restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_t that contains the res- trictions. sec_id_compatibility_mode_t A unsigned 16 bit integer that defines the compatibility between current and pre-1.1 servers. The data type uses the following con- stants: sec_id_compat_mode_none Compatibility mode is off. sec_id_compat_mode_initiator Compatibility mode is on. The 1.0 PAC data extracted from the EPAC of the chain initiator. sec_id_compat_mode_caller Compatibility mode is on. The 1.0 PAC data extracted from the last delegate in the delegation chain. sec_id_delegation_type_t An unsigned 16 bit integer that defines the delegation type. The data type uses the following constants: sec_id_deleg_type_none Delegation is not allowed. sec_id_deleg_type_traced Traced delegation is allowed. sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation Simple (impersonation) delegation is allowed. sec_id_pa_t An structure that contains pre-1.1 PAC data extracted from an EPAC of a current version server. This data type, which is used for compatibility with pre-1.1 servers, consists of the following elements: realm A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID that identifies the cell in which the principal associated with the PAC exists. principal A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID of the principal. group A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID of the principal's primary group. num_groups An unsigned 16-bit integer that specifies the number of groups in the principal's groupset. groups An array of pointers to sec_id_ts that contain the UUIDs of the each group in the principal's groupset. num_foreign_groupsets An unsigned 16-bit integer that specifies the number of foreign groups for the principal's groupset. foreign_groupsets An array of pointers to sec_id_ts that contain the UUIDs of the each group in the principal's groupset. sec_id_pac_t An structure that contains a pre-1.1 PAC. This data type, which is used as output of the sec_cred_get_v1_pac call, consists of the following elements: pac_type A value of type sec_id_pac_format_t that can be used to describe the PAC format. authenticated A boolean field that indicates whether or not the PAC is authenticated (obtained from an authenticated source). FALSE indicates that the PAC is not authenticated. No authentication protocol was used in the rpc that trans- mitted the identity of the caller. TRUE indicates that the PAC is authenticated. realm A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID that identifies the cell in which the principal associated with the PAC exists. principal A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID of the principal. group For local principals, a value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID of the principal's primary group. num_groups An unsigned 16-bit integer that specifies the number of groups in the principal's groupset. groups An array of pointers to sec_id_ts that contain the UUIDs of the each group in the principal's groupset. num_foreign_groups An unsigned 16-bit integer that specifies the number of foreign groups in the principal's groupset. foreign_groups An array of pointers to sec_id_ts that contain the UUIDs of the each foreign group in the principal's groupset. sec_id_pac_format_t An enumerator that can be used to describe the PAC format. sec_id_t A structure that contains UUIDs for principals, groups, or organiza- tions and an optional printstring name. Since a UUID is an handle for the object's identity, the sec_id_t data type is the basic unit for identifying principals, groups, and organizations. Because the printstring name is dynamically allocated, this datatype requires a destructor function. Generally, however, the sec_id_t is embedded in other data types (ACLs, for example), and these data- types have a destructor function to release the printstring storage. The sec_id_t data type is composed of the following elements: uuid A value of type uuid_t, the UUID of the principal, group, or organization. name A pointer to a character string containing the name of the principal, group, or organization. sec_id_foreign_t A structure that contains UUIDs for principals, groups, or organiza- tions for objects in a foreign cell and the UUID that identifies the foreign cell. The sec_id_foreign_t data type is composed of the following elements: id A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUIDs of the objects from the foreign cell. realm A value of type sec_id_t that contains the UUID of the foreign cell. sec_id_foreign_groupset_t A structure that contains UUIDs for set of groups in a foreign cell and the UUID that identifies the foreign cell. The sec_id_foreign_groupset_t data type is composed of the following elements: realm A value of type sec_id_t that contain the UUID of the foreign cell. num_groups An unsigned 16-bit integer specifying the number of group UUIDs in groups. groups A printer to a sec_id_t that contains the UUIDs of the groupset from the foreign cell. CONSTANTS The following constants are used in the Extended Privilege Attribute calls and in the the sec_login calls that implement extended privilege attributes: sec_id_compat_mode_none Compatibility mode is off. sec_id_compat_mode_initiator Compatibility mode is on. The 1.0 PAC data extracted from the EPAC of the chain initiator. sec_id_compat_mode_caller Compatibility mode is on. The 1.0 PAC data extracted from the last delegate in the delegation chain. sec_id_deleg_type_none Delegation is not allowed. sec_id_deleg_type_traced Traced delegation is allowed. sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation Simple (impersonation) delegation is allowed. sec_rstr_e_type_user The delegation target is a local principal identified by UUID. This type conforms with the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_rstr_e_type_group The delegation target is a local group identified by UUID. This type conforms with the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_user The delegation target is a foreign principal identified by principal and cell UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_group The delegation target is a foreign group identified by group and cell UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_foreign_other The delegation target is any principal that can authenticate to the foreign cell identified by UUID. sec_rstr_e_type_any_other The delegation target is any principal that can authenticate to any cell, but is not identified in any other type entry. sec_rstr_e_type_no_other No principal can act as a target or delegate. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_CRED.IDL The idl file from which sec_cred.h was derived. SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ID_EPAC.IDL The idl file from which id_epac.h was derived. SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]NBASE.IDL The idl file from which nbase.h was derived.
3.5 – ACL_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/aclbase.h> Data Types The following data types are used in sec_acl_ calls: sec_acl_handle_t A pointer to an opaque handle bound to an ACL that is the subject of a test or examination. The handle is bound to the ACL with sec_acl_bind(). An unbound handle has the value sec_acl_default_handle. sec_acl_posix_semantics_t A flag that indicates which, if any, POSIX ACL semantics an ACL manager supports. The following constants are defined for use with the sec_acl_posix_semantics_t data type: sec_acl_posix_no_semantics The manager type does not support POSIX semantics. sec_acl_posix_mask_obj The manager type supports the mask_obj entry type and POSIX 1003.6 Draft 12 ACL mask entry semantics. sec_acl_t This data type is the fundamental type for the ACL manager interfaces. The sec_acl_t type contains a complete access control list, made up of a list of entry fields (type sec_acl_entry_t). The default cell identifies the authentication authority for simple ACL entries (foreign entries identify their own foreign cells). The sec_acl_manager_type identifies the manager to interpret this ACL. The sec_acl_t type is a structure containing the following fields: default_realm A structure of type sec_acl_id_t, this identifies the UUID and (optionally) the name of the default cell. sec_acl_manager_type Contains the UUID of the ACL manager type. num_entries An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of ACL entries in this ACL. sec_acl_entries An array containing num_entries pointers to different ACL entries, each of type sec_acl_entry_t. sec_acl_p_t This data type, simply a pointer to a sec_acl_t, is for use with the sec_acl_list_t data type. sec_acl_list_t This data type is a structure containing an unsigned 32-bit integer num_acls that describes the number of ACLs indicated by its companion array of pointers, sec_acls, of type sec_acl_p_t. sec_acl_entry_t The sec_acl_entry_t type is a structure made up of the following components: perms A set of flags of type sec_acl_permset_t that describe the permissions granted for the principals identified by this ACL entry. Note that if a principal matches more than one ACL entry, the effective permissions will be the most restrictive combination of all the entries. entry_info A structure containing two members: entry_type A flag of type sec_acl_entry_type_t, indicating the type of ACL entry. tagged_union A tagged union whose contents depend on the type of the entry. The types of entries indicated by entry_type can be the following: sec_acl_e_type_user_obj The entry contains permissions for the implied user object. This type is described in the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_acl_e_type_group_obj The entry contains permissions for the implied group object. This type is described in the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_acl_e_type_other_obj The entry contains permissions for principals not otherwise named through user or group entries. This type is described in the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_acl_e_type_user The entry contains a key that identifies a user. This type is described in the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_acl_e_type_group The entry contains a key that identifies a group. This type is described in the POSIX 1003.6 standard. sec_acl_e_type_mask_obj The entry contains the maximum permissions for all entries other than mask_obj, unauthenticated, user_obj, other_obj. sec_acl_e_type_foreign_user The entry contains a key that identifies a user and the foreign realm. sec_acl_e_type_foreign_group The entry contains a key that identifies a group and the foreign realm. sec_acl_e_type_foreign_other The entry contains a key that identifies a foreign realm. Any user that can authenticate to the foreign realm will be allowed access. sec_acl_e_type_any_other The entry contains permissions to be applied to any accessor who can authenticate to any realm, but is not identified in any other entry (except sec_acl_e_type_unauthenticated). sec_acl_e_type_unauthenticated The entry contains permissions to be applied when the accessor does not pass authentication procedures. A privilege attribute certificate will indicate that the caller's identity is not authenticated. The identity is used to match against the standard entries, but the access rights are masked by this mask. If this mask does not exist in an ACL, the ACL is assumed to grant no access and all unauthenticated access attempts will be denied. Great care should be exercised when allowing unauthenticated access to an object. Almost by definition, unauthenticated access is very easy to spoof. The presence of this mask on an ACL essentially means that anyone can get at least as much access as allowed by the mask. sec_acl_e_type_extended The entry contains additional "pickled" data. This kind of entry cannot be interpreted, but can be used by an out-of-date client when copying an ACL from one manager to another (assuming that the two managers each understand the data). The contents of the tagged union depend on the entry type. For the following entry types, the union contains a UUID and an optional print string (called entry_info.tagged_union.id with type sec_id_t) for an identified local principal, or for an identified foreign realm. + sec_acl_e_type_user + sec_acl_e_type_group + sec_acl_type_foreign_other For the following entry types, the union contains two UUIDs and optional print strings (called entry_info.tagged_union.foreign_id with type sec_id_foreign_t) for an identified foreign principal and its realm. + sec_acl_e_type_foreign_user + sec_acl_e_type_foreign_group For an extended entry (sec_acl_e_type_extended), the union contains entry_info.tagged_union.extended_info, a pointer to an information block of type sec_acl_extend_info_t. sec_acl_permset_t A 32-bit set of permission flags. The flags currently represent the conventional file system permissions (read, write, execute) and the extended DFS permissions (owner, insert, delete). The "unused" flags represent permissions that can only be interpreted by the manager for the object. For example, sec_acl_perm_unused_00000080 may mean to one ACL manager that withdrawals are allowed, and to another ACL manager that rebooting is allowed. The following constants are defined for use with the sec_acl_permset_t data type: sec_acl_perm_read The ACL allows read access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_write The ACL allows write access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_execute The ACL allows execute access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_control The ACL allows the ACL itself to be modified. sec_acl_perm_insert The ACL allows insert access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_delete The ACL allows delete access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_test The ACL allows access to the protected object only to the extent of being able to test for existence. The bits from 0x00000080 to 0x80000000 are not used by the conventional ACL permission set. Constants of the form sec_acl_perm_unused_00000080 have been defined so application programs can easily use these bits for extended ACLs. sec_acl_extend_info_t This is an extended information block, provided for future extensibility. Primarily, this allows an out-of-date client to read an ACL from a newer manager and apply it to another (up-to- date) manager. The data cannot be interpreted by the out-of-date client without access to the appropriate "pickling" routines (that presumably are unavailable to such a client). In general, ACL managers should not accept ACLs that contain entries the manager does not understand. The manager clearly cannot perform the security service requested by an uninterpretable entry, and it is considered a security breach to lead a client to believe that the manager is performing a particular class of service if the manager cannot do so. The data structure is made up of the following components: extension_type The UUID of the extension type. format_label The format of the label, in ndr_format_t form. num_bytes An unsigned 32-bit integer indicating the number of bytes containing the "pickled" data. pickled_data The byte array containing the "pickled" data. sec_acl_type_t The sec_acl_type_t type differentiates among the various types of ACLs an object can possess. Most file system objects will only have one ACL controlling the access to that object, but objects that control the creation of other objects (sometimes referred to as "containers") may have more. For example, a directory can have three different ACLs: the directory ACL, controlling access to the directory; the initial object (or default object) ACL, which serves as a mask when creating new objects in the directory; and the initial directory (or default directory) ACL, which serves as a mask when creating new directories (containers). The sec_acl_type_t is an enumerated set containing one of the following values: sec_acl_type_object The ACL refers to the specified object. sec_acl_type_default_object The ACL is to be used when creating objects in the container. sec_acl_type_default_container The ACL is to be used when creating nested containers. The following values are defined but not currently used. They are available for application programs that may create an application- specific ACL definition. sec_acl_type_unspecified_3 sec_acl_type_unspecified_4 sec_acl_type_unspecified_5 sec_acl_type_unspecified_6 sec_acl_type_unspecified_7 sec_acl_printstring_t A sec_acl_printstring_t structure contains a printable representa- tion for a permission in a sec_acl_permset_t permission set. This allows a generic ACL editing tool to be used for application- specific ACLs. The tool need not know the printable representation for each permission bit in a given permission set. The sec_acl_get_printstring() function will query an ACL manager for the print strings of the permissions it supports. The structure consists of three components: printstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_len describing the printable representation of a specified permission. helpstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_help_len containing some text that may be used to describe the specified permission. permissions A sec_acl_permset_t permission set describing the permissions that will be represented with the specified print string. sec_acl_component_name_t This type is a pointer to a character string, to be used to specify the entity a given ACL is protecting. CONSTANTS The following constants are used in sec_acl_ calls: sec_acl_default_handle The value of an unbound ACL manager handle. sec_rgy_acct_key_t Constants The following 32-bit integer constants are used with the sec_rgy_acct_key_t data type: sec_rgy_acct_key_none Invalid key. sec_rgy_acct_key_person The person name alone is enough. sec_rgy_acct_key_group The person and group names are both necessary for the account abbreviation. sec_rgy_acct_key_org The person, group, and organization names are all necessary. sec_rgy_acct_key_last Key values must be less than this constant. sec_rgy_pname_t_size The maximum number of characters in a sec_rgy_pname_t. sec_acl_permset_t Constants The following constants are defined for use with the sec_acl_permset_t data type: sec_acl_perm_read The ACL allows read access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_write The ACL allows write access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_execute The ACL allows execute access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_owner The ACL allows owner-level access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_insert The ACL allows insert access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_delete The ACL allows delete access to the protected object. sec_acl_perm_test The ACL allows access to the protected object only to the extent of being able to test for existence. sec_acl_perm_unused_00000080 - sec_acl_perm_unused_0x80000000 The bits from 0x00000080 to 0x80000000 are not used by the conventional ACL permission set. Constants have been defined so application programs can easily use these bits for extended ACLs. sec_acl_printstring_len The maximum length of the printable representation of an ACL permis- sion. (See sec_acl_printstring_t.) sec_acl_printstring_help_len The maximum length of a help message to be associated with a supported ACL permission. (See sec_acl_printstring_t.) FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACLBASE.IDL The idl file from which aclbase.h was derived.
3.6 – KEY_MANAGEMENT_API_DATA_TYPES
NOTES Key management operations that take a keydata argument expect a pointer to a sec_passwd_rec_t structure, and those that take a keytype argument (void *) expect a pointer to a sec_passwd_type_t. Key management operations that yield a keydata argument as output set the pointer to an array of sec_passwd_rec_t. (The array is terminated by an element with a key type of sec_passwd_none.) Operations that take a keydata argument expect a pointer to a sec_passwd_rec_t structure. Operations that yield a keydata argument as output set the pointer to an array of sec_passwd_rec_t. (The array is terminated by an element with key type sec_passwd_none.) Operations that take a keytype argument (void *) expect a pointer to a sec_passwd_type_t. SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> DATA TYPES An enumerated set describing the currently supported key types. The possible values are: Indicates no key types are supported. Indicates that the key is a printable string of data. Indicates that the key is DES encrypted data. sec_passwd_rec_t A structure containing either a plaintext password or a preencrypted buffer of password data. The sec_passwd_rec_t structure consists of three components: version_number The version number of the password. pepper A character string combined with the password before an encryption key is derived from the password. key A structure consists of the following components: key_type The key type can be the following: sec_passwd_plain Indicates that a printable string of data is stored in plain. sec_passwd_des Indicates that an array of data is stored in des_key. tagged_union A structure specifying the password. The value of the structure depends on key_type. If key_type is sec_passwd_plain, structure contains plain, a character string. If key_type is sec_passwd_des, the structure contains des_key, a DES key of type sec_passwd_des_key_t. sec_passwd_version_t An unsigned 32-bit integer that defines the password version number. You can supply a version number or a 0 for no version number. If you supply the constant sec_passwd_c_version_none, the Security service supplies a system-generated version number. A 32-bit unsigned integer whose purpose is to indicate the authenti- cation service in use, since a server may have different keys for different levels of security. The possible values of this data type and their meanings are as follows: rpc_c_authn_none No authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_private DCE private key authentication (an implementation of the Kerberos system). rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). Constants There are no constants specially defined for use with the key management API. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which keymgmt.h was derived.
3.7 – ID_MAPPING_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/secidmap.h> DATA TYPES No special data types are defined for the ID Mapping API. CONSTANTS No special constants are defined for the ID Mapping API. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SECIDMAP.IDL The idl file from which secidmap.h was derived.
3.8 – PASSWORD_MANAGEMENT_API_DATA_TYPES
SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h> DATA TYPES The following data types are used in sec_pwd_mgmt_ calls: A pointer to an opaque handle consisting of password management information about a principal. It is returned by sec_pwd_mgmt_setup(). CONSTANTS There are no constants specially defined for use with the Password Management API. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_PWD_MGMT.IDL The idl file from which sec_pwd_mgmt.h was derived.
4 – API Routines
4.1 – rdacl_get_access
NAME rdacl_get_access - Reads a privilege attribute certificate SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_get_access( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_permset_t *net_rights, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the object whose ACL is to be accessed. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. Output net_rights The output list of access rights, in sec_acl_permset_t form. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_get_access() routine determines the complete extent of access to the specified object by the calling process. Although the rdacl_test_access() routines are the preferred method of testing access, this routine is useful for implementing operations like the conventional UNIX access function. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_invalid_manager_type The manager type is not valid. sec_acl_invalid_acl_type The ACL type is not valid. sec_acl_not_authorized The requested operation is not allowed. sec_acl_object_not_found The requested object could not be found. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rdacl_test_access
4.2 – rdacl_get_manager_types
NAME rdacl_get_manager_types - Lists the types of ACLs protecting an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_get_manager_types( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, unsigned32 size_avail, unsigned32 *size_used, unsigned32 *num_types, uuid_t manager_types[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the manager_types[] array. Output size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of output entries returned in the manager_types[] array. num_types An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of types returned in the manager_types[] array. This is always equal to size_used. manager_types[] An array of length size_avail to contain UUIDs (of type uuid_t) identifying the different types of ACL managers protecting the target object. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_get_manager_types() routine returns a list of the types of ACLs protecting an object. For example, in addition to the regular file system ACL, a file representing the stable storage of some database could have an ACL manager that supported permissions allowing database updates only on certain days of the week. ACL editors and browsers can use this operation to determine the ACL manager types that a particular reference monitor is using to protect a selected entity. Then, using the rdacl_get_printstring() routine, they can determine how to format for display the permissions supported by a specific manager. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rdacl_get_printstring
4.3 – rdacl_get_mgr_types_semantics
NAME rdacl_get_manager_types_semantics - Lists the ACL manager types protecting an object and the POSIX semantics supported by each manager type SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_get_mgr_types_semantics( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, unsigned32 size_avail, unsigned32 *size_used, unsigned32 *num_types, uuid_t manager_types[], sec_acl_posix_semantics_t posix_semantics[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. sec_acl_type The ACL type used to limit the function's output to ACL managers that control the specified types of ACLs. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object - Object ACL, the ACL controlling access to an object. + sec_acl_type_default_object - Initial Object ACL, the default ACL for objects created in a container object. + sec_acl_type_default_container - Initial Container ACL, the default ACL for containers created in a container object. size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the manager_types[] and the posix_semantics[] arrays. Output size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of output entries returned in the manager_types[] array. num_types An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of types returned in the manager_types[] array. This is always equal to size_used. manager_types[] An array of length size_avail containing the returned UUIDs (of type uuid_t) identifying the different ACL manager types protecting the target object. posix_semantics[] An array of length size_avail containing the POSIX semantics (of type sec_acl_posix_semantics_t) that are supported by each returned ACL manager type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_get_manager_types_semantics() routine returns a list of the ACL manager types protecting an object and a list of the POSIX semantics supported by those ACL manager types. Access to an object can be controlled by multiple ACL manager types. For example, access to a file representing the stable storage of a database could be controlled by two ACL manager types each with completely different sets of permissions: one to provide standard file system access (read, write, execute, etc.) and one to provide access that allows database updates only on certain days of the week. ACL editors and browsers can use this operation to determine the ACL manager types that a particular reference monitor is using to protect a selected entity. Then, using the rdacl_get_printstring() routine, they can determine how to format for display the permissions supported by a specific manager. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rdacl_get_printstring
4.4 – rdacl_get_printstring
NAME rdacl_get_printstring - Returns printable ACL strings SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_get_printstring( handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, unsigned32 size_avail, uuid_t *manager_type_chain, sec_acl_printstring_t *manager_info, boolean32 *tokenize, unsigned32 *total_num_printstrings, unsigned32 *size_used, sec_acl_printstring_t printstrings[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use rdacl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the printstrings[] array. Output manager_type_chain If the target object ACL contains more than 32 permission bits, multiple manager types are used, one for each 32-bit wide "slice" of permissions. The UUID returned in manager_type_chain refers to the next ACL manager in the chain. If there are no more ACL managers for this ACL, uuid_nil is returned. manager_info Provides a name and helpstring for the given ACL manager. tokenize When FALSE this variable indicates that the returned permission printstrings are unambiguous and therefore may be concatenated when printed without confusion. When TRUE, however, this property does not hold, and the strings need to be separated when printed or passed. total_num_printstrings An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the total number of permission printstrings supported by this ACL manager type. size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of permission entries returned in the printstrings[] array. printstrings[] An array of permission printstrings of type sec_acl_printstring_t. Each entry of the array is a structure containing three components: printstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_len containing the printable representation of a specified permission. helpstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_help_len containing some text that can be used to describe the specified permission. permissions A sec_acl_permset_t permission set describing the permissions that are to be represented with the companion printstring. The array consists of one such entry for each permission supported by the ACL manager identified by manager_type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_get_printstring() routine returns an array of printable representations (called printstrings) for each permission bit or combination of permission bits the specified ACL manager will support. The ACL manager type specified must be one of the types indicated by the ACL handle. In addition to returning the printstrings, this routine also returns instructions about how to print the strings. When the tokenize variable is set to FALSE, a print string might be r or w, which could be concatenated in the display as rw without any confusion. However, when the tokenize variable is TRUE, it implies the printstrings might be of a form like read or write, which must be displayed separated by spaces or colons or something. In any list of permission printstrings, there may appear to be some redundancy. ACL managers often define aliases for common permission combinations. By convention, however, simple entries need to appear at the beginning of the printstrings[] array, and combinations need to appear at the end. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not among those referenced by the input handle. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind rdacl_get_manager_types
4.5 – rdacl_get_referral
NAME rdacl_get_referral - Gets a referral to an ACL update site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_get_referral( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, sec_acl_tower_set_t *towers[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container Output towers[] A pointer to address information indicating an ACL update site. This information, obtained from the RPC runtime, is used by the client-side code to construct a new ACL binding handle indicating a site that will not return the sec_acl_site_readonly error. The sec_acl_tower_set_t structure contains an array of towers (called towers[]) and an unsigned 32-bit integer indicating the number of array elements (called count). This type enables the client to pass in an unallocated array of towers and have the server allocate the correct amount. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_get_referral() routine obtains a referral to an ACL update site. This function is used when the current ACL site yields a sec_acl_site_readonly error. Some replication managers will require all updates for a given object to be directed to a given replica. If clients of the generic ACL interface know they are dealing with an object that is replicated in this way, this function allows them to recover from the problem and rebind to the proper update site. The DCE network registry, for example, is replicated this way. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.6 – rdacl_lookup
NAME rdacl_lookup - Returns the ACL for an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_lookup( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, sec_acl_result_t *result); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container Output result A pointer to a tagged union of type sec_acl_result_t. The tag is the completion status, result.st. If result.st is equal to error_status_ok, the union contains an ACL. Otherwise, the completion status indicates an error, and the union is empty. If the call returned successfully, the result.tagged_union.sec_acl_list_t structure contains a sec_acl_list_t. This data type is an array of pointers to sec_acl_ts that define ACLs. If the permission set of the returned ACL is 32 bits or smaller, sec_acl_list_t points to only one sec_acl_t. If the permission set of the returned ACL is larger than 32 bits, multiple sec_acl_ts are used to hold them, and the sec_acl_list_t points to multiple sec_acl_ts. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_lookup() routine loads into memory a copy of an object's ACL corresponding to the specified manager type. The routine returns a pointer to the ACL. This routine is only used by ACL editors and browsers; an application would use sec_acl_test_access() or sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf() to process the contents of an ACL. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. sec_acl_cant_allocate_memory The requested operation requires more memory than is avail- able. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_test_access sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf
4.7 – rdacl_replace
NAME rdacl_replace - Replaces an ACL SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> void rdacl_replace( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, sec_acl_list_t *sec_acl_list, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container sec_acl_list The new ACL to use for the target object. This is represented by a pointer to the sec_acl_list_t structure containing the complete Access Control List. An ACL contains a list of ACL entries, the UUID of the default cell where authentication takes place (foreign entries in the ACL contain the name of their parent cell), and the UUID of the ACL manager to interpret the list. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_replace() routine replaces the ACL indicated by the input handle with the information in the sec_acl_list parameter. ACLs are thought of as immutable, and in order to modify them, an editing application must read an entire ACL (using the sec_acl_lookup() routine), modify it as needed, and replace it using this routine. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_lookup
4.8 – rdacl_test_access
NAME rdacl_test_access - Tests access to an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> boolean32 rdacl_test_access( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_permset_t desired_permset, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. desired_permset A permission set in sec_acl_permset_t form containing the desired privileges. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_test_access() routine determines if the specified ACL contains entries granting privileges to the calling process matching those in desired_permset. An application generally only inquires after the minimum set of privileges needed to accomplish a specific task. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rdacl_test_access_on_behalf
4.9 – rdacl_test_access_on_behalf
NAME rdacl_test_access_on_behalf - Tests access to an object on behalf of another process SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rdaclif.h> boolean rdacl_test_access_on_behalf( handle_t h, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_id_pac_t *subject, sec_acl_permset_t desired_permset, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. component_name A character string containing the name of the target object. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. subject A Privilege Attribute Certificate (PAC) for the subject process. The PAC contains the name and UUID of the principal and parent cell of the subject process, as well as a list of any groups to which it belongs. The PAC also contains a flag (named authenticated). When set, it indicates that the certificate was obtained from an authenticated source. When not set, the certificate must not be trusted. (The field is FALSE when it was obtained from the rpc_auth layer and the protect level was set to rpc_c_protect_level_none. This indicates that no authentication protocol was actually used in the remote procedure call; the identity was simply transmitted from the caller to the callee. If an authentication protocol was used, then the flag is set to TRUE.) A server uses rpc_binding_inq_auth_client() to acquire a certificate for the client process. desired_permset A permission set in sec_acl_permset_t form containing the desired privileges. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The rdacl_test_access_on_behalf() routine determines if the specified ACL contains entries granting privileges to the subject, a process besides the calling process, matching those in desired_permset. This routine succeeds only if the access is available to both the caller process as well as the subject identified in the call. An application will generally only inquire after the minimum set of privileges needed to accomplish a specific task. NOTES This call is not intended to be used by application programs. The sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API) provides all the functionality necessary to use the ACL facility. This reference page is provided for programmers who wish to write an ACL manager. In order to write an ACL manager, a programmer must implement the entire rdacl interface. This network interface is called on the client side via the sec_acl local interface. Developers are responsible for implementing the server side of this interface. Test server code is included as a sample implementation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RDACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/rdaclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rdacl_test_access rpc_binding_inq_auth_client
4.10 – sec_acl_bind
NAME sec_acl_bind - Returns a handle for an object's ACL SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_bind( unsigned char *entry_name, boolean32 bind_to_entry, sec_acl_handle_t *h, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input entry_name The name of the target object. Subsequent ACL operations using the returned handle will affect the ACL of this object. bind_to_entry Bind indicator, for use when entry_name identifies both an entry in the global namespace and an actual object. A TRUE value binds the handle to the entry in the namespace, while FALSE binds the handle to the actual object. Output h A pointer to the sec_acl_handle_t variable to receive the returned ACL handle. The other sec_acl routines use this handle to refer to the ACL for the object specified with entry_name. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_bind() routine returns a handle bound to the indicated object's ACL. This routine is central to all the other sec_acl routines, each of which requires this handle to identify the ACL on which to operate. NOTES If the specified name is both an actual object, and an entry in the global namespace, there are two ACLs associated with it. For example, in addition to the ACL normally attached to file system objects, the root directory of a file system has an ACL corresponding to its entry in the global namespace. This controls access by outsiders to the entire file system, whereas the resident ACL for the root directory only controls access to the directory and, by inheritance, its sub- directories. The ambiguity must be resolved with the bind_to_entry parameter. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_object_not_found The requested object could not be found. sec_acl_no_acl_found There is no ACL associated with the specified object. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.11 – sec_acl_bind_to_addr
NAME sec_acl_bind_to_addr - Returns a handle to an object identified by its network address SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_bind_to_addr( unsigned char *site_addr, sec_acl_component_name_t component_name, sec_acl_handle_t *h, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_addr An RPC string binding to the fully qualified network address of the target object. component_name The name of the target object. Subsequent ACL operations using the returned handle will affect the ACL of this object. Output h A pointer to the sec_acl_handle_t variable to receive the returned ACL handle. The other sec_acl routines use this handle to refer to the ACL for the object specified with entry_name. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_bind_to_addr() routine returns a handle bound to the indicated object's ACL manager. This routine and the sec_acl_bind() routine are central to all the other sec_acl routines, each of which requires a handle to identify the ACL on which to operate. This routine differs from sec_acl_bind() in that it binds to the network address of the target object, rather than to a cell namespace entry. Therefore, unlike sec_acl_bind(), it is possible to pass sec_acl_bind_to_addr() a null string as a component name and to bind with a nonexistent name. The purpose of this call is to eliminate the necessity of looking up an object's name. To validate the name, use sec_acl_bind(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_object_not_found The requested object could not be found. sec_acl_no_acl_found There is no ACL associated with the specified object. sec_acl_unable_to_authenticate The call could not authenticate to the server that manages the target object's ACL. sec_acl_bind_error The call could not bind to the requested site. sec_acl_invalid_site_name The site_addr parameter is invalid. sec_acl_cant_allocate_memory Memory allocation failure. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.12 – sec_acl_calc_mask
NAME sec_acl_calc_mask - Returns the sec_acl_type_mask_obj entry for the specified ACL list SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_calc_mask( sec_acl_list_t *sec_acl_list, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output *sec_acl_list A pointer to a sec_acl_type_t the specifies the number of ACLs of each ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes between the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager. In the file system, for example, most objects have only one ACL, controlling the access to that object, but objects that control the creation of other objects (sometimes referred to as "containers") may have more. A directory, for example, can have ACLs to be used as initial values when member objects are created. Do not confuse ACL types with the permissions corresponding to different ACL manager types or with the ACL manager types them- selves. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_calc_mask() routine calculates and sets the sec_acl_e_type_mask_obj entry of the specified ACL list. The value of the sec_acl_e_type_mask_obj entry is the union of the permissions of all ACL entries that refer to members of the File Group Class. This operation is performed locally, within the client. The function does not check to determine if the manager to which the specified ACL list will be submitted supports the sec_acl_e_type_mask_obj entry type. The calling application must determine whether to call this routine, after obtaining the required, if any, POSIX semantics, via the sec_acl_get_mgr_types_semantics() routine. NOTES This call is provided in source code form. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_cant_allocate_memory Requested operation requires more memory than is available. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.13 – sec_acl_get_access
NAME sec_acl_get_access - Lists the access (permission set) that the caller has for an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_get_access( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_permset_t *net_rights, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the object whose ACL is to be accessed. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the manager type of the ACL in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. Output net_rights The output list of access rights in sec_acl_permset_t form. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_get_access() routine determines the complete extent of access to the specified object by the calling process. Although the sec_acl_test_access() and sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf() routines are the preferred method of testing access, this routine is useful for implementing operations like the conventional UNIX access function. Permissions Required The sec_acl_get_access() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the access is to be returned. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_acl_test_access sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf
4.14 – sec_acl_get_error_info
NAME sec_acl_get_error_info - Returns error information from an ACL handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> error_status_t sec_acl_get_error_info( sec_acl_handle_t h); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target ACL. The handle is bound to the ACL with the sec_acl_bind() routine, which also specifies the name of the object to which the target ACL belongs. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_get_error_info() routine returns error information from the specified ACL handle. During a call to a routine in the sec_acl Application Programming Interface (API), error codes received from the RPC runtime or other APIs are saved in the ACL handle and a corresponding error code from the sec_acl set is passed back by the ACL API. The sec_acl_get_error_info() routine returns the last error code stored in the ACL handle for those clients who need to know exactly what went wrong. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. RETURN VALUES This routine returns a value of type error_status_t, indicating the cause of the last error issued by the RPC runtime. ERRORS sec_acl_invalid_handle The ACL handle specified by sec_acl_handle_t is invalid. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_lookup
4.15 – sec_acl_get_manager_types
NAME sec_acl_get_manager_types - Lists the manager types of the ACLs protecting an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_get_manager_types( sec_acl_handle_t h, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, unsigned32 size_avail, unsigned32 *size_used, unsigned32 *num_types, uuid_t manager_types[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the manager_types[] array. Output size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of output entries returned in the manager_types[] array. num_types An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of types returned in the manager_types[] array. This may be greater than size_used if there was not enough space allocated in the manager_types[] array for all the manager types. manager_types[] An array of length size_avail to contain UUIDs (of type uuid_t) identifying the different types of ACL managers protecting the target object. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_get_manager_types() routine returns a list of the manager types of ACLs of type sec_acl_type that are protecting the object identified by h. For example, in addition to the regular file system ACL, a file representing the stable storage of some database could have an ACL manager that supported permissions allowing database updates only on certain days of the week. ACL editors and browsers can use this operation to determine the ACL manager types that a particular reference monitor is using to protect a selected entity. Then, using the sec_acl_get_printstring() routine, they can determine how to format for display the permissions supported by a specific manager. Permissions Required The sec_acl_get_manager_types() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the ACL manager types are to be returned. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_get_printstring
4.16 – sec_acl_get_manager_types_semantics
NAME sec_acl_get_mgr_types_semantics - Lists the manager types of the ACLs protecting an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_get_mgr_types_semantics( sec_acl_handle_t h, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, unsigned32 size_avail, unsigned32 *size_used, unsigned32 *num_types, uuid_t manager_types[], sec_acl_posix_semantics_t posix_semantics[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the manager_types[] array. Output size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of output entries returned in the manager_types[] array. num_types An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of types returned in the manager_types[] array. This may be greater than size_used if there was not enough space allocated in the manager_types[] array for all the manager types. manager_types[] An array of length size_avail to contain UUIDs (of type uuid_t) identifying the different types of ACL managers protecting the target object. posix_semantics[] An array of POSIX semantics supported by each manager type with entries of type sec_acl_posix_semantics_t. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_get_mgr_types_semantics() routine returns a list of the manager types of ACLs of type sec_acl_type that are protecting the object identified by h. For example, in addition to the regular file system ACL, a file representing the stable storage of some database could have an ACL manager that supported permissions allowing database updates only on certain days of the week. ACL editors and browsers can use this operation to determine the ACL manager types that a particular reference monitor is using to protect a selected entity. Then, using the sec_acl_get_printstring() routine, they can determine how to format for display the permissions supported by a specific manager. Permissions Required The sec_acl_get_mgr_types_semantics() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the ACL manager types are to be returned. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_get_printstring
4.17 – sec_acl_get_printstring
NAME sec_acl_get_printstring - Returns printable ACL strings SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_get_printstring( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, unsigned32 size_avail, uuid_t *manager_type_chain, sec_acl_printstring_t *manager_info, boolean32 *tokenize, unsigned32 *total_num_printstrings, unsigned32 *size_used, sec_acl_printstring_t printstrings[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the printstrings[] array. Output manager_type_chain If the target object ACL contains more than 32 permission bits, multiple manager types are used, one for each 32-bit wide "slice" of permissions. The UUID returned in manager_type_chain refers to the next ACL manager in the chain. If there are no more ACL managers for this ACL, uuid_nil is returned. manager_info Provides a name and helpstring for the given ACL manager. tokenize When FALSE, this variable indicates that the returned permission printstrings are unambiguous and therefore may be concatenated when printed without confusion. When TRUE, however, this property does not hold, and the strings need to be separated when printed or passed. total_num_printstrings An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the total number of permission printstrings supported by this ACL manager type. size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of permission entries returned in the printstrings[] array. printstrings[] An array of permission printstrings of type sec_acl_printstring_t. Each entry of the array is a structure containing the following three components: printstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_len describing the printable representation of a specified permission. helpstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_help_len containing some text that can be used to describe the specified permission. permissions A sec_acl_permset_t permission set describing the permissions that are represented with the companion printstring. The array consists of one such entry for each permission supported by the ACL manager identified by manager_type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_get_printstring() routine returns an array of printable representations (called "printstrings") for each permission bit or combination of permission bits the specified ACL manager supports. The ACL manager type specified must be one of the types protecting the object indicated by h. In addition to returning the printstrings, this routine also returns instructions about how to print the strings. When the tokenize variable is set to FALSE, a printstring might be r or w, which could be concatenated in the display as rw without any confusion. However, when the tokenize variable is TRUE, it implies the printstrings might be of a form like read or write, which must be displayed separated by spaces or colons or something. In any list of permission printstrings, there may appear to be some redundancy. ACL managers often define aliases for common permission combinations. By convention, however, simple entries should appear at the beginning of the printstrings[] array, and combinations should appear at the end. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not among those referenced by the input handle. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_get_manager_types
4.18 – sec_acl_lookup
NAME sec_acl_lookup - Returns the ACL for an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_lookup( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, sec_acl_list_t *sec_acl_list, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container Output sec_acl_list A pointer to the sec_acl_list_t structure to receive the complete Access Control List. An ACL contains a list of ACL entries, the UUID of the default cell where authentication takes place (foreign entries in the ACL contain the name of their home cell), and the UUID of the ACL manager to interpret the list. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_lookup() routine loads into memory a copy of an object's ACL corresponding to the specified manager type. The routine returns a pointer to the ACL. This routine is only used by ACL editors and browsers; an application would use sec_acl_test_access() or sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf() to process the contents of an ACL. Permissions Required The sec_acl_lookup() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the ACL is to be returned. NOTES The memory containing the sec_acl_t structure for each ACL is dynamically allocated. Use the sec_acl_release() routine to return each ACL's memory block to the pool when an application is finished with the ACLs. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. sec_acl_cant_allocate_memory The requested operation requires more memory than is avail- able. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_test_access sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf
4.19 – sec_acl_release
NAME sec_acl_release - Releases ACL storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_release( sec_acl_handle_t h, sec_acl_t *sec_acl, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. sec_acl A pointer to the complete ACL associated with the target object. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_release() routine releases any local storage associated with the ACL object, returning it to the pool. This is strictly a local operation (since the storage in question is local), and has no effect on the remote object or its ACL. The ACL handle is in the argument list only for consistency with other sec_acl routines. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_lookup
4.20 – sec_acl_release_handle
NAME sec_acl_release_handle - Removes an ACL handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_release_handle( sec_acl_handle_t *h, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h The handle to be removed. The handle is bound to the object to which the ACL belongs with the sec_acl_bind() routine. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_release_handle() routine removes the specified handle. This is strictly a local operation, and has no effect on the remote object or its ACL. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind
4.21 – sec_acl_replace
NAME sec_acl_replace - Replaces an ACL SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> void sec_acl_replace( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_type_t sec_acl_type, sec_acl_list_t *sec_acl_list, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. sec_acl_type The ACL type. The sec_acl_type_t data type distinguishes the various types of ACLs an object can possess for a given manager type. The possible values are as follows: + sec_acl_type_object + sec_acl_type_default_object + sec_acl_type_default_container sec_acl_list The new ACL to use for the target object. This is represented by a pointer to the sec_acl_list_t structure containing the complete Access Control List. An ACL contains a list of ACL entries, the UUID of the default cell where authentication will take place (foreign entries in the ACL contain the name of their parent cell), and the UUID of the ACL manager to interpret the list. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_replace() routine replaces the ACL indicated by the input handle with the information in the sec_acl_list parameter. ACLs are thought of as immutable, and in order to modify them, an editing application must read an entire ACL (using the sec_acl_lookup() routine), modify it as needed, and replace it using this routine. Permissions Required The sec_acl_replace() routine requires the c (control) permission on the object for which the ACL is to be replaced. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_lookup
4.22 – sec_acl_test_access
NAME sec_acl_test_access - Tests access to an object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> boolean32 sec_acl_test_access( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_acl_permset_t desired_permset, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. desired_permset A permission set in sec_acl_permset_t form containing the desired privileges. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_test_access() routine determines if the specified ACL contains entries granting privileges to the calling process matching those in desired_permset. An application generally only inquires after the minimum set of privileges needed to accomplish a specific task. Permissions Required The sec_acl_test_access() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the privileges are to be tested. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the calling application program is authorized to access the target object with the privileges in desired_permset. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf
4.23 – sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf
NAME sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf - Tests access to an object on behalf of another process SYNOPSIS #include <dce/daclif.h> boolean32 sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf( sec_acl_handle_t h, uuid_t *manager_type, sec_id_pac_t *subject, sec_acl_permset_t desired_permset, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the target object. Use sec_acl_bind() to create this handle. manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_acl_get_manager_types() to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given object. subject A Privilege Attribute Certificate (PAC) for the subject process. The PAC contains the name and UUID of the principal and cell of the subject process, as well as a list of any groups to which it belongs. The PAC also contains a flag (named authenticated). When set, it indicates that the certificate was obtained from an authenticated source. When not set, the certificate must not be trusted. (The field is FALSE when it was obtained from the rpc_auth layer and the protect level was set to rpc_c_protect_level_none. This indicates that no authentication protocol was actually used in the remote procedure call; the identity was simply transmitted from the caller to the callee. If an authentication protocol was used, then the flag is set to TRUE.) If a null PAC is passed, the subject is treated as an "anonymous user", matching only the any_other and unauthenticated entries (if they exist) on the ACL. A server uses rpc_binding_inq_auth_client() to acquire a certificate for the client process. desired_permset A permission set in sec_acl_permset_t form containing the desired privileges. This is a 32-bit set of permission flags supported by the manager type. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf() routine determines if the specified ACL contains entries that grant the privileges specified in desired_permset to the subject process. An application generally inquires about only the minimum set of privileges needed to accomplish a specific task. Permissions Required The sec_acl_test_access_on_behalf() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the object for which the privileges are to be tested. Both the calling process and the identified subject must have permission on the object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]DACLIF.IDL The idl file from which dce/daclif.h was derived. RETURN VALUES If the routine completes successfully (with a completion status of error_status_ok) it returns a value of + TRUE if the caller has any access (at least one permission of any kind), and the subject has the desired_permset privileges. + FALSE if both the caller and the subject have any access, but the subject does not have the desired_permset privileges. If the routine does not complete successfully, it returns a bad completion status code and a return value of FALSE. ERRORS sec_acl_unknown_manager_type The manager type selected is not an available option. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_acl_bind sec_acl_test_access rpc_binding_inq_auth_client
4.24 – sec_attr_trig_query
NAME sec_attr_trig_query - Reads attributes coded with an attribute trigger type of query SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_attr_trig.h> void sec_attr_trig_query ( handle_t h, sec_attr_component_name_t cell_name, sec_attr_component_name_t component_name, sec_attr_trig_cursor_t *cursor, unsigned32 num_attr_keys, unsigned32 space_avail, sec_attr_t attr_keys[], unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_attr_t attrs[], sec_attr_trig_timeval_sec_t time_to_live[], unsigned32 *num_left, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the trigger server to be accessed Use the trigger binding information specified in the attribute encoding to acquire a bound handle. cell_name A value of sec_attr_component_name_t that identifies the cell in which the object whose attribute is to be accessed resides. Supply a NULL cell_name to specify the local cell (/.:). component_name A value of sec_attr_component_name_t that identifies the name of the object whose attribute is to be accessed. If cell_name specifies a foreign cell, component_name is interpreted as a UUID in string format since the caller of this interface knows only the UUID, not the name, of the foreign principal. num_attr_keys An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the attr_keys[] array. This integer must be greater than 0. space_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the size of the attr_keys[] array. attr_keys[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t. For each attribute instance, the sec_attr_t array contains an attr_id (a UUID of type uuid_t) to identify the attribute to be queried and an attr_value. attr_value can be used to pass in optional information required by the attribute trigger query. If no additional information is to be passed, set attr_value to sec_attr_enc_void. This is actually accomplished by setting the sec_attr_encoding_t data type to sec_attr_enc_void. The size of the attr_keys[] array is determined by num_attr_keys. Input/Output cursor A pointer to a cursor of type sec_attr_trig_cursor_t. As an input parameter, cursor can be initialized (by the sec_addr_trig_cursor_init routine) or uninitialized. As an output parameter, cursor is positioned past the attributes returned in this call. Output num_returned A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attribute instances returned in the attr_keys[] array. attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t. The size of this array is determined by the space_avail parameter and the length by the num_returned parameter. time_to_live[], An array of values of type sec_attr_trig_timeval_sec_t. For each attribute in the attrs[] array, The time_to_live[] array specifies the time in seconds that the attribute can be safely cached. num_left A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that supplies the number of attributes found but not returned because of space constraints in the attrs[] buffer. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_attr_trig_query() routine reads attributes coded with an attribute trigger type of query. The sec_attr_trig_query() routine is called by the DCE attribute lookup code for all schema entries that specify a query attribute trigger (sec_attr_trig_type_query specified with the sec_attr_trig_type_flags_t data type). The attribute query code passes the sec_attr_trig_query() input parameters to a user-written query attribute trigger server and receives the output parameters back from the server. Although generally this routine it is not called directly, this reference page is provided for users who are writing the attribute trigger servers that will receive sec_attr_trig_query() input and supply its output. Multi-valued attributes are returned as independent attribute instances sharing the same attribute UUID. A read of an attribute set returns all instances of members of the set; the attribute set instance is not returned. For objects in the local cell, set the cell_name parameter to null, and the component_name parameter to specify the object's name. For objects in a foreign cell, set the cell_name parameter to identify the name of the foreign cell, and the component_name parameter to the UUID in string format that identifies the object in the foreign cell. The cursor parameter specifies a cursor of type sec_attr_trig_cursor_t that establishes the point in the attribute list at which to start processing the query. Use the sec_attr_trig_cursor_init function to initialize a list cursor. If cursor is uninitialized, the server begins processing the query at the first attribute that satisfies the search criteria. Note that generally, sec_attr_trig_cursor_init function makes a remote call to the specified server. To initialize the cursor without making this remote call, set the sec_attr_trig_cursor_init function valid parameter to 0. The num_left parameter contains the number of attributes that were found but could not be returned because of space constraints of the attrs[] array. (Note that this number may be inaccurate if the target server allows updates between successive queries.) To obtain all of the remaining attributes, set the size of the attrs[] array so that it is large enough to hold the number of attributes listed in num_left. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_ATTR_TRIG.IDL The idl file from which sec_attr_trig.h was derived. ERRORS not_all_available unauthorized error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_attr_trig_cursor_init sec_attr_trig_update
4.25 – sec_attr_trig_update
NAME sec_attr_trig_update - For attributes coded with an attribute trigger type of update, passes attribute updates to an update attribute trigger server for evaluation SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_attr_trig.h> void sec_attr_trig_update ( handle_t h, sec_attr_component_name_t cell_name, sec_attr_component_name_t component_name, unsigned32 num_to_write, unsigned32 space_avail, sec_attr_t in_attrs[], unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_attr_t out_attrs[], unsigned32 *num_left, signed32 *failure_index, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input h A handle referring to the trigger server to be accessed. Use the trigger binding information specified in the attribute encoding to acquire a bound handle. cell_name A value of sec_attr_component_name_t that identifies the cell in which the object whose attribute is to be accessed resides. Supply a NULL cell_name to specify the local cell (/.:). component_name A value of sec_attr_component_name_t that identifies the name of the object whose attribute is to be accessed. If cell_name specifies a foreign cell, component_name is interpreted as a UUID in string format since the caller of this interface knows only the UUID, not the name, of the foreign principal. num_to_write An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the in_attrs array. This integer must be greater than 0. space_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the size of the out_attrs array. in_attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the attribute instances to be written. The size of in_attrs[] is determined by num_to_write. Output num_returned A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attribute instances returned in the out_attrs[] array. out_attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t. These values, supplied by the update attribute trigger server, are in a form suitable for storage in the registry database. num_left A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that supplies the number of attributes that were found but not returned because of space constraints in the out_attrs[] buffer. failure_index In the event of an error, failure_index is a pointer to the element in the in_attrs[] array that caused the update to fail. If the failure cannot be attributed to a specific attribute, the value of failure_index is -1. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_attr_trig_update() routine passes attributes coded with an attribute trigger type of update to a user-written update attribute trigger server for evaluation before the updates are made to the registry. Although generally this routine it is not called directly, this reference page is provided for users who are writing the attribute trigger servers that will receive sec_attr_trig_update() input and supply its output. The sec_attr_trig_update() routine is called by the DCE attribute update code for all schema entries that specify an update attribute trigger (sec_attr_trig_type_update specified with the sec_attr_trig_type_flags_t data type). The attribute update code passes the sec_attr_trig_update() input parameters to a user-written update attribute trigger server and receives the output parameters back from the server. The attribute trigger server is responsible for evaluating the semantics of the entry in order to reject or accept it, and the attribute trigger server may even make changes in the output it sends back to the update code to ensure the entry adheres to the semantics. The output received from the attribute trigger server is in a form to be stored in the registry. (Note that update attribute trigger servers do not store attribute values. Attribute values are stored in the registry database.) This is an atomic operation: if the update of any attribute in the array fails to pass the evaluation, all updates are aborted. The attribute causing the update to fail is identified in failure_index. If the failure cannot be attributed to a given attribute, failure_index contains -1. For objects in the local cell, set the cell_name parameter to null, and the component_name parameter to specify the object's name. For objects in a foreign cell, set the cell_name parameter the the name of the foreign cells, and the component_name parameter to specify the UUID in string format that identifies the object in the foreign cell. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_ATTR_TRIG.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_attr_trig.h was derived. ERRORS database read only server unavailable invalid/unsupported attribute type invalid encoding type value not unique site read only unauthorized error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_attr_trig_query
4.26 – sec_cred_free_attr_cursor
NAME sec_cred_free_attr_cursor - Free the local resources allocated to a sec_attr_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_free_attr_cursor ( sec_cred_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor As input, a pointer to a sec_cred_attr_cursor_t whose resources are to be freed. As output a pointer to an initialized sec_cred_attr_cursor_t with allocated resources freed. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_free_attr_cursor() routine frees the resources assoicated with a cursor of type sec_cred_attr_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() call. ERRORS error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor
4.27 – sec_cred_free_cursor
NAME sec_cred_free_cursor - Release local resources allocated to a sec_cred_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_delegate() call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_free_cursor ( sec_cred_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor As input, a sec_cred_cursor_t whose resources are to be freed. As output, a sec_cred_cursor_t whose resources are freed. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_free_cursor() routine releases local resources allocated to a sec_cred_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_delegate() call. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_initialize_cursor
4.28 – sec_cred_free_pa_handle
NAME sec_cred_free_pa_handle - Free the local resources allocated to a privilege attribute handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t used by the sec_cred_get_initiator() and sec_cred_get_delegate() calls SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_free_pa_handle ( sec_cred_pa_handle__t *pa_handle, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output pa_handle As input, a pointer to a sec_cred_pa_handle_t whose resources are to be freed. As output a pointer to a sec_cred_pa_handle_t with allocated resources freed. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_free_pa_handle() routine frees the resources assoicated with a privilege attribute handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t used by the sec_cred_get_initiator() and sec_cred_get_delegate() calls. ERRORS error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_initiator sec_cred_get_delegate
4.29 – sec_cred_get_authz_session_info
NAME sec_cred_get_authz_session_info - Returns session-specific information that represents an authenticated client's credentials. SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_get_authz_session_info( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, uuid_t *session_id, sec_timeval_t *session_expiration, error_status_t *status ); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A credential handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t. This handle is supplied as output of the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. Output session_ID A pointer to a uuid_t that identifies the client's DCE authorization session. session_expiration A pointer to a sec_timeval_t that specifies the expiration time of the authenticated client's credentials. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_authz_session_info() routine retrieves session-specific information that represents the credentials of authenticated client specified by callers_identity. If the client is a member of a delegation chain, the information represents the credentials of all members of the chain. The information can aid application servers in the construction of identity-based caches. For example, it could be used as a key into a cache of previously allocated delegation contexts and thus avoid the overhead of allocating a new login context on every remote operation. It could also be used as a key into a table of previously computed authorization decisions. Before you execute this call, you must execute an rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call to obtain an rpc_authz_cred_handle_t for the callers_identity parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_authz_cannot_comply error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller
4.30 – sec_cred_get_client_princ_name
NAME sec_cred_get_client_princ_name - Returns the principal name associated with a credential handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_get_client_princ_name( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, unsigned_char_p_t *client_princ_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t to the credentials for which to return the principal name. This handle is supplied as output of the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. Output client_princ_name A pointer to the principal name of the server's rpc client. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_client_princ_name() routine extracts the principal name associated with the credentials identified by callers_pas. Before you execute sec_cred_get_client_princ_name(), you must execute an rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call to obtain an rpc_authz_cred_handle_t for the callers_identity parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_authz_cannot_comply error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller
4.31 – sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions
NAME sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions - Returns delegate restrictions from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_restriction_set_t *sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A value of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t that provides a handle to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of the sec_cred_get_initiator() call, the sec_cred_get_delegate() call and the sec_login_cred calls. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions () routine extracts delegate restrictions from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas. The restrictions are returned in a sec_id_restriction_set_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_pa_data(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.32 – sec_cred_get_delegate
NAME sec_cred_get_delegate - Returns a handle to the privilege attributes of an intermediary in a delegation chain SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_cred_pa_handle_t sec_cred_get_delegate( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, sec_cred_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t. This handle is supplied as output of the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. Input/Output cursor As input, a pointer to a cursor of type sec_cred_cursor_t that has been initialized by the sec_cred_initialize_cursor() call. As an output parameter, cursor is a pointer to a cursor of type sec_attr_srch_cursor_t that is positioned past the principal whose privilege attributes have been returned in this call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_delegate() routine returns a handle to the the privilege attributes of an intermediary in a delegation chain that performed an authenticated RPC operation. This call is used by servers. Clients use the sec_login_cred_get_delegate() routine to return the privilege attribute handle of an intermediary in a delegation chain. The credential handle identified by callers_identity contains authenti- cation and authorization information for all delegates in the chain. This call returns a handle (sec_cred_pa_handle_t) to the privilege attributes of one of the delegates in the binding handle. The sec_cred_pa_handle_t returned by this call is used in other sec_cred_get... calls to obtain privilege attribute information for a single delegate. To obtain the privilege attributes of each delegate in the credential handle identified by callers_identity, execute this call until the message sec_cred_s_no_more_entries is returned. Before you execute sec_cred_get_delegate(), you must execute: + An rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call to obtain an rpc_authz_cred_handle_t for the callers_identity parameter. + A sec_cred_initialize_cursor() call to initialize a cursor of type sec_cred_cursor_t. Use the sec_cred_free_pa_handle() all to free the resources associated with the sec_cred_pa_handle_t. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_auth_handle sec_cred_s_invalid_cursor sec_cred_s_no_more_entries error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller sec_cred_initialize_cursor sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions sec_cred_get_delegation_type sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions sec_cred_get_pa_date sec_cred_get_req_restrictions sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions sec_cred_get_v1_pac sec_cred_free_pa_handle
4.33 – sec_cred_get_delegation_type
NAME sec_cred_get_delegation_type - Returns the delegation type from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_delegation_type_t *sec_cred_get_delegation_type( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A value of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t that provides a handle to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or ec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_delegation_type () routine extracts the delegation type from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas and returns it in a sec_id_delegation_type_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_delegation_type(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.34 – sec_cred_get_extended_attrs
NAME sec_cred_get_extended_attrs - Returns extended attributes from a privilege handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_get_extended_attrs( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, sec_cred_attr_cursor_t *cursor sec_attr_t *attr error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to the caller's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Input/Output cursor A cursor of type sec_cred_attr_cursor_t that has been initialized by the sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor() routine. As input cursor must be initialized. As output, cursor is positioned at the first attribute after the returned attribute. Output attr A pointer to a value of sec_attr_t that contains extended registry attributes. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() routine extracts extended registry initialized from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas. Before you execute call, you must execute: + A sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. + A sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor() to initialize a sec_attr_t. To obtain all the extended registry attributes in the privilege attribute handle, repeat sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() calls until the status message no_more_entries_available is returned. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle sec_cred_s_invalid_cursor sec_cred_s_no_more_entries error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor sec_cred_get_initiator sec_cred_get_delegate
4.35 – sec_cred_get_initiator
NAME sec_cred_get_initiator - Returns the privilege attributes of the initiator of a delegation chain SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_cred_pa_handle_t sec_cred_get_initiator( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A credential handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t. This handle is supplied as output of the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_initiator() routine returns a handle to the the privilege attributes of the initiator of a delegation chain that performed an authenticated RPC operation. The credential handle identified by callers_identity contains authentication and authorization information for all delegates in the chain. This call returns a handle (sec_cred_pa_handle_t) to the privilege attributes of the client that initiated the delegation chain. The sec_cred_pa_handle_t returned by this call is used in other sec_cred_get... calls to obtain privilege attribute information for the initiator. Before you execute sec_cred_get_initiator(), you must execute an rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call to obtain an rpc_authz_cred_handle_t for the callers_identity parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_auth_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions sec_cred_get_delegation_type sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions sec_cred_get_pa_date sec_cred_get_req_restrictions sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions sec_cred_get_v1_pac
4.36 – sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions
NAME sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions - Returns optional restrictions from a privilege handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_opt_req_t *sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions () routine extracts optional restrictions from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas and returns them in a sec_id_restriction_set_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_pa_data(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.37 – sec_cred_get_pa_data
NAME sec_cred_get_pa_data - Returns identity information from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_pa_t *sec_cred_get_pa_data( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_pa_data() routine extracts identity information from the privilege attribute handle specified by callers_pas and returns it in a sec_id_pa_t. The identity information includes an identifier of the princpal's locall cell and the principal's local and foreign group sets. Before you execute sec_cred_get_pa_data(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.38 – sec_cred_get_req_restrictions
NAME sec_cred_get_req_restrictions - Returns required restrictions from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_opt_req_t *sec_cred_get_req_restrictions ( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_req_restrictions() routine extracts required restrictions from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas and returns them in a sec_id_opt_req_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_req_restrictions(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.39 – sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions
NAME sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions - Returns target restrictions from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_restriction_set_t *sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to a principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions() routine extracts target restrictions from the privilege attribute handle identified by callers_pas and returns them in a sec_id_restriction_set_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.40 – sec_cred_get_v1_pac
NAME sec_cred_get_v1_pac - Returns pre-1.1 PAC from a privilege attribute handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> sec_id_pac_t *sec_cred_get_v1_pac( sec_cred_pa_handle_t callers_pas, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_pas A handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to the principal's privilege attributes. This handle is supplied as output of either the sec_cred_get_initiator() call or sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_get_v1_pac() routine extracts the privilege attributes from a pre-1.1 PAC for the privilege attribute handle specified by callers_pas and returns them in a sec_id_pa_t. Before you execute sec_cred_get_v1_pac(), you must execute a sec_cred_get_initiator() or sec_cred_get_delegate() call to obtain a sec_cred_pa_handle_t for the callers_pas parameter. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_pa_handle error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_get_initiator
4.41 – sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor
NAME sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor - Initialize a sec_attr_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor ( sec_cred_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor As input, a pointer to a sec_cred_attr_cursor_t to be initialized. As output a pointer to an initialized sec_cred_attr_cursor_t. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_initialize_attr_cursor() routine allocates and initializes a cursor of type sec_cred_attr_cursor_t for use with the sec_cred_get_extended_attrs() call. Use the sec_cred_free_attr_cursor() call to free the resources allocated to cursor. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_free_attr_cursor
4.42 – sec_cred_initialize_cursor
NAME sec_cred_initialize_cursor - Initialize a sec_cred_cursor_t used by the sec_cred_get_delegate() call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_cred_initialize_cursor ( sec_cred_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor As input, a sec_cred_cursor_t to be initialized. As output, an initialized sec_cred_cursor_t. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_initialize_cursor() routine initializes a cursor of type sec_cursor_t for use with the sec_cred_get_delegate() call. Use the sec_cred_free_cursor() call to free the resources allocated to cursor. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_delegate sec_cred_free_cursor
4.43 – sec_cred_is_authenticated
NAME sec_cred_is_authenticated - Returns true if the supplied credentials are authenticated and false if they are not SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> boolean32 sec_cred_is_authenticated( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t to the credentials to check for authentication. This handle is supplied as output of the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_cred_is_authenticated() routine returns true if the credentials identified by callers_identity are authenticated or false if they are not. Before you execute this call, you must execute an rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call to obtain an rpc_authz_cred_handle_t for the callers_identity parameter. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_CRED.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_cred.h was derived. RETURN VALUES The routine returns true is the credentials are authenticated; false if they are not. ERRORS TBS RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller
4.44 – sec_id_gen_group
NAME sec_id_gen_group - Generates a global name from cell and group UUIDs SYNOPSIS #include <dce/secidmap.h> void sec_id_gen_group( sec_rgy_handle_t context, uuid_t *cell_idp, uuid_t *group_idp, sec_rgy_name_t global_name, sec_rgy_name_t cell_namep, sec_rgy_name_t group_namep, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. cell_idp A pointer to the UUID of the home cell of the group whose name is in question. group_idp A pointer to the UUID of the group whose name is in question. Output global_name The global (full) name of the group in sec_rgy_name_t form. cell_namep The name of the group's home cell in sec_rgy_name_t form. group_namep The local (with respect to the home cell) name of the group in sec_rgy_name_t form. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the function returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_id_gen_group() routine generates a global name from input cell and group UUIDs. For example, given a UUID specifying the cell /.../world/hp/brazil, and a UUID specifying a group resident in that cell named writers, the routine would return the global name of that group, in this case, /.../world/hp/brazil/writers. It also returns the simple names of the cell and group, translated from the UUIDs. The routine will not produce translations to any name for which a NULL pointer has been supplied. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SECIDMAP.IDL The idl file from which dce/secidmap.h was derived. ERRORS sec_id_e_name_too_long The name is too long for current implementation. sec_id_e_bad_cell_uuid The cell UUID is not valid. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified group. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_id_gen_name sec_id_parse_group sec_id_parse_name
4.45 – sec_id_gen_name
NAME sec_id_gen_name - Generates a global name from cell and principal UUIDs SYNOPSIS #include <dce/secidmap.h> void sec_id_gen_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, uuid_t *cell_idp, uuid_t *princ_idp, sec_rgy_name_t global_name, sec_rgy_name_t cell_namep, sec_rgy_name_t princ_namep, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. cell_idp A pointer to the UUID of the home cell of the principal whose name is in question. princ_idp A pointer to the UUID of the principal whose name is in question. Output global_name The global (full) name of the principal in sec_rgy_name_t form. cell_namep The name of the principal's home cell in sec_rgy_name_t form. princ_namep The local (with respect to the home cell) name of the principal in sec_rgy_name_t form. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the function returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_id_gen_name() routine generates a global name from input cell and principal UUIDs. For example, given a UUID specifying the cell /.../world/hp/brazil, and a UUID specifying a principal resident in that cell named writers/tom, the routine would return the global name of that principal, in this case, /.../world/hp/brazil/writers/tom. It also returns the simple names of the cell and principal, translated from the UUIDs. The routine will not produce translations to any name for which a NULL pointer has been supplied. Permissions Required The sec_id_gen_name() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the account associated with the input cell and principal UUIDs. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SECIDMAP.IDL The idl file from which dce/secidmap.h was derived. ERRORS sec_id_e_name_too_long The name is too long for current implementation. sec_id_e_bad_cell_uuid The cell UUID is not valid. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified principal. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_id_gen_group sec_id_parse_group sec_id_parse_name
4.46 – sec_id_parse_group
NAME sec_id_parse_group - Translates a global name into group and cell names and UUIDs SYNOPSIS #include <dce/secidmap.h> void sec_id_parse_group( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t global_name, sec_rgy_name_t cell_namep, uuid_t *cell_idp, sec_rgy_name_t group_namep, uuid_t *group_idp, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. global_name The global (full) name of the group in sec_rgy_name_t form. Output cell_namep The output name of the group's home cell in sec_rgy_name_t form. cell_idp A pointer to the UUID of the home cell of the group whose name is in question. group_namep The local (with respect to the home cell) name of the group in sec_rgy_name_t form. group_idp A pointer to the UUID of the group whose name is in question. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the function returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_id_parse_group() routine translates a global group name into a cell name and a cell-relative group name. It also returns the UUIDs associated with the group and its home cell. The routine will not produce translations to any name for which a NULL pointer has been supplied. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SECIDMAP.IDL The idl file from which dce/secidmap.h was derived. ERRORS sec_id_e_name_too_long The name is too long for current implementation. sec_id_e_bad_cell_uuid The cell UUID is not valid. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified group. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_id_gen_group sec_id_gen_name sec_id_parse_group sec_id_parse_name
4.47 – sec_id_parse_name
NAME sec_id_parse_name - Translates a global name into principal and cell names and UUIDs SYNOPSIS #include <dce/secidmap.h> void sec_id_parse_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t global_name, sec_rgy_name_t cell_namep, uuid_t *cell_idp, sec_rgy_name_t princ_namep, uuid_t *princ_idp, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. global_name The global (full) name of the principal in sec_rgy_name_t form. Output cell_namep The output name of the principal's home cell in sec_rgy_name_t form. cell_idp A pointer to the UUID of the home cell of the principal whose name is in question. princ_namep The local (with respect to the home cell) name of the principal in sec_rgy_name_t form. princ_idp A pointer to the UUID of the principal whose name is in question. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the function returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_id_parse_name() routine translates a global principal name into a cell name and a cell-relative principal name. It also returns the UUIDs associated with the principal and its home cell. The routine will not produce translations to any name for which a NULL pointer has been supplied. Permissions Required Only if princ_idp is requested as output does the sec_id_parse_name() routine require a permission. In this case, the routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the account whose global principal name is to be translated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SECIDMAP.IDL The idl file from which dce/secidmap.h was derived. ERRORS sec_id_e_name_too_long The name is too long for current implementation. sec_id_e_bad_cell_uuid The cell UUID is not valid. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified principal. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_id_gen_name
4.48 – sec_key_mgmt_change_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_change_key - Changes a principal's key SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_change_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, unsigned32 key_vno, void *keydata, sec_timeval_period_t *garbage_collect_time, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key function. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key is to be changed. key_vno The version number of the new key. If 0 (zero) is specified, the routine will select the next appropriate key version number. keydata A pointer to a structure of type sec_passwd_rec_t. Output garbage_collect_time The number of seconds that must elapse before all currently valid tickets (which are encoded with the current or previous keys) expire. At that time, all obsolete keys may be "garbage collected", since no valid tickets encoded with those keys will remain outstanding on the network. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_change_key() routine performs all activities necessary to update a principal's key to the specified value. This includes updating any local storage for the principal's key and also performing any remote operations needed to keep the authentication protocol (or network registry) current. Old keys for the principal are garbage collected if appropriate. FILES The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS Any error condition will leave the key state unchanged. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The old key is not present and therefore cannot be used to set a client side authentication context. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_auth_unavailable The authentication protocol is not available to update the network database or to obtain the necessary network credentials. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unsupported The key type is not supported. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_version_ex A key with this version number already exists. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. sec_rgy_object_not_found No principal was found with the given name. sec_login_s_no_memory A memory allocation error occurred. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_generate_key sec_key_mgmt_set_key
4.49 – sec_key_mgmt_delete_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_delete_key - Deletes a key from the local storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_delete_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, unsigned32 key_vno, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key function. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key is to be deleted. key_vno The version number of the desired key. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_delete_key() routine deletes the specified key from the local key store. If an administrator ever discovers or suspects that the security of a server's key has been compromised, the administrator should delete the key immediately with sec_key_mgmt_delete_key(). This routine removes the key from the local key storage, which invalidates all extant tickets encoded with the key. If the compromised key is the current one, the principal should change the key with sec_key_mgmt_change_key() before deleting it. It is not an error for a process to delete the current key (as long as it is done after the network context has been established), but it may seriously inconvenience legitimate clients of a service. This routine deletes all key types that have the specified key version number. A key type identifies the data encryption algorithm being used (for example, DES). This routine differs from sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type() in that sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type() deletes only the specified key version of the specified key type from the local key store. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS Any error condition will leave the key state unchanged. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect
4.50 – sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type
NAME sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type - Deletes a key version of a key type from the local key storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, void *keytype, unsigned32 key_vno, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key type is to be deleted. keytype A pointer to a value of type sec_passwd_type_t. The value identifies the data encryption algorithm that is being used (for example, DES). key_vno The version number of the desired key. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_delete_key_type() routine deletes the specified key version of the specified key type from the local key store. It differs from sec_key_mgmt_delete_key() in that sec_key_mgmt_delete_key() deletes all key types that have the same key version number. This routine removes the key from the local key storage, which invalidates all extant tickets encoded with the key. If the key in question is the current one, the principal should change the key with sec_key_mgmt_change_key() before deleting it. It is not an error for a process to delete the current key (as long as it is done after the network context has been established), but it may seriously inconvenience legitimate clients of a service. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS Any error condition will leave the key state unchanged. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_delete_key sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect
4.51 – sec_key_mgmt_free_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_free_key - Frees the memory used by a key value SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_free_key( void *keydata, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input keydata A pointer to a structure of type sec_passwd_rec_t. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_free_key() routine releases any storage allocated for the indicated key data by sec_key_mgmt_get_key(). The storage for the key data returned by sec_key_mgmt_get_key() is dynamically allocated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_get_key
4.52 – sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect
NAME sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect - Deletes obsolete keys SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key information is to be garbage collected. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect() routine discards any obsolete key information for this principal. An obsolete key is one that can only decode invalid tickets. As an example, consider a key that was in use on Monday, and was only used to encode tickets whose maximum lifetime was 1 day. If that key was changed at 8:00 a.m. Tuesday morning, then it would become obsolete by 8:00 a.m. Wednesday morning, at which time there could be no valid tickets outstanding. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. Requested key not present. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. sec_rgy_object_not_found No principal was found with the given name. sec_login_s_no_memory A memory allocation error occurred. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_delete_key
4.53 – sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key - Generates a new random key of a specified key type SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, void *keytype, unsigned32 key_vno, void **keydata, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal for whom the key is to be generated. keytype A pointer to a value of type sec_passwd_type_t. The value identifies the data encryption algorithm to be used for the key (for example, DES). key_vno The version number of the new key. Output keydata A pointer to a value of sec_passwd_rec_t. The storage for keydata is allocated dynamically, so the returned pointer actually indicates a pointer to the key value. The storage for this data may be freed with the sec_key_mgmt_free_key() function. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key() routine generates a new random key for a specified principal and of a specified key type. The generated key can be used with the sec_key_mgmt_change_key() and sec_key_mgmt_set_key() routines. Note that to initialize the random keyseed, the process must first make an authenticated call such as sec_rgy_site_open(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_not_implemented The specified keytype is not supported. sec_s_no_key_seed No random key seed has been set. sec_s_no_memory Unable to allocate memory. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_change_key sec_key_mgmt_generate_key sec_key_mgmt_set_key
4.54 – sec_key_mgmt_get_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_get_key - Retrieves a key from local storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_get_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, unsigned32 key_vno, void **keydata, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal to whom the key belongs. key_vno The version number of the desired key. To return the latest version of the key, set this parameter to sec_c_key_version_none. Output keydata A pointer to a value of type sec_passwd_rec_t. The storage for keydata is allocated dynamically, so the returned pointer actually indicates a pointer to the key value. The storage for this data may be freed with the sec_key_mgmt_free_key() routine. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_get_key() routine extracts the specified key from the local key store. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_s_no_memory Unable to allocate memory. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.55 – sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key - Retrieves successive keys from the local key storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key( void *cursor, idl_char **principal_name, unsigned32 *key_vno, void **keydata, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input cursor A pointer to the current cursor position in the local key storage. The cursor position is set via the routine sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor(). Output principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal associated with the extracted key. Free the storage for the principal name with the free() function. key_vno The version number of the extracted key. keydata A pointer to a value of type sec_passwd_rec_t. The storage for keydata is allocated dynamically, so the returned pointer actually indicates a pointer to the key value. The storage for this data may be freed with the sec_key_mgmt_free_key() function. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key() routine extracts the key pointed to by the cursor in the local key store and updates the cursor to point to the next key. By repeatedly calling this routine you can scan all the keys in the local store. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_s_no_memory Unable to allocate memory. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_get_key sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor
4.56 – sec_key_mgmt_get_next_kvno
NAME sec_key_mgmt_get_next_kvno - Retrieves the next eligible key version number for a key SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_get_next_kvno( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, void *keytype, unsigned32 *key_vno, unsigned32 *next_key_vno, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal associated with the key. keytype A pointer to a value of type sec_passwd_type_t. The value identifies the data encryption algorithm (for example, DES) being used for the key. Output key_vno The current version number of the key. Specify NULL if you do not need this value to be returned. next_key_vno The next eligible version number for the key. Specify NULL if you do not need this value to be returned. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_get_next_kvno() routine returns the current and next eligible version numbers for a key from the registry server (not from the local key table). The key is identified via its associated authentication protocol, principal name, and key type. The arg value associated with the key is also specified. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. sec_rgy_object_not_found No principal was found with the given name. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.57 – sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor
NAME sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor - Repositions the cursor in the local key store SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, void *keytype, void **cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key is to be accessed. To access all keys in the local key store, supply NULL for this parameter. keytype A pointer to the data encryption algorithm (for example, DES) being used for the key. Output cursor The returned cursor value. The storage for the cursor information is allocated dynamically, so the returned pointer actually indicates a pointer to the cursor value. The storage for this data may be freed with the sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor() routine. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor() routine resets the cursor in the local key store. Use this routine to reposition the cursor before performing a scan of the local store via sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key(). The returned cursor value is supplied as input to sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_s_no_memory Unable to allocate memory. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_get_next_key sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor
4.58 – sec_key_mgmt_manage_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_manage_key - Automatically changes a principal's key before it expires SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_manage_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit ktadd command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal whose key is to be managed. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_manage_key() routine changes the specified principal's key on a regular basis, as determined by the local cell's policy. It will run indefinitely, never returning during normal operation, and therefore should be invoked only from a thread that has been devoted to managing keys. This routine queries the DCE Registry to determine the password expiration policy that applies to the named principal. It then idles until a short time before the current key is due to expire and then uses the sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key() to produce a new random key, updating both the local key store and the DCE Registry. This routine also invokes sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect() as needed. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The old key is not present and therefore cannot be used to set a client side authentication context. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unsupported The key type is not supported. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. sec_rgy_object_not_found No principal was found with the given name. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key sec_key_mgmt_garbage_collect
4.59 – sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor
NAME sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor - Releases the memory used by an initialized cursor value SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor( void **cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input cursor A pointer to the cursor value for which the storage is to be released. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_release_cursor() routine releases any storage allocated for the indicated cursor value by sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor(). The storage for the cursor value returned by sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor() is dynamically allocated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_initialize_cursor
4.60 – sec_key_mgmt_set_key
NAME sec_key_mgmt_set_key - Inserts a key value into the local storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/keymgmt.h> void sec_key_mgmt_set_key( sec_key_mgmt_authn_service authn_service, void *arg, idl_char *principal_name, unsigned32 key_vno, void *keydata, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using this key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local key file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default key file (DCE$LOCAL:[KRB]V5SRVTAB.;) should be used. A key file name specifies that file should be used as the key file. The file name must begin with FILE:. If the file name does not begin with FILE:, the code will add it. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. principal_name A pointer to a character string indicating the name of the principal associated with the key to be set. key_vno The version number of the key to be set. keydata A pointer to the key value to be set. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_key_mgmt_set_key() routine performs all local activities necessary to update a principal's key to the specified value. This routine will not update the authentication protocol's value for the principal's key. In some circumstances, a server may only wish to change its key in the local key storage, and not in the DCE Registry. For example, a database system may have several replicas of a master database, managed by servers running on independent machines. Since these servers together represent only one service, they should all share the same key. This way, a user with a ticket to use the database can choose whichever server is least busy. To change the database key, the master server would signal all the replica (slave) servers to change the current key in their local key storage. They would use the sec_key_mgmt_set_key() routine, which does not communicate with the DCE Registry. Once all the slaves have complied, the master server can then change the Registry key and its own local storage. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]KEYMGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/keymgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The old key is not present and therefore cannot be used to set a client side authentication context. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unsupported The key type is not supported. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_version_ex A key with this version number already exists. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_key_mgmt_change_key sec_key_mgmt_gen_rand_key
4.61 – sec_login_become_delegate
NAME sec_login_become_delegate - Causes an intermediate server to become a delegate in traced delegation chain SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_login_handle_t sec_login_become_delegate( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, sec_login_handle_t my_login_context, sec_id_delegation_type_t delegation_type_permitted, sec_id_restriction_set_t *delegate_restrictions, sec_id_restriction_set_t *target_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *optional_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *required_restrictions, sec_id_compatibility_mode_t compatibility_mode, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t to the authenticated identity of the previous delegate in the delegation chain. The handle is supplied by the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. my_login_context A value of sec_login_handle_t that provides an opaque handle to the identity of the client that is becoming the intermediate delegate. The sec_login_handle_t that specifies the client's identity is supplied as output of the following calls: + sec_login_get_current_context() if the client inherited the identity of the current context + The sec_login_setup_identity() and the sec_login_validate_identity() pair that together establish an authenticated identity if a new identity was established Note that this identity specified by sec_login_handle_t must be a simple login context; it cannot be a compound identity created by a previous sec_login_become_delegate() call. delegation_type_permitted A value of sec_id_delegation_type_t that specifies the type of delegation to be enabled. The types available are: sec_id_deleg_type_none No delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_traced Traced delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation Simple (impersonation) delegation. Note that the initiating client sets the type of delegation. If it is set as traced, all delegates must also specify traced delegation; they cannot specify simple delegation. The same is true if the initiating client sets the delegation type as simple; all subsequent delegates must also specify simple delegation. The intermediate delegates can, however, specify no delegation to indicate that the delegation chain can proceed no further. delegate_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as delegates for the intermediate client identified by my_login_context. These servers are added to delegates permitted by the delegate_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. target_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as targets for the intermediate client identified by my_login_context. These servers are added to targets specified by the target_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. optional_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined optional restrictions that apply to the intermediate client identified by my_login_context. These restrictions are added to the restrictions identified by the optional_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. required_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined required restrictions that apply to the intermediate client identified by my_login_context. These restrictions are added to the restrictions identified required_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. compatibility_mode A value of sec_id_compatibility_mode_t that specifies the compatibility mode to be used when the intermediate client operates on pre-1.1 servers. The modes available are: sec_id_compat_mode_none Compatibility mode is off. sec_id_compat_mode_initiator Compatibility mode is on. The pre-1.1 PAC data is extracted from the EPAC of the initiating client. sec_id_compat_mode_caller Compatibility mode is on. The pre-1.1 PAC data extracted from the EPAC of the last client in the delegation chain. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_become_delegate() is used by intermediate servers to become a delegate for the client identified by callers_identity. The routine returns a new login context (of type sec_login_handle_t) that carries delegation information. This information includes the delegation type, delegate and target restrictions, and any application-defined optional and required restrictions. The new login context created by this call can then used to to set up authenticated rpc with an intermediate or target server using the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() call. Any delegate, target, required, or optional restrictions specified in this call are added to the restrictions specified by the initiating client and any intermediate clients. The sec_login_become_delegate() call is run only if the initiating client enabled traced delegation by setting the delegation_type_permitted parameter in the sec_login_become_initiator call to sec_id_deleg_type_traced. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_context sec_login_s_compound_delegate sec_login_s_invalid_deleg_type err_sec_login_invalid_delegate_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_target_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_opt_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_req_restriction sec_login_s_invalid_compat_mode sec_login_s_deleg_not_enabled error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: intro sec_login_become_initiator sec_login_become_impersonator rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller sec_login_get_current_context sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity
4.62 – sec_login_become_impersonator
NAME sec_login_become_impersonator - Causes an intermediate server to become a delegate in a simple delegation chain SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_login_handle_t sec_login_become_impersonator( rpc_authz_cred_handle_t callers_identity, sec_id_delegation_type_t delegation_type_permitted, sec_id_restriction_set_t *delegate_restrictions, sec_id_restriction_set_t *target_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *optional_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *required_restrictions, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input callers_identity A handle of type rpc_authz_cred_handle_t to the authenticated identity of the previous delegate in the delegation chain. The handle is supplied by the rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller() call. delegation_type_permitted A value of sec_id_delegation_type_t that specifies the type of delegation to be enabled. The types available are: sec_id_deleg_type_none No delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_traced Traced delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation Simple (impersonation) delegation. The initiating client sets the type of delegation. If it is set as traced, all delegates must also specify traced delegation; they cannot specify simple delegation. The same is true if the initiating client sets the delegation type as simple; all subsequent delegates must also specify simple delegation. The intermediate delegates can, however, specify no delegation to indicate that the delegation chain can proceed no further. delegate_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as delegates for the client becoming the delegate. These servers are added to the delegates permitted by the delegate_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. target_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as targets for the client becoming the delegate. These servers are added to targets specified by the target_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. optional_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined optional restrictions that apply to the client becoming the delegate. These restrictions are added to the restrictions identified by the optional_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. required_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined required restrictions that apply to the client becoming the delegate. These restrictions are added to the restrictions identified required_restrictions parameter of the sec_login_become_initiator call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_become_impersonator() is used by intermediate servers to become a delegate for the client identified by callers_identity. The routine returns a new login context (of type sec_login_handle_t) that carries delegation information. This information includes the delegation type, delegate, and target restrictions, and any application-defined optional and required restrictions. The new login context created by this call can then used to to set up authenticated rpc with an intermediate or target server using the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() call. The effective optional and required restrictions are the union of the optional and required restrictions specified in this call and specified by the initiating client and any intermediate clients. The effective target and delegate restrictions are the intersection of the target and delegate restrictions specified in this call and specified by the initiating client and any intermediate clients. The sec_login_become_impersonator call is call is run only if the initiating client enabled simple delegation by setting the delegation_type_permitted parameter in the sec_login_become_initiator call to sec_id_deleg_type_simple. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_deleg_type err_sec_login_invalid_delegate_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_target_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_opt_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_req_restriction sec_login_s_invalid_compat_mode sec_login_s_deleg_not_enabled error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_become_initiator rpc_binding_inq_auth_caller
4.63 – sec_login_become_initiator
NAME sec_login_become_initiator - Constructs a new login context that enables delegation for the calling client SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_login_handle_t sec_login_become_initiator( sec_login_handle_t my_login_context, sec_id_delegation_type_t delegation_type_permitted, sec_id_restriction_set_t *delegate_restrictions, sec_id_restriction_set_t *target_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *optional_restrictions, sec_id_opt_req_t *required_restrictions, sec_id_compatibility_mode_t compatibility_mode, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input my_login_context A value of sec_login_handle_t that provides an opaque handle to the identity of the client that is enabling delegation. The sec_login_handle_t that specifies the client's identity is supplied as output of the following calls: + sec_login_get_current_context() if the client inherited the identity of the current context + The sec_login_setup_identity() and the sec_login_validate_identity() pair that together establish an authentiated identity if a new identity was established delegation_type_permitted A value of sec_id_delegation_type_t that specifies the type of delegation to be enabled. The types available are: sec_id_deleg_type_none No delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_traced Traced delegation. sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation Simple (impersonation) delegation. Note each subsequent intermediate delegate of the delegation chain started by the initiating client must set the delegation type to traced if the initiating client set it to traced or to simple if the initiating client set it to simple. Intermediate delegates, however, can set the delegation type to no delegation to indicate that the delegation chain can proceed no further. delegate_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as delegates for the client initiating delegation. target_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_restriction_set_t that supplies a list of servers that can act as targets for the client initiating delegation. optional_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined optional restrictions that apply to the client initiating delegation. required_restrictions A pointer to a sec_id_opt_req_t that supplies a list of application-defined required restrictions that apply to the client initiating delegation. compatibility_mode A value of sec_id_compatibility_mode_t that specifies the compatibility mode to be used when the initiating client interacts with pre-1.1 servers. The modes available are: sec_id_compat_mode_none Compatibility mode is off. sec_id_compat_mode_initiator Compatibility mode is on. The pre-1.1 PAC data is extracted from the EPAC of the initiating client. sec_id_compat_mode_caller Compatibility mode is on. The pre-1.1 PAC data extracted from the EPAC of the last client in the delegation chain. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_become_initiator() enables delegation for the calling client by constructing a new login context (in a sec_login_handle_t) that carries delegation information. This information includes the delegation type, delegate, and target restrictions, and any application-defined optional and required restrictions. The new login context is then used to to set up authenticated rpc with an intermediate server using the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() call. The intermediary can continue the delegation chain by calling sec_login_become_delegate (if the delegation type is sec_id_deleg_type_traced) or sec_login_become_impersonator (if the delegation type is sec_id_deleg_type_impersonation). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_context sec_login_s_invalid_deleg_type err_sec_login_invalid_delegate_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_target_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_opt_restriction err_sec_login_invalid_req_restriction sec_login_s_invalid_compat_mode error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_become_delegate sec_login_become_impersonator sec_login_get_current_context sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity
4.64 – sec_login_certify_identity
NAME sec_login_certify_identity - Certifies the network authentication service SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_certify_identity( sec_login_handle_t login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_certify_identity() routine certifies that the Security Server used to set up and validate a login context is legitimate. A legitimate server is one that knows the host machine's secret key. On some systems, this may be a privileged operation. Information may be retrieved via sec_login_get_pwent(), sec_login_get_groups(), and sec_login_get_expiration() from an uncertified login context, but such information cannot be trusted. All system login programs that use the sec_login interface must call sec_login_certify_identity() to certify the Security Server. If they do not, they open the local file system to attacks by imposter Security servers returning suspect local process credentials (UUID and group IDs). This operation updates the local registry with the login context credentials if the certification check succeeds. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. RETURN VALUES The routine returns a boolean32 value that is TRUE if the certification was successful, and FALSE otherwise. ERRORS sec_login_s_config The DCE configuration (dce_config) information is not available. sec_login_s_context_invalid The input context is invalid. sec_login_s_default_use It is an error to try to certify the default context. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES Applications wishing to perform a straightforward login could use the sec_login package as follows: if (sec_login_setup_identity(user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st)) { ... get password from user... if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { if (!sec_login_certify_identity(login_context, &st)) exit(error_weird_auth_svc); sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); if (reset_passwd) { ... get new password from user, reset registry record ... }; sec_login_get_pwent(login_context, &pw_entry, &st); if (pw_entry.pw_expire < todays_date) { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); exit(0) } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro, sec_login_get_pwent sec_login_get_groups sec_login_get_expiration
4.65 – sec_login_cred_get_delegate
NAME sec_login_cred_get_delegate - Returns a handle to the privilege attributes of an intermediary in a delegation chain Used by clients. SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_cred_pa_handle_t sec_login_cred_get_delegate( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_cred_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context A value of sec_login_handle_t that provides an opaque handle to a login context for which delegation has been enabled. The sec_login_handle_t that specifies the identity is supplied as output of the sec_login_become_delegate() call. Input/Output cursor As input, a pointer to a cursor of type sec_cred_cursor_t that has been initialized by the sec_login_cred_init_cursor() call. As an output parameter, cursor is a pointer to a cursor of type sec_cred_cursor_t that is positioned past the principal whose privilege attributes have been returned in this call. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_cred_get_delegate() routine returns a handle of type sec_login_handle_t to the the privilege attributes of an intermediary in a delegation chain that performed an authenticated RPC operation. This call is used by clients. Servers use the sec_cred_get_delegate() routine to return the privilege attribute handle of an intermediary in a delegation chain. The login context identified by login_context contains all members in the delegation chain. This call returns a handle (sec_cred_pa_handle_t) to the privilege attributes of one of the delegates in the login context. The sec_cred_pa_handle_t returned by this call is used in other sec_cred_get... calls to obtain privilege attribute information for a single delegate. To obtain the privilege attributes of each delegate in the credential handle identified by callers_identity, execute this call until the message sec_cred_s_no_more_entries is returned. Before you execute sec_login_cred_get_delegate(), you must execute a sec_login_cred_init_cursor() call to initialize a cursor of type sec_cred_cursor_t. Use the sec_cred_free_pa_handle() sec_cred_free_cursor() calls to free the resources allocated to the sec_cred_pa_handle_t and cursor. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_cursor sec_cred_s_no_more_entries error_status_ok EXAMPLES RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_cred_init_cursor sec_cred_get_pa_date sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_get_v1_pac sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions sec_cred_get_req_restrictions sec_cred_get_delegation_type
4.66 – sec_login_cred_get_initiator
NAME sec_login_cred_get_initiator - Returns information about the delegation initiator in a specified login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_cred_pa_handle_t sec_login_cred_get_initiator( sec_login_handle_t login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context A value of sec_login_handle_t that provides an opaque handle to a login context for which delegation has been enabled. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_cred_get_initiator() routine returns a handle of type sec_cred_pa_handle_t to the privilege attributes of the delegation initiator. The login context identified by login_context contains all members in the delegation chain. This call returns a handle (sec_cred_pa_handle_t) to the privilege attributes of the initiator. The sec_cred_pa_handle_t returned by this call is used in other sec_cred_get... calls to obtain privilege attribute information for the initiator single delegate. Use the sec_cred_free_pa_handle() call to free the resources allocated to the sec_cred_pa_handle_t handle. FILES SYS$LIBRARY:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_context error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_cred_get_pa_date sec_cred_get_extended_attrs sec_cred_get_v1_pac sec_cred_get_tgt_restrictions sec_cred_get_deleg_restrictions sec_cred_get_opt_restrictions sec_cred_get_req_restrictions sec_cred_get_delegation_type
4.67 – sec_login_cred_init_cursor
NAME sec_login_cred_init_cursor - Initialize a sec_cred_cursor_t SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_cred.h> void sec_login_cred_init_cursor ( sec_cred_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor As input, a pointer to a sec_cred_cursor_t to be initialized. As output, a pointer to an initialized sec_cred_cursor_t. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_cred_init_cursor() routine allocates and initializes a cursor of type sec_cursor_t for use with the sec_login_cred_get_delegate() call. Use the sec_cred_free_cursor() call to free the resources allocated to cursor. ERRORS sec_cred_s_invalid_cursor sec_login_s_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_cred_get_delegate
4.68 – sec_login_disable_delegation
NAME sec_login_disable_delegation - Disables delegation for a specified login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_logon_handle_t *sec_login_disable_delegation( sec_login_handle_t login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context for which delegation has been enabled. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_disable_delegation() routine disables delegation for a specified login context. It returns a new login context of type sec_login_handle_t without any delegation information, thus preventing any further delegation. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_context error_status_ok EXAMPLES RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_become_initiator sec_login_become_delegate sec_login_become_impersonator
4.69 – sec_login_export_context
NAME sec_login_export_context - Creates an exportable login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_export_context( sec_login_handle_t login_context, unsigned32 buf_len, idl_byte buf[], unsigned32 *len_used, unsigned32 *len_needed, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) buf_len An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length (in bytes) of the buffer that is to contain the login context. Output buf[] An idl_byte array that contains the exportable login context upon return. len_used A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer indicating the number of bytes needed for the entire login context, up to buf_len. len_needed If the allocated length of the buffer is too short, an error is issued (sec_login_s_no_memory), and on return this pointer indicates the number of bytes necessary to contain the login context. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_export_context() routine obtains an exportable version of the login context information. This information may be passed to another process running on the same machine. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_memory Not enough space was allocated for the buf[] array. The len_needed parameter will point to the needed length. sec_login_s_handle_invalid The login context handle is invalid. sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context specified by the input handle is invalid. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_import_context
4.70 – sec_login_free_net_info
NAME sec_login_free_net_info - Frees storage allocated for a principal's network information SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_free_net_info( sec_login_net_info_t *net_info); PARAMETERS Input/Output net_info A pointer to the sec_login_net_info_t structure to be freed. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_free_net_info() routine frees any memory allocated for a principal's network information. Network information is returned by a previous successful call to sec_login_inquire_net_info(). CAUTIONS This routine does not return any completion codes. Make sure that you supply a valid sec_login_net_info_t address. The routine simply frees a range of storage beginning at the supplied address, without regard to the actual contents of the storage. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_inquire_net_info
4.71 – sec_login_get_current_context
NAME sec_login_get_current_context - Returns a handle to the current login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_get_current_context( sec_login_handle_t *login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Output login_context A pointer to an opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_get_current_context() routine retrieves a handle to the login context for the currently established network identity. The context returned is created from locally cached data so subsequent data extraction operations may return some NULL values. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context There was no current context to retrieve. (See sec_login_setup_identity for information about how to set up, validate, and implement a login context.) error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_get_current_context() routine as part of a process to change the groupset: sec_login_get_current_context(&login_context, &st); sec_login_get_groups(login_context, &num_groups, &groups, &st); ...the group IDs have to be converted from the returned UNIX numbers into UUIDs (use sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id)... for (i=0; i < num_groups; i++) { ... query whether the user wants to discard any of the current group memberships. Copy new groupset to the new_groups array ... } if ( !sec_login_newgroups(sec_login_no_flags, num_new_groups, new_groups, &login_context, &st)) { if (st == sec_login_s_groupset_invalid) printf("New groupset invalid0); ... application specific error handling ... } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_setup_identity
4.72 – sec_login_get_expiration
NAME sec_login_get_expiration - Returns the TGT lifetime for an authenticated identity SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_get_expiration( sec_login_handle_t login_context, signed32 *identity_expiration, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output identity_expiration The lifetime of the Ticket-Granting Ticket (TGT) belonging to the authenticated identity identified by login_context. It can be used in the same ways as a UNIX time_t. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns one of the following status codes: + error_status_ok to indicate that the login context has been validated and certified. + sec_login_s_not_certified to indicate that the login context has been validated, but not certified. Although this code indicates successful completion, it warns you that the context is not validated. If the call does not complete successfully, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_get_expiration() routine extracts the lifetime for the TGT belonging to the authenticated identity contained in the login context. The liftime value is filled in if available; otherwise, it is set to 0 (zero). This routine allows an application to tell an interactive user how long the user's network login (and authenticated identity) will last before having to be refreshed. The routine works only on previously certified contexts. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is invalid. sec_login_s_default_use There was illegal use of the default login handle. sec_login_s_not_certified The login context has not been certified. sec_login_s_no_current_context The calling process has no context of its own. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES Since the authenticated network identity for a process has a finite lifetime, there is a risk it will expire during some long network operation, preventing the operation from completing. To avoid this situation, an application might, before initiating a long operation, use the sec_login package to check the expiration time of its identity and refresh it if there is not enough time remaining to complete the operation. After refreshing the identity, the process must validate it again with sec_login_validate_identity(). sec_login_get_expiration(login_context, &expire_time, &st); if (expire_time < (current_time + operation_duration)) { if (!sec_login_refresh_identity(login_context, &st)) { if (st == sec_login_s_refresh_ident_bad) { ... identity has changed ... } else { ... login context cannot be renewed ... exit(error_context_not_renewable); } if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { ... identity validated ... } else { ... validation failed ... exit(error_validation_failure); } } } operation(); RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_get_current_context
4.73 – sec_login_get_groups
NAME sec_login_get_groups - Returns the groupset from a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_get_groups( sec_login_handle_t login_context, unsigned32 *num_groups, signed32 **group_set, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output num_groups An unsigned 32-bit integer indicating the total number of groups returned in the group_set array. group_set The list of groups to which the user belongs. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns one of the following status codes: + error_status_ok to indicate that the login context has been validated and certified. + sec_login_s_not_certified to indicate that the login context has been validated, but not certified. Although this code indicates successful completion, it warns you that the context is not validated. If the call does not complete successfully, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_get_groups() routine returns the groups contained in the supplied login context. Part of a network identity is a list of the various groups to which the principal belongs. The groups are used to determine a user's access to various objects and services. This routine extracts from the login context a list of the groups for which the user has established network privileges. The routine works only on previously validated contexts. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is not valid. sec_login_s_info_not_avail The login context has no UNIX information. sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_not_certified The login context has not been certified. sec_login_s_not_certified The login context is not certified. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified login context data. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_get_groups() routine as part of a process to change the groupset: sec_login_get_current_context(&login_context, &st); sec_login_get_groups(login_context, &num_groups, &groups, &st); ...the group IDs have to be converted from the returned UNIX numbers into UUIDs (use sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id)... for (i=0; i < num_groups; i++) { ... query whether the user wants to discard any of the current group memberships. Copy new groupset to the new_groups array ... } if ( !sec_login_newgroups(sec_login_no_flags, num_new_groups, new_groups, &login_context, &st)) { if (st == sec_login_s_groupset_invalid) printf("New groupset invalid0); ... application specific error handling ... } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist
4.74 – sec_login_get_pwent
NAME sec_login_get_pwent - Returns a passwd-style entry for a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_get_pwent( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_login_passwd_t *pwent, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output pwent A pointer to a pointer to the returned passwd-style structure. The particular structure depends on the underlying system. For example, on a system with a passwd structure like that supported by 4.4BSD and OSF/1, the structure (found in /usr/include/pwd.h) is: struct passwd { char *pw_name; /* user name */ char *pw_passwd; /* encrypted password */ int pw_uid; /* user uid */ int pw_gid; /* user gid */ time_t pw_change; /* password change time */ char *pw_class; /* user access class */ char *pw_gecos; /* miscellaneous account info */ char *pw_dir; /* home directory */ char *pw_shell; /* default shell */ time_t pw_expire; /* account expiration */ }; status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns one of the following status codes: + error_status_ok to indicate that the login context has been validated and certified. + sec_login_s_not_certified to indicate that the login context has been validated, but not certified. Although this code indicates successful completion, it warns you that the context is not validated. If the call does not complete successfully, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_get_pwent() routine creates a passwd-style structure for the current network login context. This is generally useful for establishing the local operating system context. Applications that require all of the data normally extracted via getpwnam() should extract that data from the login context with this call. This routine works only on explicitly created (not inherited or imported) contexts. CAUTIONS The returned sec_login_passwd_t structure points to data stored in the structure indicated by the login_context pointer and must be treated as read-only data. Writing to these data objects may cause unexpected failures. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_get_pwent() routine: #include <pwd.h> struct passwd *pwd; sec_login_get_pwent( login_context, &(sec_login_passwd_t*)pwd,&status ); printf ("%s",pwd->pw_name); ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is invalid. sec_login_s_not_certified The login context has not been certified. sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_info_not_avail The login context has no UNIX information. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified login context data. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.75 – sec_login_import_context
NAME sec_login_import_context - Imports a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_import_context( unsigned32 buf_len, idl_byte buf[], sec_login_handle_t *login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input buf_len The allocated length (in bytes) of the buffer containing the login context. buf[] An idl_byte array containing the importable login context. Output login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_import_context() routine imports a context obtained via a call to sec_login_export_context() performed on the same machine. To import a login context, users must have the appropriate privileges. Nonprivileged users can import only their own login context; privileged users can import the login contexts created by any users. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is not valid. sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_export_context
4.76 – sec_login_init_first
NAME sec_login_init_first - Initializes the default context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_init_first( error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_init_first() routine initializes the default context inheritance mechanism. If the default inheritance mechanism is already initialized, the operation fails. Typically, this routine is called by the initial process at machine boot time to initialize the default context inheritance mechanism for the host machine process hierarchy. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_default_use The default context is already initialized. sec_login_s_privileged An unprivileged process was called in. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_setup_first sec_login_validate_first
4.77 – sec_login_inquire_net_info
NAME sec_login_inquire_net_info - Returns a principal's network information SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_inquire_net_info( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_login_net_info_t *net_info, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to the login context for the desired principal. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output net_info A pointer to the returned sec_login_net_info_t data structure that contains the principal's network information. The sec_login_net_info_t structure is defined as follows: typedef struct { sec_id_pac_t pac; unsigned32 acct_expiration_date; unsigned32 passwd_expiration_date; unsigned32 identity_expiration_date; } sec_login_net_info_t; }; status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns one of the following status codes: + error_status_ok to indicate that the principal's network information returned in the sec_login_net_info_t data structure has been validated and certified. + sec_login_s_not_certified to indicate that the principal's network information returned in the sec_login_net_info_t data structure has been validated, but not certified. Although this code indicates successful completion, it warns you that the information is not validated. If the call does not complete successfully, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_inquire_net_info() routine returns network information for the principal identified by the specified login context. The network information consists of the following: + The Privilege Attribute Certificate (PAC) that describes the identity and group memberships of the principal. + The expiration date for the principal's account in the DCE Registry. + The expiration date for the principal's password in the DCE Registry. + The lifetime for the principal's authenticated network identity. This is the lifetime of the principal's TGT (see the sec_login_get_expiration() routine). A value of 0 (zero) for an expiration date means there is no expiration date. In other words, the principal's account, password, or authenticated identity is good indefinitely. To remove the returned net_info structure when it is no longer needed, use sec_login_free_net_info(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_not_certified The login context is not certified. sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context is not valid. sec_login_s_no_current_context The default context was specified, but none exists. sec_login_s_auth_local Operation not valid on local context. The call's identity was not authenticated. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_get_expiration sec_login_free_net_info
4.78 – sec_login_newgroups
NAME sec_login_newgroups - Changes the group list for a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_newgroups( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_login_flags_t flags, unsigned32 num_local_groups, sec_id_t local_groups[], sec_login_handle_t *restricted_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) flags A set of flags of type sec_login_flags_t. These contain information about how the new network credentials will be used. Currently, the only flag used is sec_login_credentials_private, that, when set, implies that the new context is only to be used by the calling process. If this flag is not set (flags = sec_login_no_flags), descendants of the calling process may also use the new network credentials. num_local_groups An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of local group identities to include in the new context. local_groups[] An array of sec_id_t elements. Each element contains the UUID of a local group identity to include in the new context. These identities are local to the cell. Optionally, each element may also contain a pointer to a character string containing the name of the local group. Output restricted_context An opaque handle to the login context containing the changed group list. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_newgroups() routine changes the group list for the specified login context. Part of a network identity is a list of the various groups to which a principal belongs. The groups are used to determine a user's access to various objects and services. This routine returns a new login context that contains the changed group list. To remove the new login context when it is no longer needed, use sec_login_purge_context(). This operation does not need to be validated as the user identity does not change. Consequently, knowledge of the password is not needed. NOTES urrently you can have only groups from the local cell. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. RETURN VALUES This routine returns TRUE when the new login context is successfully established. ERRORS sec_login_s_auth_local Operation not valid on local context. sec_login_s_default_use It is an error to try to certify the default context. sec_login_s_groupset_invalid The input list of group names is invalid. There may be groups to which the caller does not belong, or the list may contain groups that do not exist. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_newgroups() routine as part of a process to change the groupset: sec_login_get_current_context(&login_context, &st); sec_login_get_groups(login_context, &num_groups, &groups, &st); ...the group IDs have to be converted from the returned UNIX numbers into UUIDs (use sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id)... for (i=0; i < num_groups; i++) { ... query whether the user wants to discard any of the current group memberships. Copy new groupset to the new_groups array ... } if ( !sec_login_newgroups(sec_login_no_flags, num_new_groups, new_groups, &login_context, &st)) { if (st == sec_login_s_groupset_invalid) printf("New groupset invalid0); ... application specific error handling ... } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_get_groups sec_login_purge_context
4.79 – sec_login_purge_context
NAME sec_login_purge_context - Destroys a login context and frees its storage SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_purge_context( sec_login_handle_t *login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context A pointer to an opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Note that a pointer to the handle is submitted, so the handle may be reset to NULL upon successful completion. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_purge_context() routine frees any storage allocated for the specified login context and destroys the associated network credentials, if any exist. CAUTIONS Applications must be cautious when purging the current context as this destroys network credentials for all processes that share the credentials. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is not valid. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_purge_context() routine as part of a straightforward login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity( user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st)) { ... get password from user... if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { if (!sec_login_certify_identity(login_context, &st)) exit(error_wierd_auth_svc); sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); if (reset_passwd) { ... get new password from user, reset registry record ... }; sec_login_get_pwent(login_context, &pw_entry, &st); if (pw_entry.pw_expire < todays_date) { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); exit(0) } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_set_context sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity
4.80 – sec_login_refresh_identity
NAME sec_login_refresh_identity - Refreshes an authenticated identity for a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_refresh_identity( sec_login_handle_t login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_refresh_identity() routine refreshes a previously established identity. It operates on an existing valid context, and cannot be used to change credentials associated with that identity. The refreshed identity reflects changes that affect ticket lifetimes, but not other changes. For example, the identity will reflect a change to maximum ticket lifetime, but not the addition of the identity as a member to a group. Only a DCE login reflects all administrative changes made since the last login. The refreshed identity must be validated with sec_login_validate_identity() before it can be used. It is an error to refresh a locally authenticated context. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is not valid. sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_no_memory Not enough memory is available to complete the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES Since the authenticated network identity for a process has a finite lifetime, there is a risk it will expire during some long network operation, preventing the operation from completing. For a server application that must run with an authenticated network identity because they themselves sometimes act as clients of another server, the sec_login calls can be used to check the network identity expiration date, run sec_login_refresh_identity and sec_login_validate_identity before the expiration. This will prevent interruptions in the server's operation due to the restrictions in network access applied to an unauthenticated identity. sec_login_get_expiration(login_context, &expire_time, &st); if (expire_time < (current_time + operation_duration)) { if (!sec_login_refresh_identity(login_context, &st)) { ... login context cannot be renewed ... ... sleep and try again .... } } else { if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { ... identity validated ... } else { ... validation failed ... exit(error_validation_failure); } } } operation(); RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_validate_identity
4.81 – sec_login_release_context
NAME sec_login_release_context - Frees storage allocated for a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_release_context( sec_login_handle_t *login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output login_context A pointer to an opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_release_context() routine frees any memory allocated for a login context. Unlike sec_login_purge_context(), it does not destroy the associated network credentials that still reside in the credential cache. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is invalid. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_purge_context
4.82 – sec_login_set_context
NAME sec_login_set_context - Creates network credentials for a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> void sec_login_set_context( sec_login_handle_t login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_set_context() routine sets the network credentials to those specified by the login context. This context must have been previously validated. Contexts acquired through sec_login_get_current_context() or sec_login_newgroups() do not need to be validated since those routines return previously alidated contexts. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_context_invalid The login context itself is invalid. sec_login_s_default_use Illegal use of the default login handle occurred. sec_login_s_auth_local Operation not valid on local context. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_set_context() routine as part of a straightforward login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity( user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st )) { ... get password from user... if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { if (!sec_login_certify_identity(login_context, &st)) exit(error_weird_auth_svc); sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); if (reset_passwd) { ... get new password from user, reset registry record ... }; sec_login_get_pwent(login_context, &pw_entry, &st); if (pw_entry.pw_expire < todays_date) { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); exit(0) } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity
4.83 – sec_login_set_extended_attrs
NAME sec_login_set_extended_attrs - Constructs a new login context that contains extended registry attributes SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> sec_login_handle_t sec_login_set_extended_attrs( sec_login_handle_t my_login_context, unsigned32 num_attributes, sec_attr_t attributes[] error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input my_login_context A value of sec_login_handle_t that provides an opaque handle to the identity of the calling client. num_attributes An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the attributes[] array. The number must be greater than 0. attributes[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the list of attributes to be set in the new login context. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_set_extended_attrs() constructs a login context that contains extended registry attributes that have been established for the object identified by my_login_context. The attributes themselves must have been established and attached to the object using the Extended Registry Attribute API. The input attributes[] array of sec_attr_t values should specify the attr_id field for each requested attribute. Since the lookup is by attribute type ID only, set the attribute.attr_value.attr_encoding field to sec_attr_enc_void for each attribute. Note that sec_attr_t is an Extended Registry Attribute data type. For more information on Extended Registry Attributes, see the description of the sec_attr calls in this document and the chapter titled "The Extended Registry Attribute API" in the DCE Application Development Guide. You cannot use this call to add extended registry attributes to a delegation chain. If you pass in a login context that refers to a delegation chain, an invalid context error will be returned. The routine returns a new login context of type sec_login_handle_t that includes the attributes specified in the attributes[] array. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_invalid_context error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_... calls sec_login_become_impersonator sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity sec_login_set_context
4.84 – sec_login_setup_first
NAME sec_login_setup_first - Sets up the default network context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_setup_first( sec_login_handle_t *init_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Output init_context A pointer to an opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. In this call, the context will be that of the host machine initial process. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_setup_first() routine sets up the default context network identity. If the default context already contains valid credentials, the routine fails. Typically, this routine is called from the Security Validation Service of the dced process to breathe life into the default credentials for the host machine process hierarchy. This routine uses the hostname available via the local dce_config interface as the principal name for the setup, so it does need a principal name as input. RETURN VALUES The routine returns a boolean32 value that is TRUE if the setup was successful, and FALSE otherwise. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_default_use The default context is already in use and does not need to be set up again. sec_login_s_no_current_context The calling process has no context of its own. sec_login_s_privileged An unprivileged process was called in. sec_login_s_config The DCE configuration (dce_config) information is not available. sec_rgy_object_not_found The principal does not exist. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The network registry is not available. sec_login_s_no_memory A memory allocation error occurred. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_init_first sec_login_validate_first
4.85 – sec_login_setup_identity
NAME sec_login_setup_identity - Sets up the user's network identity SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_setup_identity( unsigned_char_p_t principal, sec_login_flags_t flags, sec_login_handle_t *login_context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input principal A pointer (type unsigned_char_p_t) indicating a character string containing the principal name on the registry account corresponding to the calling process. flags A set of flags of type sec_login_flags_t. These contain information about how the new network credentials are to be used. Output login_context A pointer to an opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_setup_identity() routine creates any local context necessary to perform authenticated network operations. It does not establish any local operating system context; that is the responsibility of the caller. It is the standard network login function. The network identity set up by this operation cannot be used until it is validated via sec_login_validate_identity(). The sec_login_setup_identity() operation and the sec_login_validate_identity() operation are two halves of a single logical operation. Together they collect the identity data needed to establish an authenticated identity. NOTES Neither sec_login_setup_identity() nor sec_login_validate_identity() check for account or identity expiration. The application program using this interface is responsible for such checks. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the identity has been successfully established. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The principal does not exist. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The network registry is not available. sec_login_s_no_memory Not enough memory is available to complete the operation. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_setup_identity() routine as part of a straightforward login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity( user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st )) { ... get password from user... if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { if (!sec_login_certify_identity(login_context, &st)) exit(error_weird_auth_svc); sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); if (reset_passwd) { ... get new password from user, reset registry record ... }; sec_login_get_pwent(login_context, &pw_entry, &st); if (pw_entry.pw_expire < todays_date) { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); exit(0) } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_validate_identity sec_login_set_context
4.86 – sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident
NAME sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident - Validates and certifies a login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_passwd_rec_t *passwd, boolean32 *reset_passwd, sec_login_auth_src_t *auth_src, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) passwd A password record to be checked against the password in the principal's registry account. The routine returns TRUE if the two match. The contents of the passwd parameter are erased after the call has finished processing it. Output reset_passwd A pointer to a 32-bit boolean32 value. The routine returns TRUE if the account password has expired and must be reset. auth_src A 32-bit set of flags identifying the source of the authentication. Upon return after successful authentication, the flags in auth_src indicate what authority was used to validate the login context. If the authentication was accomplished with the network authority, the sec_login_auth_src_network flag is set, and the process login context has credentials to use the network. If the authentication was accomplished with local data only (either the principal's account is tailored for the local machine with overrides, or the network authority is unavailable), the sec_login_auth_src_local flag is set. Login contexts that are authenticated locally may not be used to establish network credentials because they have none. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident() routine validates and certifies a login context established with sec_login_setup_identity(). The caller must supply the user's password as input with the passwd parameter. This routine combines the operations of the sec_login_validate_identity() and sec_login_certify_identity() routines. It is intended for use by system login programs that need to extract trustworthy operating system credentials for use in setting the local identity for a process. This operation destroys the contents of the passwd input parameter. If the network security service is unavailable or if the user's password has been overridden on the host, a locally authenticated context is created, and the auth_src parameter is set to sec_login_auth_src_local. Data extracted from a locally authenticated context may be used to set the local OS identity, but it cannot be used to establish network credentials. This routine is a privileged operation. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the login identity has been successfully validated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_passwd_invalid The input string does not match the account password. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. sec_login_s_acct_invalid The account is invalid or has expired. sec_login_s_privileged This is a privileged operation and was invoked by an unprivileged process. sec_login_s_null_password The input string is NULL. sec_login_s_default_use The input context was the default context, which cannot be validated. sec_login_s_already_valid The login context has already been validated. sec_login_s_unsupp_passwd_type The password type is not supported. sec_login_s_no_memory Not enough memory is available to complete the operation. sec_login_s_preauth_failed Preauthentication failure. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident() routine as part of a system login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity(<user>, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st)) { ... get password ... if (sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident(login_context, password, &st)) { if (auth_src == sec_login_auth_src_network) { if (GOOD_STATUS(&st) sec_login_set_context(login_context); } } if (reset_passwd) { ... reset the user's password ... if (passwd_reset_fails) { sec_login_purge_context(login_context) ... application login failure actions ... } ... application specific login valid actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_certify_identity sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_validate_identity
4.87 – sec_login_valid_from_keytable
NAME sec_login_valid_from_keytable - Validates a login context's identit using input from a specified keytable file SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_valid_from_keytable( sec_login_handle_t login_context, unsigned32 authn_service, void *arg, unsigned32 try_kvno, unsigned32 *used_kvno, boolean32 *reset_passwd, sec_login_auth_src_t *auth_src, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal's name and UUID, account restrictions, records of the account principal's group memberships, and the account's home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) authn_service Identifies the authentication protocol using the key. The possible authentication protocols are as follows: rpc_c_authn_dce_secret DCE shared-secret key authentication. rpc_c_authn_dce_public DCE public key authentication (reserved for future use). arg This parameter can specify either the local keytab file or an argument to the get_key_fn key acquisition routine of the rpc_server_register_auth_info routine. A value of NULL specifies that the default keytab file should be used. A keytab file name specifies that that file should be used as the keytab file. You must prepend the file's absolute filename with FILE: and the file must have been created with the rgy_edit command or the sec_key_mgmt_set_key routine. Any other value specifies an argument for the get_key_fn key acquisition routine. See the rpc_server_register_auth_info() reference page for more information. try_kvno The version number of the key in the keytab file to try first. Specify NULL to try the current version of the key. Output used_kvno A pointer to a 32-bit boolean32 value that specifies the version number of the the key from the keytab file that was used to successfully validate the login context, if any. reset_passwd A pointer to a 32-bit boolean32 value. The routine returns TRUE if the account password has expired and should be reset. auth_src How the the login context was authorized. The sec_login_auth_src_t data type distinguishes the various ways the login context was authorized. There are three possible values: sec_login_auth_src_network Authentication accomplished through the normal network authority. A login context authenticated this way will have all the network credentials it ought to have. sec_login_auth_src_local Authentication accomplished via local data. Authentication occurs locally if a principal's account is tailored for the local machine, or if the network authority is unavailable. Since a login contexts authenticated locally has no network credentials, it can not be used for network operations. sec_login_auth_src_overridden Authentication accomplished via the override facility. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_valid_from_keytable () routine validates the login context established with sec_login_setup_identity(). The sec_login_valid_from_keytable () routine obtains the principal's password from the specified keytable. If try_kvno specifies a key version number, that version number key is tried first, otherwise the current key version number is tried first. The function trys all keys in the keytable until it finds one that validates the login context. This operation must be invoked before the network credentials can be used. NOTES A context is not secure and must not be set or exported until the authentication service is itself authenticated with the sec_login_certify_identity() call. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the login context has been successfully validated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_passwd_invalid The input string does not match the account password. sec_rgy_server_unavailable There is no data with which to compare the input string. sec_login_s_acct_invalid The account is invalid or has expired. sec_login_s_default_use The input context was the default context, which cannot be validated. sec_login_s_already_valid The login context has already been validated. sec_login_s_unsupp_passwd_type The password type is not supported. sec_key_mgmt_e_key_unavailable The requested key is not present. sec_key_mgmt_e_authn_invalid The authentication protocol is not valid. sec_key_mgmt_e_unauthorized The caller is not authorized to perform the operation. sec_s_no_memory Unable to allocate memory. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_valid_from_keytable() routine as part of a straightforward login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity( user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st )) { ... get password from local keytable... if (sec_login_valid_from_keytable( login_context, authn_service, arg, try_kvno, &used_kvno, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st )) { sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_validate_identity sec_login_certify_identity sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident
4.88 – sec_login_validate_first
NAME sec_login_validate_first - Validates the initial login context SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_validate_first( sec_login_handle_t init_context, boolean32 *reset_passwd, sec_login_auth_src_t *auth_src, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input init_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. In this call, the context will be that of the host machine initial process. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) Output reset_passwd A pointer to a 32-bit boolean32 value. The routine returns TRUE if the account password has expired and must be reset. auth_src A 32-bit set of flags identifying the source of the authentication. Upon return after successful authentication, the flags in auth_src indicate what authority was used to validate the login context. If the authentication was accomplished with the network authority, the sec_login_auth_src_network flag is set, and the process login context has credentials to use the network. If the authentication was accomplished with local data only (either the principal's account is tailored for the local machine with overrides, or the network authority is unavailable), the sec_login_auth_src_local flag is set. Login contexts that are authenticated locally may not be used to establish network credentials because they have none. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_validate_first() routine validates the default login context established via sec_login_setup_first(). Typically, this operation is called from the Security Validation Service of the dced process to validate the default credentials for the host machine process hierarchy. This operation uses the password for the local host, and therefore does not require a password parameter. RETURN VALUES The routine returns a boolean32 value that is TRUE if the setup was successful, and FALSE otherwise. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_privileged An unprivileged process was called in. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The network authentication service was unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_init_first sec_login_setup_first
4.89 – sec_login_validate_identity
NAME sec_login_validate_identity - Validates a login context's identity SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_login.h> boolean32 sec_login_validate_identity( sec_login_handle_t login_context, sec_passwd_rec_t *passwd, boolean32 *reset_passwd, sec_login_auth_src_t *auth_src, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input login_context An opaque handle to login context data. The login context contains, among other data, the account principal name and UUID, account restrictions, records of group membership, and the process home directory. (See sec_intro for more details about the login context.) passwd A password record to be checked against the password in the principal's registry account. The routine returns TRUE if the two match. The contents of the passwd parameter are erased after the call has finished processing it. Output reset_passwd A pointer to a 32-bit boolean32 value. The routine returns TRUE if the account password has expired and must be reset. auth_src How the the login context was authorized. The sec_login_auth_src_t data type distinguishes the various ways the login context was authorized. There are three possible values: sec_login_auth_src_network sec_login_auth_src_local sec_login_auth_src_overridden status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_login_validate_identity() routine validates the login context established with sec_login_setup_identity(). This operation must be invoked before the network credentials can be used. The caller must supply the user's password in a sec_passwd_rec_t as input with the passwd parameter. The following example sets up a plaintext password for the passwd parameter: sec_passwd_str_t tmp_passwd; passwd.version_number = sec_passwd_c_version_none; passwd.pepper = NULL; passwd.key.key_type = sec_passwd_plain; strncpy( (char *) tmp_passwd, (char *) my_passwd, sec_passwd_str_max_len ); tmp_passwd[sec_passwd_str_max_len] = ' '; passwd_rec.key.tagged_union.plain = &(tmp_passwd[0]); When a network identity is set, only state information for network operations has been established. The local operating system identity has not been modified. It is the responsibility of the caller to establish any local operating identity state. The sec_login_setup_identity() operation and the sec_login_validate_identity() operation are two halves of a single logical operation. Together they collect the identity data needed to establish an authenticated identity. The operations are independent so the user's password need not be sent across the network. The identity validation performed by sec_login_validate_identity() is a local operation. NOTES A context is not secure and must not be set or exported until the authentication service is itself authenticated with the sec_login_certify_identity() call. System login programs that set local operating system identity using data extracted from a login context should use sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident() instead of sec_login_validate_identity(). If the Security server and client clocks are not synchronized to within 2 to 3 minutes of each other, this call can return a password validation error. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the login identity has been successfully validated. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_LOGIN.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_login.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_passwd_invalid The input string does not match the account password. sec_rgy_server_unavailable There is no data with which to compare the input string. sec_login_s_acct_invalid The account is invalid or has expired. sec_login_s_null_password The input string is NULL. sec_login_s_default_use The input context was the default context, which cannot be validated. sec_login_s_already_valid The login context has already been validated. sec_login_s_unsupp_passwd_type The password type is not supported. sec_login_s_no_memory Not enough memory is available to complete the operation. sec_login_s_preauth_failed Preauthentication failure. error_status_ok The call was successful. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the sec_login_validate_identity() routine as part of a straightforward login process: if (sec_login_setup_identity( user_name, sec_login_no_flags, &login_context, &st )) { ... get password from user... if (sec_login_validate_identity(login_context, password, &reset_passwd, &auth_src, &st)) { if (!sec_login_certify_identity(login_context, &st)) exit(error_weird_auth_svc); sec_login_set_context(login_context, &st); if (auth_src != sec_login_auth_src_network) printf("no network credentials"); if (reset_passwd) { ... get new password from user, reset registry record ... }; sec_login_get_pwent(login_context, &pw_entry, &st); if (pw_entry.pw_expire < todays_date) { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); exit(0) } ... any other application specific login valid actions ... } } else { sec_login_purge_context(&login_context, &st); ... application specific login failure actions ... } } RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_login_certify_identity sec_login_setup_identity sec_login_valid_and_cert_ident
4.90 – sec_pwd_mgmt_free_handle
NAME sec_pwd_mgmt_free_handle - Frees storage allocated for a password management handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h> void sec_pwd_mgmt_free_handle( sec_pwd_mgmt_handle_t *pwd_mgmt_h, error_status_t *stp ) PARAMETERS Input/Output pwd_mgmt_h A handle to the password management data which is to be freed. Output stp A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_pwd_mgmt_free_handle() routine frees any memory allocated for the contents of a password management handle. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_PWD_MGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_pwd_mgmt_setup
4.91 – sec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd
NAME sec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd - Generate a set of passwords SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h> void sec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd( sec_pwd_mgmt_handle_t pwd_mgmt_h, unsigned32 num_pwds, unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_passwd_rec_t gen_pwds[], error_status_t *stp ) PARAMETERS Input pwd_mgmt_h A handle to user's password management data. num_pwds Number of generated passwords requested. Output num_returned Number of generated passwords returned in the gen_pwds[] array. gen_pwds Array of generated passwords. Each generated password is stored in a sec_passwd_rec_t structure. stp A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd() routine retrieves a set of generated passwords from a password management server which is exporting the rsec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd() routine. It obtains the binding information to this server from the pwd_mgmt_h handle. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_PWD_MGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_era_pwd_mgmt_auth_type The pwd_mgmt_binding ERA must contain authentication information. sec_pwd_mgmt_svr_unavail The password management server is unavailable sec_pwd_mgmt_svr_error Generic error returned from password management server. An administrator should check the password management server's log file for more information. error_status_ok The call was successful Various RPC communication errors can be returned if there are failures when binding to the password management server. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_pwd_mgmt_setup pwd_strengthd
4.92 – sec_pwd_mgmt_get_val_type
NAME sec_pwd_mgmt_get_val_type - Gets users password validation type SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h> void sec_pwd_mgmt_get_val_type( sec_pwd_mgmt_handle_t pwd_mgmt_h, signed32 *pwd_val_type, error_status_t *stp ) PARAMETERS Input pwd_mgmt_h A handle to a user's password management data. Output pwd_val_type The user's password validation type. This is retrieved from the pwd_val_type ERA. The possible values and their meaning are: (none): the user has no password policy. (user_select): the user must choose his/her own password. (user_can_select): the user can choose his/her own password or request a generated password. (generation_required): the user must use a generated password. stp A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, stp is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_pwd_mgmt_get_val_type() routine returns the value of the user's password validation type, as specified by the pwd_val_type ERA. If the ERA does not exist, 0 (none) is returned in pwd_val_type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_PWD_MGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful Various RPC communication errors can be returned if there are failures when binding to the password management server. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_pwd_mgmt_setup
4.93 – sec_pwd_mgmt_setup
NAME sec_pwd_mgmt_setup - Sets up the user's password policy information SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h> void sec_pwd_mgmt_setup( sec_pwd_mgmt_handle_t *pwd_mgmt_h, sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t login_name, sec_login_handle_t your_lc, rpc_binding_handle_t pwd_mgmt_bind_h, error_status_t *stp ) PARAMETERS Input context A registry server handle indicating the desired registry site. login_name The login name of the user. your_lc The login context handle of the user currently logged in. If null is specified, the default login context will be used. pwd_mgmt_bind_h An RPC binding handle to the password management server. Use of this parameter is currently unsupported. The password management server binding handle will be retrieved from the pwd_mgmt_binding ERA. Set this parameter to NULL. Output pwd_mgmt_h A pointer to an opaque handle to password management/policy data. pwd_mgmt_h contains, among other data, the account name, values of password management ERAs, and a binding handle to the password management server. stp A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, stp is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_pwd_mgmt_setup() routine collects the data required to perform remote password management calls to the password management server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_PWD_MGMT.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_pwd_mgmt.h was derived. ERRORS sec_s_no_memory Not enough memory is available to complete the operation. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The network registry is not available. error_status_ok The call was successful RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_pwd_mgmt_free_handle sec_pwd_mgmt_gen_pwd sec_pwd_mgmt_get_val_type pwd_strengthd
4.94 – sec_rgy_acct_add
NAME sec_rgy_acct_add - Adds an account for a login name SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_add( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, sec_passwd_rec_t *caller_key, sec_passwd_rec_t *new_key, sec_passwd_type_t new_keytype, sec_passwd_version_t *new_key_version, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. All three names must be completely specified. key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. user_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure containing the user part of the account data. This represents such information as the account password, home directory, and default shell. admin_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure containing the administrative part of an account's data. This information includes the account creation and expiration dates and flags describing limits to the use of privilege attribute certificates, among other information. caller_key A key to use to encrypt new_key for transmission to the registry server. new_key The password for the new account. During transmission to the registry server, it is encrypted with caller_key. new_keytype The type of the new key. The server uses this parameter to decide how to encode new_key if it is sent as plaintext. Output new_key_version The key version number returned by the server. If the client requests a particular key version number (via the version_number field of the new_key input parameter), the server returns the requested version number back to the client. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_add() routine adds an account with the specified login name. The login name is given in three parts, corresponding to the principal, group, and organization names for the account. The key_parts variable specifies the minimum login abbreviation for the account. If the requested abbreviation duplicates an existing abbreviation for another account, the routine supplies the next shortest unique abbreviation and returns this abbreviation in key_parts. Abbreviations are not currently implemented. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_add() routine requires the following permissions on the account (principal) that is to be added: + The m (mgmt_info) permission to change management information. + The a (auth_info) permission to change authentication information. + The u (user_info) permission to change user information. NOTES The constituent principal, group, and organization (PGO) items for an account must be added before the account can be created. (See the sec_rgy_pgo_add() routine). Also, the principal must have been added as a member of the specified group and organization. (See the sec_rgy_pgo_add_member() routine). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to add an account to the registry. sec_rgy_not_member_group The indicated principal is not a member of the indicated group. sec_rgy_not_member_org The indicated principal is not a member of the indicated organization. sec_rgy_not_member_group_org The indicated principal is not a member of the indicated group or organization. sec_rgy_object exists The account to be added already exists. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_delete sec_rgy_login_get_info sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_add_member sec_rgy_site_open
4.95 – sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace
NAME sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace - Replaces administrative account data SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. For the group and organization names, blank strings can serve as wildcards, matching any entry. The principal name must be input. key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. admin_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure containing the administrative part of an account's data. This information includes the account creation and expiration dates and flags describing limits to the use of privilege attribute certificates, among other information, and can be modified only by an administrator. The sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure contains the following fields: creator The identity of the principal who created this account in sec_rgy_foreign_id_t form. This field is set by the registry server. creation_date The date (sec_timeval_sec_t) the account was created. This field is set by the registry server. last_changer The identity of the principal who last modified any of the account information (user or administrative). This field is set by the registry server. change_date The date (sec_timeval_sec_t) the account was last modified (either user or administrative data). This field is set by the registry server. expiration_date The date (sec_timeval_sec_t) the account will cease to be valid. good_since_date This date (sec_timeval_sec_t) is for Kerberos-style, ticket-granting ticket revocation. Ticket-granting tickets issued before this date will not be honored by authenticated network services. flags Contains administration flags used as part of the administrator's information for any registry account. This field is in sec_rgy_acct_admin_flags_t form. (See sec_intro for a complete description of these flags.) authentication_flags Contains flags controlling use of authentication services. This field is in sec_rgy_acct_auth_flags_t form. (See sec_intro for a complete description of these flags.) Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace() routine replaces the administrative information in the account record specified by the input login name. The administrative information contains limitations on the account's use and privileges. It can be modified only by a registry administrator; that is, a user with the admin_info (abbreviated as a) privilege for an account. The key_parts variable identifies how many of the login_name parts to use as the unique abbreviation for the account. If the requested abbreviation duplicates an existing abbreviation for another account, the routine supplies the next shortest unique abbreviation and returns this abbreviation using key_parts. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace() routine requires the following permissions on the account principal: + The m (mgmt_info) permission, if flags or expiration_date is to be changed. + The a (auth_info) permission, if authentication_flags or good_since_date is to be changed. NOTES All users need the w (write) privilege in the appropriate ACL entry to modify any account information. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to change the administrative information for the specified account. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified name. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_user_replace sec_rgy_acct_replace_all sec_rgy_acct_lookup
4.96 – sec_rgy_acct_delete
NAME sec_rgy_acct_delete - Deletes an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_delete( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. Only the principal name is required to perform the deletion. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_delete() routine deletes from the registry the account corresponding to the specified login name. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_delete() routine requires the following permissions on the account principal: + The m (mgmt_info) permission to remove management information. + The a (auth_info) permission to remove authentication information. + The u (user_info) permission to remove user information. NOTES Even though the account is deleted, the PGO items corresponding to the account remain. These must be deleted with separate calls to sec_rgy_pgo_delete(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to delete the specified account. sec_rgy_object_not_found No PGO item was found with the given name. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add sec_rgy_pgo_delete
4.97 – sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist
NAME sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist - Returns the projects in an account's project list SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_cursor_t *projlist_cursor, signed32 max_number, signed32 *supplied_number, uuid_t id_projlist[], signed32 unix_projlist[], signed32 *num_projects, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. For the group and organization names, blank strings can serve as wildcards, matching any entry. The principal name must be input. max_number The maximum number of projects to be returned by the call. This must be no larger than the allocated size of the projlist[] arrays. Input/Output projlist_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific project in an account's project list. The sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() routine returns the project indicated by projlist_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next project in the list. When the end of the list is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output supplied_number A pointer to the actual number of projects returned. This will always be less than or equal to the max_number supplied on input. If there are more projects in the account list, sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() sets projlist_cursor to point to the next entry after the last one in the returned list. id_projlist[] An array to receive the UUID of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. unix_projlist[] An array to receive the UNIX number of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. num_projects A pointer indicating the total number of projects in the specified account's project list. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() routine returns members of the project list for the specified account. It returns the project information in two arrays. The id_projlist[] array contains the UUIDs for the returned projects. The unix_projlist[] array contains the UNIX numbers for the returned projects. The project list cursor, projlist_cursor, provides an automatic place holder in the project list. The sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next project in the project list. To return an entire project list, reset projlist_cursor with sec_rgy_cursor_reset() on the initial call and then issue successive calls until all the projects are returned. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() routine requires the r (read) permission on the account principal for which the project list data is to be returned. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to refresh a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of projects. sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to see a project list for this principal. sec_rgy_object exists The account to be added already exists. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_cursor_reset sec_rgy_pgo_get_next
4.98 – sec_rgy_acct_lookup
NAME sec_rgy_acct_lookup - Returns data for a specified account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_lookup( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *name_key, sec_rgy_cursor_t *account_cursor, sec_rgy_login_name_t *name_result, sec_rgy_sid_t *id_sid, sec_rgy_unix_sid_t *unix_sid, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_key A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. Blank strings serve as wildcards, matching any entry. Input/Output account_cursor An opaque pointer to a specific account in the registry database. If name_key is blank, sec_rgy_acct_lookup() returns information about the account to which the cursor is pointing. On return, the cursor points to the next account in the database after the returned account. If name_key is blank and the account_cursor has been reset with sec_rgy_cursor_reset(), sec_rgy_acct_lookup() returns information about the first account in the database. When the end of the list of accounts in the database is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to refresh the cursor. Output name_result A pointer to the full login name of the account (including all three names) for which the information is returned. The remaining parameters contain the information belonging to the returned account. id_sid A structure containing the three UUIDs of the principal, group, and organization for the account. unix_sid A structure containing the three UNIX numbers of the principal, group, and organization for the account. key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. user_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure containing the user part of the account data. This represents such information as the account password, home directory, and default shell, all of which are accessible to, and may be modified by, the account owner. admin_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure containing the administrative part of an account's data. This information includes the account creation and expiration dates and flags describing limits to the use of privilege attribute certificates, among other information, and can be modified only by an administrator. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_lookup() routine returns all the information about an account in the registry database. The account can be specified either with name_key or account_cursor. If name_key is completely blank, the routine uses the account_cursor value instead. For name_key, a zero-length principal, group, or organization key serves as a wildcard. For example, a login name key with the principal and organization fields blank returns the next (possibly first) account whose group matches the input group field. The full login name of the returned account is passed back in name_result. The account_cursor provides an automatic place holder in the registry database. The routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next account in the database, after the account for which the information was returned. If name_key is blank and the account_cursor has been reset with sec_rgy_cursor_reset()*O, sec_rgy_acct_lookup() returns information about the first account in the database. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_lookup() routine requires the r (read) permission on the account principal to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the accounts in the registry. sec_rgy_object_not_found The input account could not be found by the registry server. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_cursor_reset sec_rgy_acct_replace_all sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace sec_rgy_acct_user_replace
4.99 – sec_rgy_acct_passwd
NAME sec_rgy_acct_passwd - Changes the password for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_passwd( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_passwd_rec_t *caller_key, sec_passwd_rec_t *new_key, sec_passwd_type_t new_keytype, sec_passwd_version_t *new_key_version, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. All three strings must be completely specified. caller_key A key to use to encrypt the key for transmission to the registry server. If communications secure to the rpc_c_authn_level_pkt_privacy level are available on a system, then this parameter is not necessary, and the packet encryption is sufficient to ensure security. new_key The password for the new account. During transmission to the registry server, it is encrypted with caller_key. new_keytype The type of the new key. The server uses this parameter to decide how to encode new_key if it is sent as plaintext. Output new_key_version The key version number returned by the server. If the client requests a particular key version number (via the version_number field of the new_key input parameter), the server returns the requested version number back to the client. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_passwd() routine changes an account password to the input password character string. Wildcards (blank fields) are not permitted in the specified account name; the principal, group, and organization names of the account must be completely specified. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_passwd() routine requires the u (user_info) permission on the account principal whose password is to be changed. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to change the password of this account. sec_rgy_object_not_found The account to be modified was not found by the registry server. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.100 – sec_rgy_acct_rename
NAME sec_rgy_acct_rename - Changes an account login name SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_rename( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *old_login_name, sec_rgy_login_name_t *new_login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *new_key_parts, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. old_login_name A pointer to the current account login name. The login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. All three strings must be completely specified. new_login_name A pointer to the new account login name. Again, all three component names must be completely specified. Input/Output new_key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_rename() routine changes an account login name from old_login_name to new_login_name. Wildcards (empty fields) are not permitted in either input name; both the old and new login names must completely specify their component principal, group, and organization names. Note, though, that the principal component in a login name cannot be changed. The new_key_parts variable identifies how many of the new_login_name parts to use as the unique abbreviation for the account. If the requested abbreviation duplicates an existing abbreviation for another account, the routine identifies the next shortest unique abbreviation and returns this abbreviation using new_key_parts. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_rename() routine requires the m (mgmt_info) permission on the account principal to be renamed. NOTES The sec_rgy_acct_rename() routine does not affect any of the registry PGO data. The constituent principal, group, and organization items for an account must be added before the account can be created. (See the sec_rgy_pgo_add routine). Also, the principal must have been added as a member of the specified group and organization. (See the sec_rgy_pgo_add_member routine). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to make the changes. sec_rgy_object_not_found The account to be modified was not found by the registry server. sec_rgy_name_exists The new account name is already in use by another account. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add
4.101 – sec_rgy_acct_replace_all
NAME sec_rgy_acct_replace_all - Replaces all account data for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_replace_all( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, boolean32 set_password, sec_passwd_rec_t *caller_key, sec_passwd_rec_t *new_key, sec_passwd_type_t new_keytype, sec_passwd_version_t *new_key_version, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. For the group and organization names, blank strings can serve as wildcards, matching any entry. The principal name must be input. user_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure containing the user part of the account data. This represents such information as the account password, home directory, and default shell, all of which are accessible to, and may be modified by, the account owner. admin_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure containing the administrative part of an account's data. This information includes the account creation and expiration dates and flags describing limits to the use of privilege attribute certificates, among other information, and can be modified only by an administrator. set_passwd The password reset flag. If you set this parameter to TRUE, the account's password will be changed to the value specified in new_key. caller_key A key to use to encrypt the key for transmission to the registry server. If communications secure to the rpc_c_authn_level_pkt_privacy level are available on a system, then this parameter is not necessary, and the packet encryption is sufficient to ensure security. new_key The password for the new account. During transmission to the registry server, it is encrypted with caller_key. new_keytype The type of the new key. The server uses this parameter to decide how to encode the plaintext key. Input/Output key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. Output new_key_version The key version number returned by the server. If the client requests a particular key version number (via the version_number field of the new_key input parameter), the server returns the requested version number back to the client. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_replace_all() routine replaces both the user and administrative information in the account record specified by the input login name. The administrative information contains limitations on the account's use and privileges. The user information contains such information as the account home directory and default shell. Typically, the administrative information can only be modified by a registry administrator (users with admin_info (a) privileges for an account), while the user information can be modified by the account owner (users with user_info (u) privileges for an account). Use the set_passwd parameter to reset the account password. If you set this parameter to TRUE, the account's pasword is changed to the value specified in new_key. The key_parts variable identifies how many of the login_name parts to use as the unique abbreviation for the replaced account. If the requested abbreviation duplicates an existing abbreviation for another account, the routine identifies the next shortest unique abbreviation and returns this abbreviation using key_parts. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_replace_all() routine requires the following permissions on the account principal: + The m (mgmt_info) permission, if flags or expiration_date is to be changed. + The a (auth_info) permission, if authentication_flags or good_since_date is to be changed. + The u (user_info) permission, if user flags, gecos, homedir (home directory), shell, or passwd (password) are to be changed. NOTES All users need the w (write) privilege to modify any account information. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to change account information. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified account could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace sec_rgy_acct_rename sec_rgy_acct_user_replace
4.102 – sec_rgy_acct_user_replace
NAME sec_rgy_acct_user_replace - Replaces user account data SYNOPSIS #include <dce/acct.h> void sec_rgy_acct_user_replace( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, boolean32 set_passwd, sec_passwd_rec_t *caller_key, sec_passwd_rec_t *new_key, sec_passwd_type_t new_keytype, sec_passwd_version_t *new_key_version, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. For the group and organization names, blank strings can serve as wildcards, matching any entry. The principal name must be input. user_part A pointer to the sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure containing the user part of the account data. This represents such information as the account password, home directory, and default shell, all of which are accessible to, and may be modified by, the account owner. The structure contains the following fields: gecos A character string containing information about the account owner. This often includes such information as their name and telephone number. homedir The default directory upon login for the account. shell The default shell to use upon login. passwd_version_number The password version number, a 32-bit unsigned integer, set by the registry server. passwd_dtm The date and time of the last password change (in sec_timeval_sec_t form), also set by the registry server. flags A flag set of type sec_rgy_acct_user_flags_t. passwd The account's encrypted password. set_passwd The password reset flag. If you set this parameter to TRUE, the user's password will be changed to the value specified in new_key. caller_key A key to use to encrypt the key for transmission to the registry server. If communications secure to the rpc_c_authn_level_pkt_privacy level are available on a system, then this parameter is not necessary, and the packet encryption is sufficient to ensure security. new_key The password for the new account. During transmission to the registry server, it is encrypted with caller_key. new_keytype The type of the new key. The server uses this parameter to decide how to encode the plaintext key. Output new_key_version The key version number returned by the server. If the client requests a particular key version number (via the version_number field of the new_key input parameter), the server returns the requested version number back to the client. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_acct_user_replace() routine replaces the user information in the account record specified by the input login name. The user information contains such information as the account home directory and default shell. Typically, the the user information can be modified by the account owner (users with user_info (u) privileges for an account). Use the set_passwd parameter to reset the user's password. If you set this parameter to TRUE, the user's pasword is changed to the value specified in new_key. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_acct_user_replace() routine requires the u (user_info) permission on the account principal. NOTES All users need the w (write) privilege to modify any account information. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]ACCT.IDL The idl file from which dce/acct.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to modify the account data. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified account could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add sec_rgy_acct_admin_replace sec_rgy_acct_rename sec_rgy_acct_replace_all
4.103 – sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc
NAME sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc - Allocates resources to a cursor used by the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc( sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the call returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc() call allocates resources to a cursor used with the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call. This routine, which is a local operation, does not initialize cursor. The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() routine, which makes a remote call, allocates and initializes the cursor. In addition, sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() returns the total number of attributes attached to the object as an output parameter; sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc() does not. Permissions Required None FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_ATTR_BASE.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_attr_base.h was derived. ERRORS no such object error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release sec_rgy_attr_cursor_reset sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id
4.104 – sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init
NAME sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init - Initialize a cursor used by the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 *cur_num_attrs, sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the registry domain in which the object specified by name resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute to be scanned is attached. Output cur_num_attrs A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attributes currently attached to the object. cursor A pointer to a sec_rgy_cursor_t positioned at the first attribute in the list of the object's attributes. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() routine initializes a cursor of type sec_attr_cursor_t (used with the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call) and initializes the cursor to the first attribute in the specified object's list of attributes. This call also supplies the total number of attributes attached to the object as part of its output. The cursor allocation is a local operation. The cursor initialization is a remote operation and makes a remote call to the Registry. Use the sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release() call to release all resources allocated to a sec_attr_cursor_t cursor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() routine requires at least one permission (of any type) on the person, group, or organization to which the attribute to be scanned is attached. ERRORS no such object error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release
4.105 – sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release
NAME sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release - Release a cursor of typesec_attr_cursor_t that was allocated with the sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc() call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release ( sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. Input/Output *cursor As an input parameter, a pointer to an uninitialized cursor of type sec_attr_cursor_t. As an output parameter, a pointer to an uninitialized cursor of type sec_attr_cursor_t with all resources released. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release() routine releases all resources allocated to a sec_attr_cursor_t by the sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc() call. This is a local-only operation and makes not remote calls. Permissions Required None. ERRORS No such object error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id
4.106 – sec_rgy_attr_cursor_reset
NAME sec_rgy_attr_cursor_reset - Rinitializes a cursor that has been allocated with either sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc(). SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_attr_base.h> void sec_attr_cursor_reset( sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As an input parameter, an initialized cursor. As an output parameter, cursor is reset to the first attribute in the schema. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_cursor_reset() routine resets a dce_attr_cursor_t that has been allocated by either a sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc(). The reset cursor can then be used to process a new sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id query by reusing the cursor instead of releasing and re-allocating it. This is a local operation and makes no remote calls. Permissions Required None. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_cursor_alloc sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id
4.107 – sec_rgy_attr_delete
NAME sec_rgy_attr_delete - Deletes specified attributes for a specified object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_delete ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 num_to_delete, sec_attr_t attrs[], signed32 *failure_index, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the registry domain in which the object identified by name resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A character string of type sec_rgy_name_t specifying the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attributes are attached. num_to_delete A 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the attrs[] array. This integer must be greater than 0. attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the attribute instances to be deleted. The size of the array is determined by num_to_delete. Output failure_index In the event of an error, failure_index is a pointer to the element in the in_attrs[] array that caused the update to fail. If the failure cannot be attributed to a specific attribute, the value of failure_index is -1. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_delete() routine deletes attributes. This is an atomic operation: if the deletion of any attribute in the attrs[] array fails, all deletions are aborted. The attribute causing the delete to fail is identified in failure_index. If the failure cannot be attributed to a given attribute, failure_index contains -1. The attrs array, which specifies the attributes to be deleted, contains values of type sec_attr_t These values consist of: + attr_id, a UUID that identifies the attribute type + attr_value, values of sec_attr_value_t that specify the attribute's encoding type and values. To delete attributes that are not multi-valued and to delete all instances of a multi-valued attribute, an attribute UUID is all that is required. For these attribute instances, supply the attribute UUID in the input array and set the attribute encoding (in sec_attr_encoding_t) to sec_attr_enc_void. To delete a specific instance of a multi-valued attribute, supply the UUID and value that uniquely identify the multi-valued attribute instance in the input array. Note that if the deletion of any attribute instance in the array fails, all fail. However, to help pinpoint the cause of the failure, the call identifies the first attribute whose deletion failed in a failure index by array element number. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_delete() routine requires the delete permission set for each attribute type identified in the attrs[] array. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry for the attribute type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS unauthorized database read only server unavailable invalid/unsupported attribute type site read only error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_update
4.108 – sec_rgy_attr_get_effective
NAME sec_rgy_attr_get_effective - Reads effective attributes by ID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_get_effective( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 num_attr_keys, sec_attr_t attr_keys[], sec_attr_vec_t *attr_list, error_status_t status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the domain in which the named object resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_principal The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. num_attr_keys An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the the attr_keys[] array. If num_attr_keys is set to 0, all of the effective attributes that the caller is authorized to see are returned. attr_keys[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specify the UUIDs of the attributes to be returned if they are effective. If the attribute type is associated with a query attribute trigger, the sec_attr_t attr_value field can be used to pass in optional information required by the attribute trigger query. If no information is to be passed in the attr_value field (whether the type indicates an attribute trigger query or not), set the attribute's encoding type to sec_rgy_attr_enc_void. The size of the attr_keys[] array is determined by the num_attr_keys parameter. Output attr_list A pointer an attribute vector allocated by the server containing all of the effective attributes matching the search criteria (defined in num_attr_keys or attr_keys[] ). The server allocates a buffer large enough to return all the requested attributes so that subsequent calls are not necessary. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_get_effective() routine returns the UUIDs of a pecified object's effective attributes. Effective attributes are determined by setting of the schema entry apply_defaults flag: + If the flag is set off, only the attributes directly attached to the object are effective. + If the flag is set on, the effective attributes are obtained by performing the following steps for each attribute identified by UUID in the attr_keys array: 1. If the object named by name is a principal and if the a requested attribute exists on the principal, that attribute is effective and is returned. If it does not exist, the search continues. 2. The next step in the search depends on the type of object: For principals with accounts: a. The organization named in the principal's account is examined to see if an attribute of the requested type exists. If it does, it is effective and is returned; then the search for that attribute ends. If it does not exist, the search for that attribute continues to the policy object as described in b, below. b. The registry policy object is examined to see if an attribute of the requested type exits. If it does, it is returned. If it does not, a message indicating the no attribute of the type exists for the object is returned. For principals without accounts, for groups, and for organizations: the registry policy object is examined to see if an attribute of the requested type exits. If it does, it is returned. If it does not, a message indicating the no attribute of the type exists for the object is returned. For multi-valued attributes, the call returns a sec_attr_t for each value as an individual attribute instance. For attribute sets, the call returns a sec_attr_t for each member of the set; it does not return the set instance. If the attribute instance to be read is associated with a query attribute trigger that requires additional information before it can process the query request, use a sec_attr_value_t to supply the requested information. To do this: + Set the sec_attr_encoding_t to an encoding type that is compatible with the information required by the query attribute trigger. + Set the sec_attr_value_t to hold the required information. If the attribute instance to be read is not associated with a query trigger or no additional information is required by the query trigger, an attribute UUID is all that is required. For these attribute instances, supply the attribute UUID in the input array and set the attribute encoding (in sec_attr_encoding_t) to sec_attr_enc_void. If the requested attribute type is associated with a query trigger, the value returned for the attribute will be the binding (as set in the schema entry) of the trigger server. The caller must bind to the trigger server and pass the original input query attribute to the sec_attr_trig_query call in order to retrieve the attribute value. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.109 – sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id
NAME sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id - Reads a specified object's attribute(s), expanding attribute sets into individual member attributes SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, unsigned32 num_attr_keys, unsigned32 space_avail, sec_attr_t attr_keys[], unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_attr_t attrs[], unsigned32 *num_left, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the registry domain in which the object specified by name resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. num_attr_keys An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the attr_keys array. Set this parameter to 0 to return all of the object's attributes that the caller is authorized to see. space_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the size of the attr_keys array. attr_keys[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that identify the attribute type ID of the attribute instance(s) to be looked up. If the attribute type is associated with a query attribute trigger, the sec_attr_t attr_value field can be used to pass in optional information required by the attribute trigger query. If no information is to be passed in the attr_value field (whether the type indicates an attribute trigger query or not), set the attribute's encoding type to sec_rgy_attr_enc_void. The size of the attr_keys[] array is determined by the num_attr_keys parameter. Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As an input parameter, cursor is a pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t initialized by a sec_rgy_attr_srch_cursor_init call. As an output parameter, cursor is a pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t that is positioned past components returned in this call. Output num_returned A pointer to a 32-bit unsigned integer that specifies the number of attribute instances returned in the attrs[] array. attrs An array of values of type sec_attr_t that contains the attributes retrieved by UUID. The size of the array is determined by space_avail and the length by num_returned. num_left A pointer to a 32-bit unsigned integer that supplies the number of attributes that were found but could not be returned because of space constraints in the attrs[] buffer. To ensure that all the attributes will be returned, increase the size of the attrs[] array by increasing the size of space_avail and num_returned. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok, or, if the requested attributes were not available, it returns the message not_all_available. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id() function reads those attributes specified by UUID for an object specified by name. This routine is similar to the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand routine with one exception: for attribute sets, the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand routine returns a sec_attr_t for the set instance only; it does not expand the set and return a sec_attr_t for each member in the set. This call expands attribute sets and returns a sec_attr_t for each member in the set. If the num_attr_keys parameter is set to 0, all of the object's attributes that the caller is authorized to see are returned. This routine is useful for programmatic access. For multi-valued attributes, the call returns a sec_attr_t for each value as an individual attribute instance. For attribute sets, the call returns a sec_attr_t for each member of the set; it does not return the set instance. The attr_keys[] array, which specifies the attributes to be returned, contains values of type sec_attr_t. These values consist of: + attr_id, a UUID that identifies the attribute type + attr_value, values of sec_attr_value_t that specify the attribute's encoding type and values. Use the attr_id field of each attr_keys array element, to specify the UUID that identifies the attribute type to be returned. If the attribute instance to be read is not associated with a query trigger or no additional information is required by the query trigger, an attribute UUID is all that is required. For these attribute instances, supply the attribute UUID in the input array and set the attribute encoding (in sec_attr_encoding_t) to sec_attr_enc_void. If the attribute instance to be read is associated with a query attribute trigger that requires additional information before it can process the query request, use a sec_attr_value_t to supply the requested information. To do this: + Set the sec_attr_encoding_t to an encoding type that is compatible with the information required by the query attribute trigger. + Set the sec_attr_value_t to hold the required information. Note that if you set num_attr_keys to zero to return all of the object's attributes and that attribute is associated with a query attribute trigger, the attribute trigger will be called with no input attribute information (that would normally have been passed in via the attr_value field). The cursor parameter specifies a cursor of type sec_attr_cursor_t initialized to the point in the attribute list at which to start processing the query. Use the sec_attr_cursor_init function to initialize cursor. If cursor is uninitialized, the server begins processing the query at the first attribute that satisfies the search criteria. The num_left parameter contains the number of attributes that were found but could not be returned because of space constraints of the attrs[] array. (Note that this number may be inaccurate if the target server allows updates between successive queries.) To obtain all of the remaining attributes, set the size of the attrs[] array so that it is large enough to hold the number of attributes listed in num_left. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id() routine requires the query permission set for each attribute type identified in the attr_keys[] array. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry of each attribute type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS unauthorized registry server unavailable trigger server unavailable error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand sec_rgy_attr_attr_lookup_by_name
4.110 – sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name
NAME sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name - Read a single attribute instance for a specific object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, char *attr_name, sec_attr_t *attr, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the domain in which the named object resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_principal The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. attr_name An pointer to a character string that specifies the name of the attribute to be retrieved. Output attr A pointer to a sec_attr_t that contains the first instance of the named attribute. status A pointer to the completion status. The completion status can be one of the following: + error_status_ok if all instances of the value are returned with no errors. + more_available if a multi-valued attribute was specified as name and the routine completed successfully. For multi- valued attributes, this routine returns the first instance of the attribute. + attribute_set_instance if an attribute set was specified as name and the routine completed successfully. + An error message is the routine did not complete successfully. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name() routine returns the named attribute for a named object. This routine is useful for an interactive editor. For multi-valued attributes, this routine returns the first instance of the attribute. To retrieve every instance of the attribute, use the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call, supplying the attribute UUID returned in the attr parameter. For attribute sets, the routine returns the attribute set instance, not the member instances. To retrieve all members of the set, use the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id call, supplying the the attribute set UUID returned in the attr parameter. Warning This routine does not provide for input data to an attribute trigger query operation. If the named attribute is associated with a query attribute trigger, the attribute trigger will be called with no input attribute value information. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name() routine requires the query permission set for the attribute type of the attribute instance identified by attr_name. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry of each attribute type ERRORS unauthorized registry server unavailable trigger server unavailable error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand
4.111 – sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand
NAME sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand - Reads a specified object's attribute(s), without expanding attribute sets into individual member attributes SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, unsigned32 num_attr_keys, unsigned32 space_avail, uuid_t attr_keys[], unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_attr_t attr_sets[], unsigned32 *num_left, error_status_t status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the domain in which the named object resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_principal The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. num_attr_keys An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the the attr_keys[] array. If num_attr_keys is set to 0, all attribute sets that the caller is authorized to see are returned. space_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the size of the attrs_sets[] array. attr_keys[] An array of values of type uuid_t that specify the UUIDs of the attribute sets to be returned. The size of the attr_keys[] array is determined by the num_attr_keys parameter. Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As an input parameter, cursor is a pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t that is initialized by the sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init. As an output parameter, cursor is a pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t that is positioned past the attribute sets returned in this call. Output num_returned A pointer to a 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attribute sets returned in the attrs[] array. attr_sets An array of values of type sec_attr_t that contains the attribute sets retrieved by UUID. The size of the array is determined by space_avail and the length by num_returned. num_left A pointer to a 32-bit unsigned integer that supplies the number of attribute sets that were found but could not be returned because of space constraints in the attr_sets[] buffer. To ensure that all the attributes will be returned, increase the size of the attr_sets[] array by increasing the size of space_avail and num_returned. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand() routine reads attribute sets. This routine is similar to the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id() routine with one exception: for attribute sets, the sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id() routine expands attribute sets and returns a sec_attr_t for each member in the set. This call does not. Instead it returns a sec_attr_t for the set instance only. The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand() routine is useful for programmatic access. cursor is a cursor of type sec_attr_cursor_t that establishes the point in the attribute set list from which the server should start processing the query. Use the sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init function to initialize cursor. If cursor is uninitialized, the server begins processing the query with the first attribute that satisfies the search criteria. The num_left parameter contains the number of attribute sets that were found but could not be returned because of space constraints of the attr_sets[] array. (Note that this number may be inaccurate if the target server allows updates between successive queries.) To obtain all of the remaining attribute sets, set the size of the attr_sets[] array so that it is large enough to hold the number of attributes listed in num_left. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_lookup_no_expand() routine requires the query permission set for each attribute type identified in the attr_keys[] array. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry of each attribute type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS unauthorized registry server unavailable invalid/unsupported attribute type error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_id sec_rgy_attr_lookup_by_name
4.112 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings - Returns printable ACL strings associated with an ACL manager protecting a bound to schema object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/dce_attr_base.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, uuid_t *acl_mgr_type, unsigned32 size_avail, uid_t *acl_mgr_type_chain, sec_acl_printstring_t *acl_mgr_info, boolean32 *tokenize, unsigned32 *total_num_printstrings, unsigned32 *size_used, sec_acl_printstring_t permstrings[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. acl_manager_type A pointer to the UUID identifying the type of the ACL manager in question. There may be more than one type of ACL manager protecting the schema object whose ACL is bound to the input handle. Use this parameter to distinguish them. Use sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs to acquire a list of the manager types protecting a given schema object. size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the permstrings[] array. Output acl_mgr_type_chain If the target object ACL contains more than 32 permission bits, chains of manager types are used: each manager type holds one 32-bit segment of permissions. The UUID returned in acl_mgr_type_chain refers to the next ACL manager in the chain. If there are no more ACL managers in the chain, uuid_nil is returned. acl_mgr_info A pointer to a printstring that contains the ACL manager type's name, help information, and set of supported of permission bits. tokenize A pointer to a variable that specifies whether or not printstrings will be passed separately: + TRUE indicates that the printstrings must be printed or passed separately. + FALSE indicates that the printstrings are unambiguous and can be concatenated when printed without confusion. total_num_printstrings A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer containing the total number of permission entries supported by this ACL manager type. size_used A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of permission entries returned in the permstrings[] array. permstrings[] An array of printstrings of type sec_acl_printstring_t. Each entry of the array is a structure containing the following three components: printstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_len describing the printable representation of a specified permission. helpstring A character string of maximum length sec_acl_printstring_help_len containing some text that can be used to describe the specified permission. permissions A sec_acl_permset_t permission set describing the permissions that are represented with the companion printstring. The array consists of one such entry for each permission supported by the ACL manager identified by acl_mgr_type. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings() routine returns an array of printable representations (called "printstrings") for each permission bit or combination of permission bits the specified ACL manager supports. The ACL manager type specified by acl_mgr_type must be one of the types protecting the schema object bound to by h. In addition to returning the printstrings, this routine also returns instructions about how to print the strings in the tokenize variable. If this variable is set to FALSE, the printstrings can be concatenated. If it is set to TRUE, the printstrings cannot be concatenated. For example a printstrings of r or w could be concatenated as rw without any confusion. However, printstrings in a form of read or write, should not be concatenated. ACL managers often define aliases for common permission combinations. By convention, simple entries appear at the beginning of the printstrings[] array, and combinations appear at the end. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_scl_mgr_strings() routine requires the r permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs
4.113 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry - Create a schema entry SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, sec_attr_schema_entry_t *schema_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. schema_entry A pointer to a sec_attr_schema_entry_t that contains the schema entry values for the schema in which the entry is to be created. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry() routine creates schema entries that define attribute types. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry() routine requires i permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_bad_name sec_attr_bad_encoding_type sec_attr_bad_acl_mgr_set sec_attr_bad_acl_mgr_type sec_attr_bad_permset sec_attr_bad_intercell_action sec_attr_trig_bind_info_missing sec_attr_bad_bind_info sec_attr_bad_bind_svr_name sec_attr_bad_bind_prot_level sec_attr_bad_bind_authn_svc sec_attr_bad_bind_authz_svc sec_attr_bad_uniq_query_accept sec_attr_bad_scope sec_attr_bad_comment sec_attr_type_id_exists sec_attr_name_exists sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_read_only sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry sec_rgy_attr_sch_update
4.114 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc - Allocates resources to a cursor used with the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan call SYNOPSIS void sec_rgy_att_sch_cursor_alloc( dce_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the call returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc() call allocates resources to a cursor used with the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() call. This routine, which is a local operation, does not initialize cursor. The sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() routine, which makes a remote call, allocates and initializes the cursor. In addition, sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() returns the total number of entries found in the schema as an output parameter; sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc() does not. Permissions Required None. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.id was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_release sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
4.115 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init - Initialize and allocate a cursor used with the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan call SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_cursor_init( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, unsigned32 *cur_num_entries, sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. Output cur_num_entries A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the total number of entries contained in the schema at the time of this call. cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t that is initialized to the first entry in the the schema. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the call returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() call initializes and allocates resources to a cursor used with the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan call. This call makes remote calls to initialize the cursor. To limit the number of remote calls, use the sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc() call to allocate cursor, but not initialize it. Be aware, however, that the sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() call supplies the total number of entries found in the schema as an output parameter; the sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc() call does not. If the cursor iunput to sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan has not been initialized, the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan call will initialize it; if it has been initialized, sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan advances it. Permissions Required None. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_release sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc
4.116 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_release
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_release - Release states associated with a cursor used by the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan routine SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_cursor_release( sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As an input parameter, cursor must have been initialized to the first entry in a schema. As an output parameter, cursor is uninitialized with all resources releases. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() routine releases the resources allocated to the cursor used by the sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan routine. This call is a local operation and makes no remote calls. Permissions Required None. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_allocate sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
4.117 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_reset
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_reset - Resets a cursor that has been allocated with either sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc(). SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void dce_attr_cursor_reset( sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As an input parameter, an initialized cursor. As an output parameter, cursor is reset to the first attribute in the schema. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_reset() routine resets a dce_attr_cursor_t that has been allocated by either a sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() or sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc(). The reset cursor can then be used to process a new sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan query by reusing the cursor instead of releasing and re-allocating it. This is a local operation and makes no remote calls. Permissions Required None. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_bad_cursor error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
4.118 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry - Delete a schema entry SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, uuid_t *attr_id, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. attr_id A pointer to a uuid_t that identifies the schema entry to be deleted. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry() routine deletes a schema entry. Because this is a radical operation that invalidates any existing attributes of this type on objects dominated by the schema, access to this operation should be severely limited. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry() routine requires the d permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_sch_entry_not_found sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_read_only sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry
4.119 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs - Retrieve the manager types of the ACLs protecting the objects dominated by a named schema SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, unsigned32 size_avail, unsigned32 *size_used, unsigned32 *num_acl_mgr_types, uuid_t acl_mgr_types[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. size_avail An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the allocated length of the acl_manager_types[] array. Output size_used An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of output entries returned in the acl_mgr_types[] array. num_acl_mgr_types An unsigned 32-bit integer containing the number of types returned in the acl_mgr_types[] array. This may be greater than size_used if there was not enough space allocated by size_avail for all the manager types in the acl_manager_types[] array. acl_mgr_types[] An array of the length specified in size_avail to contain UUIDs (of type uuid_t) identifying the types of ACL managers protecting the target object. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs() routine returns a list of the manager types protecting the schema object identified by context. ACL editors and browsers can use this operation to determine the ACL manager types protecting a selected schema object. Then, using the sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings() routine, they can determine how to format for display the permissions supported by that ACL manager type. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_get_acl_mgrs() routine requires the r permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_aclmgr_strings
4.120 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id - Read a schema entry identified by UUID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, uuid_t *attr_id, sec_attr_schema_entry_t *schema_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. attr_id A pointer to a uuid_t that identifies a schema entry. Output schema_entry A sec_attr_schema_entry_t that contains an entry identified by attr_id. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id() routine reads a schema entry identified by attr_id. This routine is useful for programmatic access. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id() routine requires the r permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_sch_entry_not_found sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
4.121 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name - Read a schema entry identified by name SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, char *attr_name, sec_attr_schema_entry_t *schema_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. attr_name A pointer to a character string that identifies the schema entry. Output schema_entry A sec_attr_schema_entry_t that contains the schema entry identified by attr_name. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name() routine reads a schema entry identified by name. This routine is useful for use with an interactive editor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_name() routine requires the r permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_sch_entry_not_found sec_attr_bad_name sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_lookup_by_id sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
4.122 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan - Read a specified number of schema entries SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, sec_attr_cursor_t *cursor, unsigned32 num_to_read, unsigned32 *num_read, sec_attr_schema_entry_t schema_entries[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. num_to_read An unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the size of the schema_entries[] array and the maximum number of entries to be returned. Input/Output cursor A pointer to a sec_attr_cursor_t. As input cursor must be allocated and can be initialized. If cursor is not initialized, sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan will initialized. As output, cursor is positioned at the first schema entry after the returned entries. Output num_read A pointer an unsigned 32-bit integer specifying the number of entries returned in schema_entries[]. schema_entries[] A sec_attr_schema_entry_t that contains an array of the returned schema entries. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() routine reads schema entries. The read begins at the entry at which the input cursor is positioned and ends after the number of entries specified in num_to_read. The input cursor must have been allocated by either the sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init() or the sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc() call. If the input cursor is not initialzed, sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() initializes it; if cursor is initialized, sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() simply advances it. To read all entries in a schema, make successive sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() calls. When all entries have been read, the call returns the message no_more_entries. This routine is useful as a browser. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_scan() routine requires r permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_bad_cursor sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_init sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_alloc sec_rgy_attr_sch_cursor_release
4.123 – sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry
NAME sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry - Update a schema entry SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h> void sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_attr_component_name_t schema_name, sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t modify_parts, sec_attr_schema_entry_t *schema_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. schema_name Reserved for future use. modify_parts A value of type sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t that identifies the fields in schema_entry that can be modified. schema_entry A pointer to a sec_attr_schema_entry_t that contains the schema entry values for the schema entry to be updated. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry() routine modifies schema entries. Only those schema entry fields set to be modified in the sec_attr_schema_entry_parts_t data type can be modified. Some schema entry components can never be modified. Instead to make any changes to these components, the schema entry must be deleted (which deletes all attribute instances of that type) and recreated. The schema entry components that can never be modified are listed below: + Attribute name + Reserved flag + Apply defaults flag + Intercell action flag + Trigger binding + Comment Fields that are arrays of structures (such as acl_mgr_set and trig_binding) are completely replaced by the new input array. This operation cannot be used to add a new element to the existing array. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_sch_update_entry() routine requires the M permission on the attr_schema object. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR_SCH.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr_sch.h was derived. ERRORS sec_attr_field_no_update sec_attr_bad_name sec_attr_bad_acl_mgr_set sec_attr_bad_acl_mgr_type sec_attr_bad_permset sec_attr_bad_intercell_action sec_attr_trig_bind_info_missing sec_attr_bad_bind_info sec_attr_bad_bind_svr_name sec_attr_bad_bind_prot_level sec_attr_bad_bind_authn_svc sec_attr_bad_bind_authz_svc sec_attr_bad_uniq_query_accept sec_attr_bad_comment sec_attr_name_exists sec_attr_sch_entry_not_found sec_attr_unauthorized sec_attr_svr_read_only sec_attr_svr_unavailable sec_attr_no_memory error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_sch_delete_entry sec_rgy_attr_sch_create_entry
4.124 – sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update
NAME sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update - Updates specified attribute instances for a specified object only if a set of control attribute instances match the object's existing attribute instances SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 num_to_test, sec_attr_t test_attrs[], unsigned32 num_to_write, sec_attr_t update_attrs[], signed32 *failure_index, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the registry domain in which the object specified by name resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A character string of type sec_rgy_name_t specifying the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. num_to_test An unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of elements in the test_attrs[] array. This integer must be greater than 0. test_attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the control attributes. The update takes place only if the types and values of the control attributes exactly match those of the attribute instances on the named registry object. The size of the array is determined by num_to_test. num_to_write A 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attribute instances returned in the update_attrs[] array. update_attrs An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the attribute instances to be updated. The size of the array is determined by num_to_write. Output failure_index In the event of an error, failure_index is a pointer to the element in the update_attrs[] array that caused the update to fail. If the failure cannot be attributed to a specific attribute, the value of failure_index is -1. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update() routine updates an attribute only if the set of control attributes specified in the test_attrs[] match attributes that already exist for the object. This update is an atomic operation: if any of the control attributes do not match existing attributes, none of the updates are performed, and if an update should be performed, but the write cannot occur for whatever reason to any member of the update_attrs[] array, all updates are aborted. The attribute causing the update to fail is identified in failure_index. If the failure cannot be attributed to a given attribute, failure_index contains -1. If an attribute instance already exists which is identical in both attr_id and attr_value to an attribute specified in in_attrs[], the existing attribute information is overwritten by the new information. For multi-valued attributes, every instance with the same attr_id is overwritten with the supplied values. If an attribute instance does not exist, it is created. If you specify an attribute set for updating, the update applies to the set instance, the set itself, not the members of the set. To update a member of an attribute set, supply the UUID of the set member. If an input attribute is associated with an update attribute trigger server, the attribute trigger server is invoked (by the sec_attr_trig_update() function) and the in_attr[] array is supplied as input. The output attributes from the update attribute trigger server are stored in the registry database and returned in the out_attrs[] array. Note that the update attribute trigger server may modify the values before they are used to update the registry database. This is the only circumstance under which the values in the out_attrs[] array differ from the values in the in_attrs[] array. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update() routine routine requires the test permission and the update permission set set for each attribute type identified in the test_attrs[] array. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry of each attribute type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS control attribute has changed unauthorized database read only server unavailable invalid/unsupported attribute type invalid encoding type value not unique trigger server unavailable site read only error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_update sec_rgy_attr_delete
4.125 – sec_rgy_attr_update
NAME sec_rgy_attr_update - Creates and updates attribute instances for a specified object SYNOPSIS #include <dce/sec_rgy_attr.h> void sec_rgy_attr_update ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 num_to_write, unsigned32 space_avail, sec_attr_t in_attrs[], unsigned32 *num_returned, sec_attr_t out_attrs[], unsigned32 *num_left, signed32 *failure_index, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain A value of type sec_rgy_domain_t that identifies the registry domain in which the object specified by name resides. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. This parameter is ignored if name is policy or replist. name A character string of type sec_rgy_name_t specifying the name of the person, group, or organization to which the attribute is attached. num_to_write A 32-bit unsigned integer that specifies the number of elements in the in_attrs array. This integer must be greater than 0. space_avail A 32-bit unsigned integer that specifies the size of the out_attrs array. This integer must be greater than 0. in_attrs[] An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the attribute instances to be updated. The size of the array is determined by num_to_write. Output num_returned A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that specifies the number of attribute instances returned in the out_attrs[] array. out_attrs An array of values of type sec_attr_t that specifies the updated attribute instances. Not that only if these attributes were processed by an update attribute trigger server will they differ from the attributes in the in_attrs[] array. The size of the array is determined by space_avail and the length by num_returned. num_left A pointer to an unsigned 32-bit integer that supplies the number of attributes that could not be returned because of space constraints in the out_attrs[] buffer. To ensure that all the attributes will be returned, increase the size of the out_attrs[] array by increasing the size of space_avail and num_returned. failure_index In the event of an error, failure_index is a pointer to the element in the in_attrs[] array that caused the update to fail. If the failure cannot be attributed to a specific attribute, the value of failure_index is -1. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_attr_update() routine creates new attribute instances and updates existing attribute instances attached to a object specified by name and Registry domain. The instances to be created or updated are passed as an array of sec_attr_t data types. This is an atomic operation: if the creation of any attribute in the in_attrs[] array fails, all updates are aborted. The attribute causing the update to fail is identified in failure_index. If the failure cannot be attributed to a given attribute, failure_index contains -1. The in_attrs array, which specifies the attributes to be created, contains values of type sec_attr_t. These values are: + attr_id, a UUID that identifies the attribute type + attr_value, values of sec_attr_value_t that specify the attribute's encoding type and values. If an attribute instance already exists which is identical in both attr_id and attr_value to an attribute specified in in_attrs, the existing attribute information is overwritten by the new information. For multi-valued attributes, every instance with the same attr_id is overwritten with the supplied values. If an attribute instance does not exist, it is created. For multi-valued attributes, because every instance of the multi-valued attribute is identified by the same UUID, every instance is overwritten with the supplied value. To change only one of the values, you must supply the values that should be unchanged as well as the new value. To create instances of multi-valued attributes, create individual sec_attr_t data types to define each multi-valued attribute instance and then pass all of them in in the input array. If an input attribute is associated with an update attribute trigger server, the attribute trigger server is invoked (by the sec_attr_trig_update() function) and the in_attr[] array is supplied as input. The output attributes from the update attribute trigger server are stored in the registry database and returned in the out_attrs[] array. Note that the update attribute trigger server may modify the values before they are used to update the registry database. This is the only circumstance under which the values in the out_attrs[] array differ from the values in the in_attrs[] array. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_attr_update() routine requires the update permission set for each attribute type identified in the in_attrs[] array. These permissions are defined as part of the ACL manager set in the schema entry of each attribute type. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]SEC_RGY_ATTR.IDL The idl file from which dce/sec_rgy_attr.h was derived. ERRORS unauthorized database read only server unavailable invalid/unsupported attribute type invalid encoding type value not unique attribute instance already exists trigger server unavailable site read only error_status_ok RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_attr_delete sec_rgy_attr_test_and_update
4.126 – sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective
NAME sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective - Returns the effective authentication policy for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *account, sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t *auth_policy, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. account A pointer to the account login name (type sec_rgy_login_name_t). A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. If all three fields contain empty strings, the authentication policy returned is that of the registry. Output auth_policy A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t structure to receive the authentication policy. The authentication policy structure contains the maximum lifetime for an authentication ticket, and the maximum amount of time for which one can be renewed. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() routine returns the effective authentication policy for the specified account. The authentication policy in effect is the more restrictive of the registry and the account policies for each policy category. If no account is specified, the registry's authentication policy is returned. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() routine requires the r (read) permission on the policy object from which the data is to be returned. If an account is specified and an account policy exists, the routine also requires the r (read) permission on the account principal. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified account could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info
4.127 – sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info
NAME sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info - Returns the authentication policy for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *account, sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t *auth_policy, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. account A pointer to the account login name (type sec_rgy_login_name_t). A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. Output auth_policy A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t structure to receive the authentication policy. The authentication policy structure contains the maximum lifetime for an authentication ticket, and the maximum amount of time for which one can be renewed. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info() routine returns the authentication policy for the specified account. If no account is specified, the registry's authentication policy is returned. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info() routine requires the r (read) permission on the policy object or account principal from which the data is to be returned. NOTES The actual policy in effect will not correspond precisely to what is returned by this call if the overriding registry authentication policy is more restrictive than the policy for the specified account. Use sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() to return the policy currently in effect for the given account. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No account with the given login name could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info
4.128 – sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info
NAME sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info - Sets the authentication policy for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *account, sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t *auth_policy, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. account A pointer to the account login name (type sec_rgy_login_name_t). A login name is composed of three character strings, containing the principal, group, and organization (PGO) names corresponding to the account. All three names must be completely specified. auth_policy A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_auth_t structure containing the authentication policy. The authentication policy structure contains the maximum lifetime for an authentication ticket, and the maximum amount of time for which one can be renewed. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info() routine sets the indicated authentication policy for the specified account. If no account is specified, the authentication policy is set for the registry as a whole. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_auth_plcy_set_info() routine requires the a (auth_info) permission on the policy object or account principal for which the data is to be set. NOTES The policy set on an account may be less restrictive than the policy set for the registry as a whole. In this case, the change in policy has no effect, since the effective policy is the most restrictive combination of the principal and registry authentication policies. (See the sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() routine). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No account with the given login name could be found. sec_rgy_not_authorized The user is not authorized to update the specified record. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_info
4.129 – sec_rgy_cell_bind
NAME sec_rgy_cell_bind - Binds to a registry in a cell SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_cell_bind( unsigned_char_t *cell_name, sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t *auth_info, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input cell_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the cell in question. Upon return, a Security Server for that cell is associated with context, the registry server handle. The cell must be specified completely and precisely. This routine offers none of the pathname resolving services of sec_rgy_site_bind(). auth_info A pointer to the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure that identifies the authentication protocol, protection level, and authorization protocol to use in establishing the binding. (See the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() routine). Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_cell_bind() routine establishes a relationship with a registry site at an arbitrary level of security. The cell_name parameter identifies the target cell. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_bind
4.130 – sec_rgy_cursor_reset
NAME sec_rgy_cursor_reset - Resets the registry database cursor SYNOPSIS #include <dce/misc.h> void sec_rgy_cursor_reset( sec_rgy_cursor_t *cursor); PARAMETERS Input/Output cursor A pointer into the registry database. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_cursor_reset() routine resets the database cursor to return the first suitable entry. A cursor is a pointer into the registry. It serves as a place holder when returning successive items from the registry. A cursor is bound to a particular server. In other words, a cursor that is in use with one replica of the registry has no meaning for any other replica. If a calling program attempts to use a cursor from one replica with another, the cursor is reset and the routine for which the cursor was specified returns the first item in the database. A cursor that is in use with one call cannot be used with another. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]MISC.IDL The idl file from which dce/misc.h was derived. EXAMPLES The following example illustrates use of the cursor within a loop. The initial sec_rgy_cursor_reset() call resets the cursor to point to the first item in the registry. Successive calls to sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() return the next PGO item and update the cursor to reflect the last item returned. When the end of the list of PGO items is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. sec_rgy_cursor_reset(&cursor); do { sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(context, domain, scope, &cursor, &item, name &status); if (status == error_status_ok) { /* Print formatted PGO item info */ } } while (status == error_status_ok); RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist sec_rgy_acct_lookup sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_get_members sec_rgy_pgo_get_next
4.131 – sec_rgy_login_get_effective
NAME sec_rgy_login_get_effective - Returns the effective login data for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/misc.h> void sec_rgy_login_get_effective( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_sid_t *sid, sec_rgy_unix_sid_t *unix_sid, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, sec_rgy_plcy_t *policy_data, signed32 max_number, signed32 *supplied_number, uuid_t id_projlist[], signed32 unix_projlist[], signed32 *num_projects, sec_rgy_name_t cell_name, uuid_t *cell_uuid, sec_override_fields_t *overridden, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context The registry server handle. max_number The maximum number of projects to be returned by the call. This must be no larger than the allocated size of the projlist[] arrays. Input/Output login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of the names for the account's principal, group, and organization (PGO) items. Output key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. sid A pointer to a sec_rgy_sid_t structure to receive the returned Subject Identifier (SID) for the account. This structure consists of the UUIDs for the account's PGO items. unix_sid A pointer to a sec_rgy_unix_sid_t structure to receive the returned UNIX Subject Identifier (SID) for the account. This structure consists of the UNIX numbers for the account's PGO items. user_part A pointer to a sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure to receive the returned user data for the account. admin_part A pointer to a sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure to receive the returned administrative data for the account. policy_data A pointer to a sec_rgy_policy_t structure to receive the policy data for the account. The policy data is associated with the account's organization, as identified in the login name. supplied_number A pointer to the actual number of projects returned. This will always be less than or equal to the max_number supplied on input. id_projlist[] An array to receive the UUID of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. unix_projlist[] An array to receive the UNIX number of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. num_projects A pointer indicating the total number of projects in the specified account's project list. cell_name The name of the account's cell. cell_uuid The UUID for the account's cell. overridden A pointer to a 32-bit set of flags identifying the local overrides, if any, for the account login information. [NOT APPLICABLE ON OPENVMS] status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_login_get_effective() routine returns effective login information for the specified account. Login information is extracted from the account's entry in the registry database. Effective login information is the login information from the registry database. The overridden parameter indicates which, if any, of the following local overrides have been defined for the account: + The UNIX user ID + The group ID + The encrypted password + The account's miscellaneous information (gecos) field + The account's home directory + The account's login shell FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]MISC.IDL The idl file from which dce/misc.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy__object_not_found The specified account could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add sec_rgy_login_get_info
4.132 – sec_rgy_login_get_info
NAME sec_rgy_login_get_info - Returns login information for an account SYNOPSIS #include <dce/misc.h> void sec_rgy_login_get_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_login_name_t *login_name, sec_rgy_acct_key_t *key_parts, sec_rgy_sid_t *sid, sec_rgy_unix_sid_t *unix_sid, sec_rgy_acct_user_t *user_part, sec_rgy_acct_admin_t *admin_part, sec_rgy_plcy_t *policy_data, signed32 max_number, signed32 *supplied_number, uuid_t id_projlist[], signed32 unix_projlist[], signed32 *num_projects, sec_rgy_name_t cell_name, uuid_t *cell_uuid, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context The registry server handle. max_number The maximum number of projects to be returned by the call. This must be no larger than the allocated size of the projlist[] arrays. Input/Output login_name A pointer to the account login name. A login name is composed of the names for the account's principal, group, and organization (PGO) items. Output key_parts A pointer to the minimum abbreviation allowed when logging in to the account. Abbreviations are not currently implemented and the only legal value is sec_rgy_acct_key_person. sid A pointer to a sec_rgy_sid_t structure to receive the UUID's representing the account's PGO items. unix_sid A pointer to a sec_rgy_unix_sid_t structure to receive the UNIX numbers for the account's PGO items. user_part A pointer to a sec_rgy_acct_user_t structure to receive the returned user data for the account. admin_part A pointer to a sec_rgy_acct_admin_t structure to receive the returned administrative data for the account. policy_data A pointer to a sec_rgy_policy_t structure to receive the policy data for the account. The policy data is associated with the account's organization, as identified in the login name. supplied_number A pointer to the actual number of projects returned. This will always be less than or equal to the max_number supplied on input. id_projlist[] An array to receive the UUID of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. unix_projlist[] An array to receive the UNIX number of each project returned. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of projects in the account project list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the projects. num_projects A pointer indicating the total number of projects in the specified account's project list. cell_name The name of the account's cell. cell_uuid The UUID for the account's cell. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_login_get_info() routine returns login information for the specified account. This information is extracted from the account's entry in the registry database. To return any local over- rides for the account's login data, use sec_rgy_login_get_effective(). Permissions Required The sec_rgy_login_get_info() routine requires the r (read) permission on the account principal from which the data is to be returned. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]MISC.IDL The idl file from which dce/misc.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified account could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_acct_add sec_rgy_login_get_effective
4.133 – sec_rgy_pgo_add
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_add - Adds a PGO item to the registry database SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_add( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the new PGO item. pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure containing the data for the new PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item may have (or belong to) a concurrent group set. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_add() routine adds a PGO item to the registry database. The PGO data consists of the following: + The Universal Unique Identifier (UUID) of the PGO item. Specify NULL to have the registry server create a new UUID for an item. + The UNIX number for the PGO item. If the registry uses embedded UNIX IDs (where a subset of the UUID bits represent the UNIX ID), then the specified ID must match the UUID, if both are specified. Use a value of -1 for the UNIX number to match any value. + The quota for subaccounts allowed for this item entry. + The full name of the PGO item. + Flags (in the sec_rgy_pgo_flags_t format) indicating whether - A principal item is an alias. - The PGO item can be deleted from the registry. - A principal item can have a concurrent group set. - A group item can appear in a concurrent group set. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_add() routine requires the i (insert) permission on the parent directory in which the the PGO item is to be created. NOTES An account can be added to the registry database only when all its constituent PGO items are already in the database, and the appropriate membership relationships between them are established. For example, to establish an account with principal name tom, group name writers, and organization name hp, all three names must exist as independent PGO items in the database. Furthermore, tom must be a member of writers, which must be a member of hp. (See sec_rgy_acct_add() to add an account to the registry.) FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to add the specified PGO item. sec_rgy_object_exists A PGO item already exists with the name given in name. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_delete sec_rgy_pgo_rename sec_rgy_pgo_replace sec_rgy_acct_add
4.134 – sec_rgy_pgo_add_member
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_add_member - Adds a person to a group or organization SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_add_member( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t go_name, sec_rgy_name_t person_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the person, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_group The go_name parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The go_name parameter identifies an organization. go_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the group or organization to which the specified person will be added. person_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the person to be added to the membership list of the group or organization specified by go_name. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_add_member() routine adds a member to the membership list of a group or organization in the registry database. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_add_member() routine requires the M (Member_list) permission on the group or organization item specified by go_name. If go_name specifies a group, the routine also requires the g (groups) permission on the principal person_name. NOTES An account can be added to the registry database only when all its constituent PGO items are already in the database, and the appropriate membership relationships between them are established. For example, to establish an account with person name tom, group name writers, and organization name hp, all three names must exist as independent PGO items in the database. Furthermore, tom must be a member of writers, which must be a member of hp. (See the sec_rgy_acct_add() routine to add an account to the registry.) FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to add members to the specified group or organization. sec_rgy_bad_domain An invalid domain was specified. A member can be added only to a group or organization, not a person. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified name. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member sec_rgy_pgo_get_members sec_rgy_pgo_is_member
4.135 – sec_rgy_pgo_delete
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_delete - Deletes a PGO item from the registry database SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_delete( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the PGO item to be deleted. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_delete() routine deletes a PGO item from the registry database. Any account depending on the deleted PGO item is also deleted. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_delete() routine requires the following permissions: + The d (delete) permission on the parent directory that contains the the PGO item to be deleted. + The D (Delete_object) permission on the PGO item itself. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to delete the specified item. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified item. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add
4.136 – sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member - Deletes a member of a group or organization SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t go_name, sec_rgy_name_t person_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the person, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_group The go_name parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The go_name parameter identifies an organization. go_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the group or organization from which the specified person will be deleted. person_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the person to be deleted from the membership list of the group or organization specified by go_name. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member() routine deletes a member from the membership list of a group or organization. Any accounts in which the person holds the deleted group or organization membership are also deleted. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_delete_member() routine requires the M (Member_list) permission on the group or organization item specified by go_name. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to delete the specified member. sec_rgy_bad_domain An invalid domain was specified. Members can exist only for groups and organizations, not for persons. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified group or organization was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_add_member
4.137 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num - Returns the name and data for a PGO item identified by its effective UNIX number SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t scope, signed32 unix_id, boolean32 allow_aliases, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, sec_rgy_name_t name, boolean32 *overridden, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The UNIX number identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The UNIX number identifies a group. Note that this function does not support the value sec_rgy_domain_org. scope A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the scope of the desired search. The registry database is designed to accommodate a tree-structured name hierarchy. The scope of a search is the name of the branch under which the search takes place. For example, all names in a registry might start with /alpha, and be divided further into /beta or /gamma. To search only the part of the database under /beta, the scope of the search would be /alpha/beta, and any resulting PGO items would have names beginning with this string. Note that these naming conventions need not have anything to do with group or organization PGO item membership lists. unix_id The UNIX number of the desired registry PGO item. allow_aliases A boolean32 value indicating whether to search for a primary PGO item, or whether the search can be satisfied with an alias. If TRUE, the routine returns the next entry found for the PGO item. If FALSE, the routine returns only the primary entry. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure to receive the data for the returned PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. The data is as it appears in the registry, for that UNIX number. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the returned name for the PGO item. overridden A pointer to a boolean32 value indicating whether or not the supplied UNIX number has an entry in the local override file (passwd_override or group_override). [NOT APPLICABLE ON OPENVMS] status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num() routine returns the name and data for a PGO item. The desired item is identified by its type (domain) and its UNIX number. This routine is similar to the sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num() routine. The difference between the routines is that on UNIX, sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num() first searches the local override files for the respective name_domain for a match with the supplied UNIX number. If an override match is found, and an account or group name is found in that entry, then that name is used to obtain PGO data from the registry and the value of the overridden parameter is set to TRUE. The item_cursor parameter specifies the starting point for the search through the registry database. It provides an automatic place holder in the database. The routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next PGO item after the returned item. The returned cursor location can be supplied on a subsequent database access call that also uses a PGO item cursor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_eff_unix_num() routine requires the r (read) permission on the PGO item to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of PGO items. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified PGO item was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_get_next sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id sec_rgy_cursor_reset
4.138 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id - Returns the name and data for a PGO item identified by its UUID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t scope, uuid_t *item_id, boolean32 allow_aliases, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, sec_rgy_name_t name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The UUID identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The UUID identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The UUID identifies an organization. scope A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the scope of the desired search. The registry database is designed to accommodate a tree-structured name hierarchy. The scope of a search is the name of the branch under which the search takes place. For example, all names in a registry might start with /alpha, and be divided further into /beta or /gamma. To search only the part of the database under /beta, the scope of the search would be /alpha/beta, and any resulting PGO items would have names beginning with this string. Note that these naming conventions need not have anything to do with group or organization PGO item membership lists. item_id A pointer to the uuid_t variable containing the UUID (Unique Universal Identifier) of the desired PGO item. allow_aliases A boolean32 value indicating whether to search for a primary PGO item, or whether the search can be satisfied with an alias. If TRUE, the routine returns the next entry found for the PGO item. If FALSE, the routine returns only the primary entry. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure to receive the data for the returned PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the returned name for the PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id() routine returns the name and data for a PGO item. The desired item is identified by its type (domain) and its UUID. The item_cursor parameter specifies the starting point for the search through the registry database. It provides an automatic place holder in the database. The routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next PGO item after the returned item. The returned cursor location can be supplied on a subsequent database access call that also uses a PGO item cursor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id() routine requires the r (read) permission on the PGO item to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of PGO items. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified PGO item was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_get_next sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id sec_rgy_cursor_reset
4.139 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name - Returns the data for a named PGO item SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. pgo_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the principal, group, or organization to search for. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure to receive the data for the returned PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name() routine returns the data for a named PGO item from the registry database. The desired item is identified by its type (name_domain) and name. The item_cursor parameter specifies the starting point for the search through the registry database. It provides an automatic place holder in the database. The routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next PGO item after the returned item. The returned cursor location can be supplied on a subsequent database access call that also uses a PGO item cursor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name() routine requires the r (read) permission on the PGO item to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of PGO items. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified PGO item was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_get_next sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id sec_rgy_cursor_reset
4.140 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num - Returns the name and data for a PGO item identified by its UNIX ID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t scope, signed32 unix_id, boolean32 allow_aliases, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, sec_rgy_name_t name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The UNIX number identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The UNIX number identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The UNIX number identifies an organization. scope A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the scope of the desired search. The registry database is designed to accommodate a tree-structured name hierarchy. The scope of a search is the name of the branch under which the search takes place. For example, all names in a registry might start with /alpha, and be divided further into /beta or /gamma. To search only the part of the database under /beta, the scope of the search would be /alpha/beta, and any resulting PGO items would have names beginning with this string. Note that these naming conventions need not have anything to do with group or organization PGO item membership lists. unix_id The UNIX number of the desired registry PGO item. allow_aliases A boolean32 value indicating whether to search for a primary PGO item, or whether the search can be satisfied with an alias. If TRUE, the routine returns the next entry found for the PGO item. If FALSE, the routine returns only the primary entry. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure to receive the data for the returned PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the returned name for the PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num() routine returns the name and data for a PGO item. The desired item is identified by its type (domain) and its UNIX number. The item_cursor parameter specifies the starting point for the search through the registry database. It provides an automatic place holder in the database. The routine automatically updates this variable to point to the next PGO item after the returned item. The returned cursor location can be supplied on a subsequent database access call that also uses a PGO item cursor. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num() routine requires the r (read) permission on the PGO item to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of PGO items. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified PGO item was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_next sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id sec_rgy_cursor_reset
4.141 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_members
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_members - Returns the membership list for a specified group or organization or returns the set of groups in which the specified principal is a member. SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_members( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t go_name, sec_rgy_cursor_t *member_cursor, signed32 max_members, sec_rgy_member_t member_list[], signed32 *number_supplied, signed32 *number_members, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a secd server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable specifies whether go_name identifies a principal, group, or organization. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_group The go_name parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The go_name parameter identifies an organization. sec_rgy_domain_person The go_name parameter identifies an principal. go_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) that contains the name of a group, organization, or principal. If go_name is the name of a group or organization, the call returns the group's or organization's member list. If go_name is the name of a principal, the call returns a list of all groups in which the principal is a member. (Contrast this with the sec_rgy_acct_get_proj call, which returns only those groups in which the principal is a member and that have been marked to be included in the principal's project list.) max_members A signed32 variable containing the allocated dimension of the member_list[] array. This is the maximum number of members or groups that can be returned by a single call. Input/Output member_cursor An opaque pointer to a specific entry in the membership list or list of groups. The returned list begins with the entry specified by member_cursor. Upon return, the cursor points to the next entry after the last one returned. If there are no more entries, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor to the beginning of the list. Output member_list[] An array of character strings to receive the returned member or group names. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of members or group names, multiple calls must be made to return all of the members or groups. number_supplied A pointer to a signed32 variable to receive the number of members or groups actually returned in member_list[]. number_members A pointer to a signed32 variable to receive the total number of members or groups. If this number is greater than number_supplied, multiple calls to sec_rgy_pgo_get_members() are necessary. Use the member_cursor parameter to coordinate successive calls. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_members() routine returns a list of the members in the specified group or organization, or a list of groups in which a specified principal is a member. The member_cursor parameter specifies the starting point for the search through the registry database. It provides an automatic place holder in the database. The routine automatically updates member_cursor to point to the next member or group (if any) after the returned list. If not all of the members or groups are returned, the updated cursor can be supplied on successive calls to return the remainder of the list. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_members() routine requires the r (read) permission on the group, organization, or principal object specified by go_name. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. RETURN VALUES The routine returns: + The names of the groups or members in member_list[] + The number of members or groups returned by the call in number_supplied + The total number of members in the group or organization, or the total number of groups in which the principal is a member in number_members FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor points to the end of the membership list for a group or organization or to the end of the list of groups for a principal. sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified group, organization, or principal could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add_member sec_rgy_cursor_reset sec_rgy_pgo_is_member sec_rgy_acct_get_proj
4.142 – sec_rgy_pgo_get_next
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_get_next - Returns the next PGO item in the registry database SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_get_next( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t scope, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, sec_rgy_name_t name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person Returns the next principal item. sec_rgy_domain_group Returns the next group item. sec_rgy_domain_org Returns the next organization item. scope A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the scope of the desired search. The registry database is designed to accommodate a tree-structured name hierarchy. The scope of a search is the name of the branch under which the search takes place. For example, all names in a registry might start with /alpha, and be divided further into /beta or /gamma. To search only the part of the database under /beta, the scope of the search would be /alpha/beta, and any resulting PGO items would have names beginning with this string. Note that these naming conventions need not have anything to do with group or organization PGO item membership lists. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns the value sec_rgy_no_more_entries in the status parameter. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to reset the cursor. Output pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure to receive the data for the returned PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the name of the returned PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() routine returns the data and name for the PGO in the registry database indicated by item_cursor. It also advances the cursor to point to the next PGO item in the database. Successive calls to this routine return all the PGO items in the database of the specified type (given by name_domain), in storage order. The PGO data consists of the following: + The Universal Unique Identifier (UUID) of the PGO item. + The UNIX number for the PGO item. + The quota for subaccounts. + The full name of the PGO item. + Flags indicating whether - A principal item is an alias. - The PGO item can be deleted. - A principal item can have a concurrent group set. - A group item can appear on a concurrent group set. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() routine requires the r (read) permission on the PGO item to be viewed. CAUTIONS There are several different types of cursors used in the registry Application Programmer Interface (API). Some cursors point to PGO items, others point to members in a membership list, and others point to account data. Do not use a cursor for one sort of object in a call expecting another sort of object. For example, you cannot use the same cursor on a call to sec_rgy_acct_get_projlist() and sec_rgy_pgo_get_next(). The behavior in this case is undefined. Furthermore, cursors are specific to a server. A cursor pointing into one replica of the registry database is useless as a pointer into another replica. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to renew a cursor for use with another call or for another server. RETURN VALUES The routine returns the data for the returned PGO item in pgo_item and the name in name. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The cursor is at the end of the list of PGO items. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_cursor_reset sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
4.143 – sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name - Returns the name for a PGO item identified by its UUID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, uuid_t *item_id, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The item_id parameter identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The item_id parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The item_id parameter identifies an organization. item_id A pointer to the uuid_t variable containing the input UUID (Unique Universal Identifier). Output pgo_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the principal, group, or organization with the input UUID. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name() routine returns the name of the PGO item having the specified UUID. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the PGO item to be viewed. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No item with the specified UUID could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
4.144 – sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num - Returns the UNIX number for a PGO item identified by its UUID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, uuid_t *item_id, signed32 *item_unix_id, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The item_id parameter identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The item_id parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The item_id parameter identifies an organization. item_id A pointer to the uuid_t variable containing the input UUID (Unique Universal Identifier). Output item_unix_id A pointer to the signed32 variable to receive the returned UNIX number for the PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num() routine returns the UNIX number for the PGO item having the specified UUID. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No item with the specified UUID could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
4.145 – sec_rgy_pgo_is_member
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_is_member - Checks group or organization membership SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> boolean32 sec_rgy_pgo_is_member( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t go_name, sec_rgy_name_t person_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_group The go_name parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The go_name parameter identifies an organization. go_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the group or organization whose membership list is in question. person_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the principal whose membership in the group or organization specified by go_name is in question. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_is_member() routine tests whether the specified principal is a member of the named group or organization. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_is_member() routine requires the t (test) permission on the group or organization item specified by go_name. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE if the principal is a member of the named group or organization. If the principal is not a member, the routine returns FALSE. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The named group or organization was not found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add_member sec_rgy_pgo_get_members
4.146 – sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id - Returns the UUID for a named PGO item SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, uuid_t *item_id, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. pgo_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the principal, group, or organization whose UUID is desired. Output item_id A pointer to the uuid_t variable containing the UUID (Unique Universal Identifier) of the resulting PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id() routine returns the UUID associated with the named PGO item. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The specified PGO item could not be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
4.147 – sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_unix_num
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_unix_num - Returns the UNIX number for a PGO item identified by its name SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_unix_num( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, signed32 *item_unix_id, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. pgo_name A character string containing the name of the PGO item in question. Output item_unix_id A pointer to the signed32 variable to receive the returned UNIX number for the PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_unix_num() routine returns the UNIX number for the PGO item having the specified name. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No item with the specified UUID could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
4.148 – sec_rgy_pgo_rename
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_rename - Changes the name of a PGO item in the registry database SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_rename( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t old_name, sec_rgy_name_t new_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. old_name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the existing name of the PGO item. new_name A pointer to a sec_rgy_name_t character string containing the new name for the PGO item. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_rename() routine renames a PGO item in the registry database. Permissions Required If the sec_rgy_pgo_rename() routine is performing a rename within a directory, it requires the n (name) permission on the old name of the PGO item. If the routine is performing a move between directories, it requires the following permissions: + The d (delete) permission on the parent directory that contains the PGO item. + The n (name) permission on the old name of the PGO item. + The i (insert) permission on the parent directory in which the PGO item is to be added under the new name. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to change the name of the specified PGO item. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified PGO item. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_replace
4.149 – sec_rgy_pgo_replace
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_replace - Replaces the data in an existing PGO item SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_replace( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, sec_rgy_pgo_item_t *pgo_item, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The name identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The name identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The name identifies an organization. pgo_name A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the principal, group, or organization whose data is to be replaced. pgo_item A pointer to a sec_rgy_pgo_item_t structure containing the new data for the PGO item. The data in this structure includes the PGO item's name, UUID, UNIX number (if any), and administrative data, such as whether the item, if a principal, may have a concurrent group set. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_replace() routine replaces the data associated with a PGO item in the registry database. The UNIX ID and UUID of a PGO item cannot be replaced. To change the UNIX ID or UUID, the existing PGO item must be deleted and a new PGO item added in its place. The one exception to this rule is that the UNIX ID can be replaced in the PGO item for a cell principal. The reason for this exception is that the UUID for a cell principal does not contain an embedded UNIX ID. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_replace() routine requires at least one of the following permissions: + The m (mgmt_info) permission on the PGO item, if quota or flags is being set. + The f (fullname) permission on the PGO item, if fullname is being set. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The client program is not authorized to replace the specified PGO item. sec_rgy_object_not_found No PGO item was found with the given name. sec_rgy_unix_id_changed The UNIX number of the PGO item was changed. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_delete sec_rgy_pgo_rename
4.150 – sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id - Returns the UUID for a PGO item identified by its UNIX number SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, signed32 item_unix_id, uuid_t *item_id, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain This variable identifies the type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by the given name. The valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The item_unix_id parameter identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The item_unix_id parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The item_unix_id parameter identifies an organization. item_unix_id The signed32 variable containing the UNIX number for the PGO item. Output item_id A pointer to the uuid_t variable containing the UUID (Unique Universal Identifier) of the resulting PGO item. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_id() routine returns the Universal Unique Identifier (UUID) for a PGO item that has the specified UNIX number. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No item with the specified UNIX number could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id
4.151 – sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_name
NAME sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_name - Returns the name for a PGO item identified by its UNIX number SYNOPSIS #include <dce/pgo.h> void sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_name( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_domain_t name_domain, signed32 item_unix_id, sec_rgy_name_t pgo_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name_domain The type of the principal, group, or organization (PGO) item identified by item_unix_id. Valid values are as follows: sec_rgy_domain_person The item_unix_id parameter identifies a principal. sec_rgy_domain_group The item_unix_id parameter identifies a group. sec_rgy_domain_org The item_unix_id parameter identifies an organization. item_unix_id The signed32 variable containing the UNIX number for the PGO item. Output pgo_name A character string containing the name of the PGO item in question. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_name() routine returns the name for a PGO item that has the specified UNIX number. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_pgo_unix_num_to_name() routine requires at least one permission of any kind on the PGO item identified by item_unix_id. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]PGO.IDL The idl file from which dce/pgo.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found No item with the specified UNIX number could be found. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_pgo_add sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_id sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_name sec_rgy_pgo_get_by_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_name sec_rgy_pgo_id_to_unix_num sec_rgy_pgo_name_to_id
4.152 – sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective
NAME sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective - Returns the effective policy for an organization SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t organization, sec_rgy_plcy_t *policy_data, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. organization A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the organization for which the policy data is to be returned. If this string is empty, the routine returns the registry's policy data. Output policy_data A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_t structure to receive the authentication policy. This structure contains the minimum length of a user's password, the lifetime of a password, the expiration date of a password, the lifetime of the entire account, and some flags describing limitations on the password spelling. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective() routine returns the effective policy for the specified organization. The effective policy data is the most restrictive combination of the registry and the organization policies. The policy data consists of the following: + The password expiration date. This is the date on which account passwords will expire. + The minimum length allowed for account passwords. + The period of time (life span) for which account passwords will be valid. + The period of time (life span) for which accounts will be valid. + Flags indicating whether account passwords can consist entirely of spaces or entirely of alphanumeric characters. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective() routine requires the r (read) permission on the policy object from which the data is to be returned. If an organization is specified, the routine also requires the r (read) permission on the organization. NOTES If no organization is specified, the routine returns the registry's policy data. To return the effective policy, an organization must be specified. This is because the routine compares the registry's policy data with that of the organization to determine which is more restrictive. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified organization. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_plcy_get_info sec_rgy_plcy_set_info
4.153 – sec_rgy_plcy_get_info
NAME sec_rgy_plcy_get_info - Returns the policy for an organization SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_plcy_get_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t organization, sec_rgy_plcy_t *policy_data, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. organization A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the organization for which the policy data is to be returned. If this string is empty, the routine returns the registry's policy data. Output policy_data A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_t structure to receive the authentication policy. This structure contains the minimum length of a user's password, the lifetime of a password, the expiration date of a password, the lifetime of the entire account, and some flags describing limitations on the password spelling. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_plcy_get_info() routine returns the policy data for the specified organization. If no organization is specified, the registry's policy data is returned. The policy data consists of the following: + The password expiration date. This is the date on which account passwords will expire. + The minimum length allowed for account passwords. + The period of time (life span) for which account passwords will be valid. + The period of time (life span) for which accounts will be valid. + Flags indicating whether account passwords can consist entirely of spaces or entirely of alphanumeric characters. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_plcy_get_info() routine requires the r (read) permission on the policy object or organization from which the data is to be returned. NOTES The returned policy may not be in effect if the overriding registry authorization policy is more restrictive. (See the sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() routine.) FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified organization. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective_info sec_rgy_plcy_set_info
4.154 – sec_rgy_plcy_set_info
NAME sec_rgy_plcy_set_info - Sets the policy for an organization SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_plcy_set_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t organization, sec_rgy_plcy_t *policy_data, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. organization A character string (type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the organization for which the policy data is to be returned. If this string is empty, the routine sets the registry's policy data. policy_data A pointer to the sec_rgy_plcy_t structure containing the authentication policy. This structure contains the minimum length of a user's password, the lifetime of a password, the expiration date of a password, the lifetime of the entire account, and some flags describing limitations on the password spelling. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_plcy_set_info() routine sets the authentication policy for a specified organization. If no organization is specified, the registry's policy data is set. Policy data can be returned or set for individual organizations and for the registry as a whole. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_plcy_set_info() routine requires the m (mgmt_info) permission on the policy object or organization for which the data is to be set. NOTES The policy set on an account may be less restrictive than the policy set for the registry as a whole. In this case, the changes in policy have no effect, since the effective policy is the most restrictive combination of the organization and registry authentication policies. (See the sec_rgy_auth_plcy_get_effective() routine.) FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The user is not authorized to perform this operation. sec_rgy_object_not_found The registry server could not find the specified organization. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_plcy_get_effective sec_rgy_plcy_get_info
4.155 – sec_rgy_properties_get_info
NAME sec_rgy_properties_get_info - Returns registry properties SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_properties_get_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_properties_t *properties, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. Output properties A pointer to a sec_rgy_properties_t structure to receive the returned property information. A registry's property information contains information such as the default and minimum lifetime and other restrictions on privilege attribute certificates, the realm authentication name, and whether or not this replica of the registry supports updates. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_properties_get_info() routine returns a list of the registry properties. The property information consists of the following: read_version A stamp specifying the earliest version of the registry server software that can read from this registry. write_version A stamp specifying the earliest version of the registry server software that can write to this registry. minimum_ticket_lifetime The minimum period of time for which an authentication ticket remains valid. default_certificate_lifetime The default period of time for which an authentication certificate (ticket-granting ticket) remains valid. A process can request an authentication certificate with a longer lifetime. Note that the maximum lifetime for an authentication certificate cannot exceed the lifetime established by the effective policy for the requesting account. low_unix_id_person The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to a principal in the registry. low_unix_id_group The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to a group in the registry. low_unix_id_org The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to an organization in the registry. max_unix_id The maximum UNIX ID that can be used for any item in the registry. realm A character string naming the cell controlled by this registry. realm_uuid The UUID of the cell controlled by this registry. flags Flags indicating whether sec_rgy_prop_readonly If TRUE, the registry database is read-only. sec_rgy_prop_auth_cert_unbound If TRUE, privilege attribute certificates can be generated for use at any site. sec_rgy_prop_shadow_password If FALSE, passwords can be distributed over the network. If this flag is TRUE, passwords will be stripped from the returned data to the sec_rgy_acct_lookup(), and other calls that return an account's encoded password. sec_rgy_prop_embedded_unix_id All registry UUIDs contain embedded UNIX IDs. This implies that the UNIX ID of any registry object cannot be changed, since UUIDs are immutable. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_properties_get_info() routine requires the r (read) permission on the policy object from which the property information is to be returned. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_properties_set_info
4.156 – sec_rgy_properties_set_info
NAME sec_rgy_properties_set_info - Sets registry properties SYNOPSIS #include <dce/policy.h> void sec_rgy_properties_set_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_properties_t *properties, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context The registry server handle. An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. properties A pointer to a sec_rgy_properties_t structure containing the registry property information to be set. A registry's property information contains information such as the default and minimum lifetime and other restrictions on privilege attribute certificates, the realm authentication name, and whether or not this replica of the registry supports updates. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_properties_set_info() routine sets the registry properties. The property information consists of the following: read_version A stamp specifying the earliest version of the registry server software that can read from this registry. write_version A stamp specifying the earliest version of the registry server software that can write to this registry. minimum_ticket_lifetime The minimum period of time for which an authentication ticket remains valid. default_certificate_lifetime The default period of time for which an authentication certificate (ticket-granting ticket) remains valid. A process can request an authentication certificate with a longer lifetime. Note that the maximum lifetime for an authentication certificate cannot exceed the lifetime established by the effective policy for the requesting account. low_unix_id_person The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to a principal in the registry. low_unix_id_group The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to a group in the registry. low_unix_id_org The lowest UNIX ID that can be assigned to an organization in the registry. max_unix_id The maximum UNIX ID that can be used for any item in the registry. realm A character string naming the cell controlled by this registry. realm_uuid The UUID of the cell controlled by this registry. flags Flags indicating whether sec_rgy_prop_readonly If TRUE, the registry database is read-only. sec_rgy_prop_auth_cert_unbound If TRUE, privilege attribute certificates can be generated for use at any site. sec_rgy_prop_shadow_password If FALSE, passwords can be distributed over the network. If this flag is TRUE, passwords will be stripped from the returned data to the sec_rgy_acct_lookup(), and other calls that return an account's encoded password. sec_rgy_prop_embedded_unix_id All registry UUIDs contain embedded UNIX IDs. This implies that the UNIX ID of any registry object cannot be changed, since UUIDs are immutable. Permissions Required The sec_rgy_properties_set_info() routine requires the m (mgmt_info) permission on the policy object for which the property information is to be set. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]POLICY.IDL The idl file from which dce/policy.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_not_authorized The user is not authorized to change the registry properties. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_properties_get_info
4.157 – sec_rgy_site_bind
NAME sec_rgy_site_bind - Binds to a registry site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_bind( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t *auth_info, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the registry site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To randomly choose a site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To bind to a specific site in a specific cell, specify either the site's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the site's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) auth_info A pointer to the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure that identifies the authentication protocol, protection level, and authorization protocol to use in establishing the binding. (See the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() routine). If the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure specifies authenticated rpc, the caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_bind() call binds to a registry site at the security level specified by the auth_info parameter. The site_name parameter identifies the registry to use. If site_name is NULL, or a zero- length string, a registry site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. NOTES Like the sec_rgy_site_bind_query() routine, this routine binds arbitrarily to either an update or query site. Although update sites can accept queries, query sites cannot accept updates. To specifically select an update site, use sec_rgy_site_bind_update(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_cell_bind
4.158 – sec_rgy_site_bind_query
NAME sec_rgy_site_bind_query - Binds to a registry query site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_bind_query( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t *auth_info, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the registry site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To randomly choose a site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To bind to a specific site in a specific cell, specify either the site's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the site's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) auth_info A pointer to the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure that identifies the authentication protocol, protection level, and authorization protocol to use in establishing the binding. (See the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() routine). If the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure specifies authenticated rpc, the caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_bind_query() routine binds to a registry query site at an arbitrary level of security. A registry query site is a satellite server that operates on a periodically updated copy of the main registry database. To change the registry database, it is necessary to change a registry update site, which then automatically updates its associated query sites. No changes can be made directly to a registry query database. The site_name parameter identifies the query site to use. If site_name is NULL, or a zero-length string, a query site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. The handle for the associated registry server is returned in context. NOTES Like sec_rgy_bind_open() routine, this routine binds arbitrarily to either an update or query site. Although update sites can accept queries, query sites cannot accept updates. To specifically select an update site, use sec_rgy_site_bind_update(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_bind
4.159 – sec_rgy_site_bind_update
NAME sec_rgy_site_bind_update - Binds to a registry update site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_bind_update( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t *auth_info, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the registry site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To choose the update site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To start the search for the update site at a specific replica in the replica's cell, specify either the replica's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the replica's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) auth_info A pointer to the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure that identifies the authentication protocol, protection level, and authorization protocol to use in establishing the binding. (See the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() routine). If the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure specifies authenticated rpc, the caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_bind_update() routine binds to a registry update site. A registry update site is a master server that may control several satellite (query) servers. To change the registry database, it is necessary to change a registry update site, which then automatically updates its associated query sites. No changes can be made directly to a registry query database. The site_name parameter identifies either the cell in which to find the update site or the replica at which to start the search for the update site. If site_name is NULL, or a zero-length string, an update site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. The handle for the associated registry server is returned in context. The handle is to an update site. Use this registry context handle in subsequent calls that update or query the the registry database (for example, the sec_rgy_pgo_add() or sec_rgy_acct_lookup() call). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_bind sec_rgy_site_open
4.160 – sec_rgy_site_binding_get_info
NAME sec_rgy_site_binding_get_info - Returns information from the registry binding handle SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_binding_get_info( sec_rgy_handle_t context, unsigned_char_t **cell_name, unsigned_char_t **server_name, unsigned_char_t **string_binding, sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t *auth_info, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context A sec_rgy_handle_t variable that contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. To obtain information on the default binding handle, initialize context to sec_rgy_default_handle. A valid login context must be set for the process if context is set to sec_rgy_default_handle; otherwise the error sec_under_login_s_no_current_context is returned. Output cell_name The name of the home cell for this registry. server_name The name of the node on which the server is resident. This name is either a global name or a network address, depending on the form in which the name was input to the call that bound to the site. string_binding A string containing binding information from sec_rgy_handle_t. auth_info A pointer to the sec_rgy_bind_auth_info_t structure that identifies the authentication protocol, protection level, and authorization protocol to use in establishing the binding. (See the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() routine). status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_binding_get_info() routine returns the site name and authentication information associated with the context parameter. If the context is the default context, the information for the default binding is returned. Passing in a NULL value for any of the output values (except for status) will prevent that value from being returned. Memory is allocated for the string returned in the cell_name, server_name, and string_binding parameters. The application calls the rpc_string_free() routine to deallocate that memory. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_under_login_s_no_current_context sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_bind
4.161 – sec_rgy_site_close
NAME sec_rgy_site_close - Frees the binding handle for a registry server SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_close( sec_rgy_handle_t context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle indicating ("bound to") a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_close() routine frees the memory occupied by the specified handle and destroys its binding with the registry server. NOTES A handle cannot be used after it is freed. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_get sec_rgy_site_is_readonly sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_open_query sec_rgy_site_open_update
4.162 – sec_rgy_site_get
NAME sec_rgy_site_get - Returns the string representation for a bound registry site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_get( sec_rgy_handle_t context, unsigned_char_t **site_name, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle indicating (bound to'') a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. To obtain information on the default binding handle, initialize context to sec_rgy_default_handle. A valid login context must be set for the process if context is set to sec_rgy_default_handle; otherwise the error sec_under_login_s_no_current_context is returned. Output site_name A pointer to a character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the returned name of the registry site associated with context, the given registry server handle. The name is either a global name or a network address, depending on the form in which the name was input to the call that bound to the site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_get() routine returns the name of the registry site associated with the specified handle. If the handle is the default context, the routine returns the name of the default context's site. Memory is allocated for the string returned in the site_name parameter. The application calls the rpc_string_free() routine to deallocate that memory. NOTES To obtain binding information, the use of the sec_rgy_site_binding_get_info() call is recommended in place of this call. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_under_login_s_no_current_context sec_rgy_server_unavailable The requested registry server is not available. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open
4.163 – sec_rgy_site_is_readonly
NAME sec_rgy_site_is_readonly - Checks whether a registry site is read-only SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> boolean32 sec_rgy_site_is_readonly( sec_rgy_handle_t context); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle indicating (bound to'') a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_is_readonly() routine checks whether the registry site associated with the specified handle is a query site or an update site. A query site is a read-only replica of a master registry database. The update site accepts changes to the registry database, and duplicates the changes in its associated query sites. RETURN VALUES The routine returns: + TRUE if the registry site is read-only or if there was an error using the specified handle + FALSE if the registry site is an update site FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_open_query
4.164 – sec_rgy_site_open
NAME sec_rgy_site_open - Binds to a registry site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_open( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A pointer to a character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the registry site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To randomly choose a site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To bind to a specific site in a specific cell, specify either the site's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the site's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) Note that if you specify the name of a specific secd to bind to and the name is not valid, the call will bind to a random site in the cell if the specified cell name is valid. Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_open() routine binds to a registry site at the level of security specified in the rpc_binding_set_auth_info() call. The site_name parameter identifies the registry to use. If site_name is NULL, or a zero-length string, a registry site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. The caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. NOTES To bind to a registry site, the use of the sec_rgy_site_bind() call is recommended in place of this call. Like sec_rgy_site_open_query() routine, this routine binds arbitrarily to either an update or query site. Although update sites can accept queries, query sites cannot accept updates. To specifically select an update site, use sec_rgy_site_open_update(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The requested registry server is not available. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_close sec_rgy_site_is_readonly sec_rgy_site_open_query sec_rgy_site_open_update
4.165 – sec_rgy_site_open_query
NAME sec_rgy_site_open_query - Binds to a registry query site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_open_query( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of the registry query site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To randomly choose a site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To bind to a specific site in a specific cell, specify either the site's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the site's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_open_query() routine binds to a registry query site. A registry query site is a satellite server that operates on a periodically updated copy of the main registry database. To change the registry database, it is necessary to change a registry update site, which then automatically updates its associated query sites. No changes can be made directly to a registry query database. The site_name parameter identifies the query site to use. If site_name is NULL, or a zero-length string, a query site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. The handle for the associated registry server is returned in context. The caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. NOTES To bind to a registry query site, the use of the sec_rgy_site_bind_query() call is recommended in place of this call. Like sec_rgy_site_open() routine, this routine binds arbitrarily to either an update or query site. Although update sites can accept queries, query sites cannot accept updates. To specifically select an update site, use sec_rgy_site_open_update(). FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. Errors sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_close sec_rgy_site_get sec_rgy_site_is_readonly sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_open_update
4.166 – sec_rgy_site_open_update
NAME sec_rgy_site_open_update - Binds to a registry update site SYNOPSIS #include <dce/binding.h> void sec_rgy_site_open_update( unsigned_char_t *site_name, sec_rgy_handle_t *context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input site_name A character string (type unsigned_char_t) containing the name of an update registry site to bind to. Supply this name in any of the following forms: + To choose the update site to bind to in the named cell, specify a cell name (for example, /.../r_d.com or /.: for the local cell) + To start the search for the update site at a specific replica in the replica's cell, specify either the site's global name (for example, /.../r_d.com/subsys/dce/sec/rs_server_250_2) or the site's network address (for example, ncadg_ip_udp:15.22.144.248) Output context A pointer to a sec_rgy_handle_t variable. Upon return, this contains a registry server handle indicating ("bound to") the desired registry site. status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_site_open_update() routine binds to a registry update site. A registry update site is a master server that may control several satellite (query) servers. To change the registry database, it is necessary to change a registry update site, which then automatically updates its associated query sites. No changes can be made directly to a registry query database. The site_name parameter identifies either the cell in which to find the update site or the replica at which to start the search for the update site. If site_name is NULL, or a zero-length string, an update site in the local cell is selected by the client agent. The handle for the associated registry server is returned in context. The handle is to an update site. Use this registry context handle in subsequent calls that update or query the the registry database (for example, the sec_rgy_pgo_add() or sec_rgy_acct_lookup() call). The caller must have established a valid network identity for this call to succeed. NOTES To bind to a registry update site, the use of the sec_rgy_site_bind_update() call is recommended in place of this call. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]BINDING.IDL The idl file from which dce/binding.h was derived. ERRORS sec_login_s_no_current_context The caller does not have a valid network login context. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro sec_rgy_site_close sec_rgy_site_get sec_rgy_site_is_readonly sec_rgy_site_open sec_rgy_site_open_query
4.167 – sec_rgy_unix_getgrgid
NAME sec_rgy_unix_getgrgid - Returns a UNIX style group entry for the account matching the specified group ID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rgynbase.h> void sec_rgy_unix_getgrent( sec_rgy_handle_t context, signed32 gid, signed32 max_number, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_unix_group_t *group_entry, signed32 *number_members, sec_rgy_member_t member_list[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input A pointer to an opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. gid A 32-bit integer specifying the group ID to match. max_number The maximum number of members to be returned by the call. This must be no larger than the allocated size of the member_list[] array. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_pgo_get_next() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns sec_rgy_no_more_entries. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to refresh the cursor. Output group_entry A UNIX style group entry structure returned with information about the account matching gid. number_members An signed 32-bit integer containing the total number of member names returned in the member_list[] array. member_list[] An array of character strings to receive the returned member names. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of members in the membership list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the members. status On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_unix_getgrgid() routine returns the next UNIX group structure that matches the input UNIX group ID. The structure is in the following form: typedef struct { sec_rgy_name_t name; signed32 gid; sec_rgy_member_buf_t members; } sec_rgy_unix_group_t; The structure includes o The name of the group. o The group's UNIX ID. o A string containing the names of the group members. This string is limited in size by the size of the sec_rgy_member_buf_t type defined in rgynbase.idl. The routine also returns an array of member names, limited in size by the number_members parameter. This call is supplied in source code form. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RGYBASE.IDL The idl file from which dce/rgybase.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_nomore_entries The end of the list of entries has been reached. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro.
4.168 – sec_rgy_unix_getgrnam
NAME sec_rgy_unix_getgrnam - Returns a UNIX style group entry for the account matching the specified group name SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rgynbase.h> void sec_rgy_unix_getgrnam( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t name, signed32 name_length, signed32 max_num_members, sec_rgy_cursor_t item_cursor, sec_rgy_unix_group_t group_entry, signed32 number_members, sec_rgy_member_t member_list[], error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. name A character string (of type sec_rgy_name_t) specifying the group name to be matched. name_length An signed 32-bit integer specifying the length of name in characters. max_num_members The maximum number of members to be returned by the call. This must be no larger than the allocated size of the member_list[] array. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_unix_getgrnam() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns sec_rgy_no_more_entries. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to refresh the cursor. Output group_entry A UNIX style group entry structure returned with information about the account matching name. number_members An signed 32-bit integer containing the total number of member names returned in the member_list[] array. member_list[] An array of character strings to receive the returned member names. The size allocated for the array is given by max_number. If this value is less than the total number of members in the membership list, multiple calls must be made to return all of the members. status On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_unix_getgrnam() routine looks up the next group entry in the registry that matches the input group name and returns the corresponding UNIX style group structure. The structure is in the following form: typedef struct { sec_rgy_name_t name; signed32 gid; sec_rgy_member_buf_t members; } sec_rgy_unix_group_t; The structure includes + The name of the group. + The group's UNIX ID. + A string containing the names of the group members. This string is limited in size by the size of the sec_rgy_member_buf_t type defined in rgynbase.idl. The routine also returns an array of member names, limited in size by the number_members parameter. Note that the array contains only the names explicitly specified as members of the group. A principal that was made a member of the group because that group was assigned as the principal's primary group will not appear in the array. This call is provided in source code form. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RGYBASE.IDL The idl file from which dce/rgybase.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The end of the list of entries has been reached. sec_rgy bad_data The name supplied as input was too long. error_status_ok The call was successful. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.169 – sec_rgy_unix_getpwnam
NAME sec_rgy_unix_getpwnam - Returns a UNIX style passwd entry for account matching the specified name. SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rgynbase.h> void sec_rgy_unix_getpwnam ( sec_rgy_handle_t context, sec_rgy_name_t name, unsigned32 name_len, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_unix_passwd_t *passwd_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open to acquire a bound handle. name A character string (of type sec_rgy_name_t) containing the name of the person, group, or organization whose name entry is desired. name_len A 32-bit integer representing the length of the name in characters. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_unix_getpwnam routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns sec_rgy_no_more_entries. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset to refresh the cursor. Output passwd_entry A UNIX style passwd structure returned with information about the account matching name. status On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_unix_getpwnam routine returns the next UNIX passwd structure that matches the input name. The structure is in the form: typedef struct { sec_rgy_unix_login_name_t name; sec_rgy_unix_passwd_buf_t passwd; signed32 uid; signed32 gid; signed32 oid; sec_rgy_unix_gecos_t gecos; sec_rgy_pname_t homedir; sec_rgy_pname_t shell; } sec_rgy_unix_passwd_t; The structure includes: + The account's login name. + The account's password. + The account's UNIX ID. + The UNIX ID of group and organization associated with the account. + The account's GECOS information. + The account's home directory. + The account's login shell This call is provided in source code form. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RGYNBASE.IDL The idl file from which rgynbase.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy bad_data The name supplied as input was too long. error_status_ok The call was successful. sec_rgy_no_more_entries The end of the list of entries has been reached. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.170 – sec_rgy_unix_getpwuid
NAME sec_rgy_unix_getpwuid - Returns a UNIX style passwd entry for the account matching the specified UID SYNOPSIS #include <dce/rgynbase.h> void sec_rgy_unix_getpwuid( sec_rgy_handle_t context, signed32 uid, sec_rgy_cursor_t *item_cursor, sec_rgy_unix_passwd_t *passwd_entry, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context An opaque handle bound to a registry server. Use sec_rgy_site_open() to acquire a bound handle. uid A 32-bit integer UNIX ID. Input/Output item_cursor An opaque pointer indicating a specific PGO item entry in the registry database. The sec_rgy_unix_getpwuid() routine returns the PGO item indicated by item_cursor, and advances the cursor to point to the next item in the database. When the end of the list of entries is reached, the routine returns sec_rgy_no_more_entries. Use sec_rgy_cursor_reset() to refresh the cursor. Output passwd_entry A UNIX style password structure returned with information about the account matching uid. status On successful completion, the routine returns error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_unix_getpwuid() routine looks up the next passwd entry in the registry that matches the input UNIX ID and returns the corresponding sec_rgy_passwd structure. The structure is in the following form: typedef struct { sec_rgy_unix_login_name_t name; sec_rgy_unix_passwd_buf_t passwd; signed32 Vuid; signed32 Vgid; signed32 oid; sec_rgy_unix_gecos_t gecos; sec_rgy_pname_t homedir; sec_rgy_pname_t shell; } sec_rgy_unix_passwd_t; The structure includes + The account's login name. + The account's password. + The account's UNIX ID. + The UNIX ID of group and organization associated with the account. + The account's GECOS information. + The account's home directory. + The account's login shell FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]RGYNBASE.IDL The idl file from which dce/rgynbase.h was derived. This call is provided in source code form. ERRORS sec_rgy_no_more_entries The end of the list of entries has been reached. sec_rgy_server_unavailable The DCE Registry Server is unavailable. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro
4.171 – sec_rgy_wait_until_consistent
NAME sec_rgy_wait_until_consistent - Blocks the caller while prior updates are propagated to the registry replicas SYNOPSIS #include <dce/misc.h> boolean32 sec_rgy_wait_until_consistent( sec_rgy_handle_t context, error_status_t *status); PARAMETERS Input context The registry server handle associated with the master registry. Output status A pointer to the completion status. On successful completion, status is assigned error_status_ok. Otherwise, it returns an error. DESCRIPTION The sec_rgy_wait_until_consistent() routine blocks callers until all prior updates to the master registry have been propagated to all active registry replicas. RETURN VALUES The routine returns TRUE when all active replicas have received the prior updates. It returns FALSE if at least one replica did not receive the updates. FILES SYS$COMMON:[DCE$LIBRARY]MISC.IDL The idl file from which dce/misc.h was derived. ERRORS sec_rgy_server_unavailable The server for the master registry is not available. sec_rgy_read_only Either the master site is in maintenance mode or the site associated with the handle is a read-only (query) site. error_status_ok The call was successful. RELATED INFORMATION Functions: sec_intro